Royal Academy of Art Studyguide 2013/2014 Index Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide 1.1 Welcome to the academy.....................................5 1.2 A glorious history.........................................6 2.1 Academy-wide education.....................................9 2.2ArtScience................................................11 2.3 Fine Arts.................................................27 2.4Photography...............................................49 2.5 Graphic Design............................................73 2.6 Interior Architecture and Furniture Design................91 2.7Interactive/Media/Design.................................111 2.8 Textile & Fashion........................................129 3.1 Preparatory Courses......................................147 3.2 School for Young Talent..................................148 3.3 Preparatory Year.........................................149 3.4 Collaborations with secondary schools....................151 3.5 Special Combined Education...............................153 3.6 Orientation Course.......................................155 3.7 Additional activities....................................155 4.1 Post Graduate Course Industrial Design...................159 4.2 Type & Media.............................................163 4.3 Master Artscience........................................165 4.4 Film and Photographic Studies............................171 4.5 INSIDE Interior Architecture.............................173 4.6 Master Artistic Research.................................175 4.7 Media Technology.........................................181 4.8PhDArts..................................................183 5.1 What is a Research Domain................................189 5.2 Research Domain Art Theory and Artistic Practice.........189 5.3 Research Domain Interior Architecture....................189 5.4 Research Domain Innovative Visualisation Techniques......190 5.5 Research in the Arts.....................................193 5.6 Academy of Creative and Performing Arts..................195 6.1 Educational structure....................................197 6.1.1 Competences and domains..................................197 6.1.2 Teaching formats.........................................198 6.1.3 Individual Study Trajectory..............................200 6.1.4Electives................................................201 6.1.5 Minor programmes.........................................203 6.1.6Internationalisation.....................................204 6.1.7 After graduation.........................................205 6.1.8 Career orientation and preparation.......................206 6.1.9Internship...............................................208 6.2 Assessing in art education...............................209 6.2.1 Credits, EC..............................................210 6.2.2 Study and progress guidance..............................212 6.3 Quality Assurance........................................213 6.4Accreditation............................................214 6.5 Quality Assurance at the KABK............................215 7.1 Education and Examination Regulations....................219 8Referrals................................................241 1. Welcome 1.1 Welcome to the academy At the Royal Academy of Art (KABK), we educate students to become selfaware artists and designers, who contribute meaningfully to their discipline and society with their ambition, profound insight and experimental attitude. I wish all our students a substantial, captivating, and above all, pleasurable study experience. Jack Verduyn Lunel director Royal Academy of Art Students can make use of workshops for wood, metal, textile, computers and photography. Recent investments have made it possible to work with modern 3D scanning and printing techniques. The multimedia recording and editing studios have been further modernised. Additionally, the academy has several labs for interfacing (LabLand), radio frequency identification technology and augmented reality (AR+RFID Lab). Students can gain basic knowledge and skills by taking academy-wide introductory courses on gaming, the moving image, sound, 3D-modeling and website design. Numerous lectures, film screenings, debates and exhibitions take place throughout the year. However, not everything the KABK has to offer takes place at the building on the Prinsessegracht. The collaboration with the Royal Conservatoire and the Academy of Creative and p.5 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Choosing for this academy means choosing for a future in the world of art and culture, where research holds a prominent position. The programmes are aimed at developing creativity, professionalism and the urge to innovate, and are shaped by theory and practice teachers who have a professional practice. During their studies, students receive every opportunity to develop in a way that suits their talents and ambitions best. At the KABK, they are acquainted with all matters that will be of importance later, when they start working as an artist or designer. Performing Arts at Leiden University enables students to take electives and to follow minor or master’s programmes in Leiden and at the Conservatoire in the framework of the Individual Study Trajectory. In January 2010, we opened the doors of STOOR, the academy store. Students have created all the products being sold here. The programmes we offer develop at a high pace, in a continuing intensive relationship with a professional practice that almost explodes in its diversity. 1.2 A glorious history Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The Royal Academy of Art in The Hague is the oldest art academy in the Netherlands. Already in the sixteenth century there is mention of a Lucas Guild in The Hague. In 1656, a group of painters cut their ties with the guild to form the Pictura Brotherhood, in order to make a clear distinction between artists and craftsmen. In 1682, the Pictura Brotherhood founded an academy, which was the forerunner of our current academy. Its predecessor was primarily intended to give members of the Picture Brotherhood the opportunity to further develop their drawing skills. The idea to organise this additional education came from a group of painters who had worked in Rome, and who, inspired by their international experience, felt the need to lift painting in The Hague to a more international and organised level. This wish corresponded to the fact that The Hague, in comparison to other cities in the Netherlands, had a very courtly character. The founding of the original academy and its international orientation is exemplary of two aspects that have played a regular role in the history of our academy: the encouragement of the artistic climate in the immediate area, and the continuous attempt to achieve this from an international perspective. In 1780, the academy became completely independent of the Pictura Brotherhood and turned into an open academy that was free of cost for everyone. Building on the Prinsessegracht The end of the eighteenth century was a period of economic and political decline. It was a difficult time for the academy as well, which only regained its prominent place in 1821. This year saw the joining of the academy with the School for Civil Architecture. After being located p.6 at the Korenbeurs and Boterwaag, the academy moved to its current building at the Prinsessegracht in 1839. This neoclassical building, designed by the city’s master architect Zeger Reyers, was a true temple to the arts. With the disappearance of the guilds in the nineteenth century, technical education became more important. The academy also played a role in this development. Over the course of the century, in addition to the architecture programme, a large number of craftsmen came to the academy for extra schooling in the field of drawing and design. The lists of enrolled students of that time almost make it seem like the academy was a technical school instead of an art academy. Additionally, a teacher programme was founded that, up until the 1970’s, held a prominent place in the institute. The nineteenth century saw the heyday of painting in The Hague. Many famous artists from that period, such as G.H. Breitner, Willem Maris, Jacob Maris and Johannes Bosboom, were educated at the academy. Independent courses In addition to drawing, painting and architecture, the academy founded the aforementioned programme for art teachers at the end of the nineteenth century. Under the leadership of director dr J.H. Plantenga, the twentieth century saw the addition of evening courses and, for a while, a Sunday morning course. Under the influence of, among others, the Bauhaus movement, there was an increase in interest in the applied arts in the design disciplines. In 1929, the academy started the course ‘Advertisement Drawing and Furniture Construction’, which later evolved into the independent departments Graphic and Typographic Design and Interior. Towards a modern academy The academy building was a clear reference to the ancient past. It was therefore no surprise that in the same period the school was updated to reflect modern times, which included a prominent place for design, the building was also modernised. Director Plantenga oversaw this renewal. New teachers were recruited who applied the new perspectives of the twentieth century avant-garde to their teaching. Among them were the renowned teachers Kiljan, Citroen, Schuitema and Alons. Photography was given an important place in the Advertising department. Innovations of the last fifty years In 1957, on the occasion of its 275th anniversary, the academy received the designation ‘Royal’. In that year, the academy and the technical college (in Dutch: HTS) separated. In subsequent years the art educational system was modernised in three successive phases. The Royal Academy of Art underwent these changes as well, of course. In 1968 a number of vocational schools officially became art academies as institutes of Higher Vocational Education (HBO). These academies, which then had five-year programmes, consisted of various departments. In addition to the painting and sculpture departments, these academies also offered programmes in the field of design. They generally produced more designers than autonomous visual artists. The final phase of renovation commenced with the redesigning and renovation of the building in 2000. All departments in the field of art and design have since then been housed in the building at the Prinsessegracht, whilst retaining the 1938 building. Its current form was realised by architects Van Mourik Vermeulen. With a new addition on top of the building at the Prinsessegracht and the purchase of two spaces directly connected to the academy in 2012, the space requirements of modern art education are met, and the building is able to accommodate the expansion of bachelor’s and master’s programmes at the academy. In 2001, an intensive collaboration was established with Leiden University in the newly founded Academy of Creative and Performing Arts. It was the first formal collaboration between a university and an art institute in the Netherlands. Since that time it has become possible for students to study at both the University of the Arts and at Leiden University simultaneously. In the academy’s programmes, the focus on new technologies and new media has dramatically expanded, which is visible in new facilities and workshops, as well as in new programmes such as ArtScience, Interactive/ Media/Design, the Master Interior Architecture (INSIDE) and the Master Artistic Research. In the 1980’s, a process of expansion took place in the HBO system. The various independent institutes p.7 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide During those years, the academy played a pioneering role in the Netherlands. In 1938, the ancient temple was replaced with a new academy building that fully reflected the new educational system. It was a monument of modernism and was designed by Plantenga, J.W.E. Buijs and J.B. Lürsen. After the war, director B. Th. de Hey obtained approval of Royal Decree to establish a course in Industrial Design. This is currently one of the oldest programmes in industrial design in the Netherlands. merged into larger schools. This also applied to the Royal Academy of Art, which was named University of Visual Art, Music and Dance after merging with the photography and photonics departments of the vocational technical school (MTS) and the Royal Conservatoire. In 2011 this name was changed into University of the Arts The Hague. 2.1 Academy-wide education Some components of the academy-wide programme are part of the departments’ (compulsory) programmes. When this is the case, the components are included in the relevant credit overviews. Students can follow the other courses as part of the Individual Study Trajectory (IST) or as extra-curricular programme, albeit in consultation with their IST-coach. In the propaedeutic year Research and Discourse The aim of Research and Discourse is to familiarize students with a scientific way of thinking and to create a foundation for an investigative attitude in the students’ practice. It also provides students with insight into the theories and ideas that form the foundation of art. In lectures and/or seminars, students investigate the role of research in art and the relationship between art and science. Additionally, students acquire skills to help them accurately substantiate and present their position and opinions as an artist/designer. Research and Discourse is a compulsory course. The academy-wide propaedeutic project week aims to bring students from different departments together in intense collaborations. During this week, students work on an assignment in multidisciplinary groups. Attending the project week is compulsory. In the third year and above Business Plan Writing The KABK offers the course Business Plan Writing to optimally prepare students for their future careers. The aim of the course is to familiarise students with writing a business plan. The course is compulsory for students of all departments. The period in which it is offered may vary according to the department and is indicated in the credit overviews. In the IST or as extra-curricular programme Introductory courses The KABK offers a wide range of courses that introduce students to various techniques. Introductory courses are open to students of all departments from the second year onwards. Students can follow the courses in the framework of the Individual Study Trajectory, with approval of the IST-coach. If a course does not fit in the IST programme it can be followed as an extra-curricular course. The up-to-date schedule for introductory courses can be found at: www.kabk.nl/introductory p.9 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide From the first year onwards, students take a number of interdisciplinary courses to support and complement their programmes: academy-wide education. In these courses we encourage collaboration between students from different departments and disciplines. The academy-wide programme corresponds to the ideals and goals set for the KABK in its totality. Examples of this are the joint core for theoretical education and research in the arts, and entrepreneurship and career preparation. We also offer a number of academy-wide practice-based courses that can be useful for students from different disciplines. Academy-wide propaedeutic project week 2.2 The ArtScience Interfaculty 2.2.1 Introduction We ask and encourage students to investigate ideas by making things and questioning the results. How do you and other people interact You want to think with your hands and build with your brain? Come and study at the ArtScience Interfaculty! 2.2.2 Art and Science Since a number of years we are in the midst of a new wave of interest in the connection between art and science. In the previous century there have been two such waves, the first in the twenties and thirties, marking the beginning of modern art, industrial design, modern music and modern architecture. The second of these waves was in the fifties and sixties, marking the birth of electronic music, video art, interactive art and generative art. Both of these periods shared a sense of optimism about potential future developments, but also a sense of responsibility for the artist who had to fulfil a specific mission to help ensure this positive potential. This mission was perceived to consist in absorbing new technological and scientific notions into the realms of human experience and imagination. Civilization often lags behind the advances in technological control of the world, and according to Bauhaus artist Laszlo Moholy-Nagy this lag is one of the root causes for excesses such as exploitation and war. In the current wave of interest in the ArtScience connection, a number of views on the interactions between art and science can be distinguished. A form of collaboration that has become almost common is one in which scientific concepts are seen as a p.11 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Are you an ambitious student looking for a study that matches your broad talents and vision? Are you creative, curious and looking for a place where you can ask your own questions and research these within an art context? Do you want to be able to freely choose and develop the artistic medium your project needs? Are you inspired by both the arts and the sciences? The ArtScience Interfaculty is situated between the Royal Academy of Art, the Royal Conservatoire and the Academy for Creative and Performing Arts of Leiden University. ArtScience has an interdisciplinary focus that intersects amongst others music, visual arts, media art, humanities and the natural sciences. The staff originates from a variety of artistic cultures and disciplines and is unique in its scope. ArtScience offers both a four-year bachelor’s, and a two-year master’s programme embedded in an interdisciplinary learning environment. The programme stimulates students to ask their own questions and create their own media of expression. Starting on day one, students participate in artistic research focussing on contemporary questions and resulting in the development of innovative artworks. The study stimulates students to reflect upon actual developments around us, this includes developments within the art world itself and also technological, social, political and scientific developments. We are interested in new forms of art and in new presentation places and methods. Furthermore we challenge students to question what future forms of art could look like. with these works and reflect upon them? How does making a model help in developing the original idea? How does making a work of art help to answer a research question? These processes will be shared and discussed with your fellow students and teachers, and the final works will be presented in public exhibitions and events. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide kind of ‘content’, and where the artist translates these concepts into images, sounds or other experiences. This can reduce the artist to a kind of scientific communicator, but in most cases it triggers radically new kinds of artistic development. Also it can result in works that help scientists get a new intuitive understanding of what it is they are doing, or works that comment on consequences of scientific developments. Another form of collaboration is one in which scientists or technologists assist in realizing an artistic idea. This can reduce the scientist or engineer to a kind of art facilitator, but more often the artistic idea itself is informed by a new awareness of possibilities. Also the artists can help trigger new directions of research by posing uncommon problems. A more complex and much more interesting zone between art and science has been described in two recent books. In his book ‘ArtScience’ (2008) David Edwards cites many examples from the worlds of science, art, civil society and industry that show how transposing ideas or strategies from one field to the other often results in radical innovation. ArtScience for him is an intermediate area of creativity where art nor science are clearly defined: stimulating this zone he considers to be one of the key strategies to foster innovation. In his ‘Information Arts’ (2002) artist and theorist Stephen Wilson gives an encyclopaedic overview of many new forms of art that have their origin in current science and technology. To discuss these forms he no longer considers the traditional artistic disciplines to be relevant, and in his book he proceeds to group these art forms under the headings of the main scientific disciplines. He argues that these new forms of art will not necessarily find a place within the traditional platforms for art, p.12 and will also not necessarily share traditional artistic concerns. The core idea that makes such collaborations and intermediate zones interesting is that art and science are both considered as types of exploration, and that they are thought to be complementary in many ways. Where science maintains an aura of objectivity and detachedness, in art subjectivity and critical engagement tend to be favoured. Where in science peer-review is the norm, artists are expected to be iconoclastic and original. Where science is expressed in formulas and text, art often exists through non-verbal experience. Ultimately, however, art and science share the aim to enlarge the scope of our ideas about the world. By inventing new media and new artistic languages, art can create new worlds of experience. By widening our imagination it also creates new kinds of thinking, as we cannot think about the things we can not imagine. As Gyorgy Kepes, founder of the Centre for Advanced Visual Studies at the MIT wrote in 1956: “The images and symbols which can truly domesticate the newly revealed aspects of nature will be developed only if we use all our faculties to the full - assimilating with the scientist’s brain, the poet’s heart and the painter’s eyes. It is an integrated vision that we need; but our awareness and understanding of the world and its realities are divided into the rational - the knowledge frozen in words and quantities - and the emotional - the knowledge vested in sensory image and feeling.” 2.2.3 An overview of the ArtScience Interfaculty At the ArtScience Interfaculty students and teachers are developing new forms of interdisciplinary art. The goal of the teaching programme of the Interfaculty is to investigate and possibly shape the intersection between artistic concepts and recent developments in science and technology. The Interfaculty is a collaboration between the Royal Academy of Art, the Royal Conservatoire and the Academy for Creative and Performing Arts of Leiden University. The staff comes from a variety of artistic cultures and disciplines that is unique in its scope. The ArtScience Interfaculty collaborates closely with the master’s programme MediaTechnology of the Leiden Institute of Advanced Computer Science (Leiden University). Within the Royal Conservatoire the Interfaculty has close links with the Composition department and the Institute of Sonology, within the Royal Academy with the ARlab. The bachelor’s programme aims to guide students towards an ‘autodisciplinary’ art practice: students acquire the skills, research methods and conceptual background necessary to develop their personal artistic work within the broad field of the arts and sciences. The ArtScience Interfaculty has a partly ‘open Apart from the collective activities, students are expected to do their own research and develop individual work, which is evaluated by all teachers in two presentations each year. Starting from the second year, each bachelor student chooses two personal coaches who advise in study choices and who reflect on the individual work of the student. Participants in the master’s programme are admitted on the basis of a research proposal, and depending on the research topic the student chooses two personal coaches. The three of them together then draw up a study- and research plan that will include course modules, projects and labs offered within the ArtScience Interfaculty and which can also include other courses from the Royal Conservatoire, The Royal Academy of Art or Leiden University. This choice will be based on both the research topic and the background of the student; also the ratio between self-study and course modules will be different for each student. Complementing this individual track are a number of introductory courses that are obligatory for all ArtScience master students. Also there are collective activities to stimulate the mutual contribution to the research of fellow students. The progress in the individual work is being monitored in evaluations by the ArtScience teachers two times a year p.13 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Every year, the programme of courses and projects is partly updated according to current themes from the area where art, media, science and technology overlap. Possible artistic responses to recent developments are formulated by experimenting with new contexts and forms in which art can play a role. This discussion is continually related to an interdisciplinary base in which the continuity between media art, music, theatre, film and visual art is considered to be self-evident. curriculum’: during most of the study, the students navigate individually through the teaching modules on offer within the Interfaculty and connected departments and institutions. At the Interfaculty there are four forms of group activities: research projects, labs, theoretical courses and practical workshops. 2.2.4 Goals of the programme Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The bachelor’s programme aims to guide students towards an ‘autodisciplinary’ art practice: students acquire the skills, research methods and conceptual background necessary to develop their personal artistic work within the broad field of the arts and sciences. A theoretical and practical basis is offered in the courses, but the core of the education offered at ArtScience isconsists of practice-based research: knowledge is acquired in the context of conceiving and realizing projects. In these projects students work together with the teachers and mostly together with other students and learn to collaborate and organize projects on various scales. Because of the open curriculum and the individual study trajectories this implies, students develop a strong sense of independence, self-organization and critical thought during the study. Because many study projects are presented outside of the school walls, the students are expected to be already active and well-connected in the field at the time of their final exam. Professional competencies The students are challenged to develop a range of professional competencies regarding three domains: // The artistic-technical domain // The professional world // The theoretical domain Within each of these domains students are expected to develop competencies within these areas: // Creativity // Critical reflection // Innovation and growth // Organizing // Communication p.14 / / External awareness / / Collaboration These competencies are the basis of the evaluation by the teachers at the end of each course module and they are also used to evaluate the presentations at the end of each semester. In turn, twice a year an evaluation meeting is held for the students to evaluate the programme and suggest improvements. Final qualifications of the bachelor’s programme At the final exam the students present a work that demonstrates their ability to work as a professional artist and which convincingly brings across an articulated and authentic vision on the arts. The graduate should have the following final qualifications: // Y ou create authentic work that comes from following your own artistic vision and contributes to the fulfilment of your personal ambition as an artist (creative ability) // Y ou are able to consider, analyse, interpret and assess your own and others’ work, and are capable of constructively considering your findings in relation to your own work (capacity for critical reflection) // Y ou are able to further develop the breadth and depth of your artistic practice in an ongoing process, and in this way contribute to developments in your artistic discipline (capacity for growth and innovation) // Y ou are able to establish and maintain an inspirational and functional working environment, and to organize your research, work and practice (organizational ability) // Y ou are able to effectively present and discuss your artistic vision, research and work (communicative ability) // Y ou are able to relate your artistic practice to both the artistic and social context (external awareness) // Y ou are able to make an independent contribution to a collaborative product or process (capacity for collaboration) 2.2.5 The structure of the programme Theoretical Courses and Seminars Starting in the year 2012-2013, students follow a programme consisting of five theoretical courses from the first until the third year of the bachelor. After an introduction to ArtScience, subjects covered in these courses are the theory and history of the senses, media (an)archeology, the philosophy of technology, science and art and the theory of interaction in art and nature. These courses run for six whole days over a period of six weeks, and consist of lectures, the reading of texts, group discussion and the preparation of written and verbal presentations by the students. At the end of each semester there will be a seminar of two days for all students and teachers of the inter- Together, these courses and seminars aim to give a theoretical and historical context to the research activities that take place in the Interfaculty. Through them, students also learn to do theoretical research, to articulate their thoughts in writing and to give verbal presentations about their work in connection with the work of others. Practical Workshops A large number of short, practical workshops are offered in four periods of three weeks, two for each semester. Each of these consists of two full days a week over a period of three weeks. Some of these short and intensive courses focus on specific techniques, skills and practical awareness, such as light, sound, editing, electronics, programming and form studies. One or two of them each year focus on subjects that are still experimental and speculative and that might become the subject of a research project next year. Every year, about one third of these short courses is changed, in order to be able to cover more ground during the four years of the bachelor’s programme. For the first year students there is a separate programme of these practical workshops. Each of these modules focuses on a number of medium-independent concepts, basic skills and sensory training that are essential to the ArtScience approach. Labs In the last three years, many of the activities at the Interfaculty have been clustered around six studiolabs that are defined by output media. These labs do everything in and there are aries between not pretend to cover the ArtScience field also no hard boundthe labs: they are p.15 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide With exception of the theoretical courses, the ArtScience Interfaculty has an ‘open curriculum’: within some constraints, the students navigate individually through the modules on offer within the Interfaculty and related departments and institutions. At the Interfaculty there are five forms of tuition: research projects, labs, individual coaching, theoretical courses and practical workshops. With the exception of the first year courses and theory courses, students can always choose between several options. For more information and the complete schedule, please refer to ArtScience studyguide 2013-2014 and the website. faculty, zooming in on current topics that emerge from the discussions in the individual courses. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide support structures and groupings of people who are involved in creating similar output. Each of these labs is a combination of a laboratory, a production facility and an ensemble of teachers, students, alumni and guests working there. Each lab is also a platform to offer coaching and space for projects by individual students, and a channel for the accumulation, documentation and dissemination of their research results and artworks. Every couple of years the focus of each studiolab is re-evaluated in order to keep up with developments in the field and with the evolution in our research interests. Bachelor’s students are expected to be a member of one or two of these studiolabs. They can switch labs during their study, but not during the semester. Students should document their own work they do in the lab over the course of the year and write a research report every semester. Each lab has a weekly working session of three hours during which students work on their projects together with the lab coach. In some of the labs these sessions are a form of group coaching, but in other cases (RecPLay and StageLab) these sessions tend to be more like group rehearsals. Some of the labs are facilities that are also open to lab members outside of the coaching sessions, and participation in all labs is also open to students from other departments within the KABK and KC. Furthermore, each lab initiates group projects that result in presentations outside of the walls of the school. These projects will in some cases be group projects, but in some of the labs these presentations will mostly be group exhibitions of individual works. Each lab also organises excursions and visits to performances, exhibitions and symposia. In time, every lab will publish its results in the form of books, dvd’s or other media. p.16 The labs are: RecPlay This studiolab is an extension of the RecPLay group that has existed since 2001. It deals with subjects such as audiovisual improvisation, improvised electronic music, realtime visuals and freestyle video, and the practical focus is on developing strategies for ensemble playing. The labcoach of RecPlay is Robert Pravda, complemented by Kasper van der Horst. StageLab In this lab, the esthetic and technical qualities of materials and instruments in relation to the body are investigated, with the aim to develop hybrid performance practices. Practical work includes body training, work with light and sound on stage and developing performances. The labcoach is Michiel Pijpe. Spatial Interaction Lab This lab deals with composing interactions by way of audiovisual interfaces, interactive spaces, robotics, physical computing, extra senses and interactive architecture. Its practical focus will be on hardware controllers, sensors, actuators and spatial use of sound and light. The labcoach of the Spatial Interaction Lab is Edwin van der Heide. Performative Instruments Lab The focus of this lab is on developing media performance tools, interfaces and performative installations. Research is done into existing practices and technologies, and the emphasis is on developing new works through a series of hands-on experiments. The labcoach of the Performative Instruments Lab is Kasper van der Horst, complemented by Robert Pravda. Tactile Research Lab This is a lab dealing with wearables, inflatables and new, active and responsive materials. Its practical focus will be on the skills that are necessary to ments out of The labcoach Lab is Cocky make physical environlightweight materials. of the Tactile Research Eek. c0d3l4b This is a lab dealing with the development of software for generative composition and generative art. Its practical focus will be on work in software environments such as Max/ Msp/Jitter, Processing, OpenFrameworks and LuaAV. The labcoaches of the CodeLab are Marcus Graf and Nenad Popov. Research projects The field covered by the ArtScience programme is very broad and dynamic. In order to avoid freezing our current approach in a fixed curriculum, we chose to cover this territory through an “inkblobstrategy”. Every year the ArtScience team chooses a number of topics that are explored in research projects that run over a period of six weeks, at least three days a week. Some research projects are collective projects with the emphasis on the production of art works and lead to a public presentation, outside the school walls. Other research projects focus less on the final result and more on the process of artistic investigation of the topic in question, producing artworks, prototypes Self-study, coaching and presentations We expect our students to start developing their personal niche in the field of the arts and sciences during their studies, and an important part of the education therefore consists of self-study: time to make personal work and to pursue personal research. From the second year of the study each student has two teachers who coach this personal work, reflect on it together with the student, offer a context for it, suggest literature and other sources of information and often assist in solving practical problems. As the study advances we expect from our students that they start showing their personal work outside of the school walls and start building up a network. Instead of making work specifically for the presentations twice a year, the student in this way evolves towards a situation where the work has been shown and developed outside the school before being shown at the presentations. This personal research is evaluated twice a year during the collective presentations at the end of each semester. At the end of the first semester, the students are asked to give a presentation of their research, explaining their topic, progress and methodology and illustrating this with (documentation of) experiments or finished works. p.17 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide AR Interactions Lab Since a number of years the KABK has been collaborating very actively with the TU Delft in the development of new approaches to the use of Augmented Reality in art and design. Since 2010, the Interfaculty ArtScience and the masters programme Mediatechnology in Leiden have been playing a more active role in this project and made the lab more available to their students. The AR lab at the KABK is not an ArtScience lab in a similar way as the labs mentioned above, but it is open for individual projects by the students and undertakes group projects a few times per year. and documentation in the form of papers and audiovisual registrations. In the research projects, students also learn to develop ideas collectively and become involved in the organizational aspects of preparing a public presentation. Examples of recent research projects are: groWorld: Borrowed Scenery Alternate Reality Narrative, Pyramids: Monuments for Late Capitalism, Structet II: Building Music and Musurgia Universalis: the Return of Athanasius Kircher. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide At the end of the second semester, the students are asked to present a finished work, together with a short, verbal explanation. Both presentations are evaluated in a discussion between the student and all the core teachers, during which also the general progress in the study is discussed. The evaluations are based on five criteria and five student qualifications. The criteria to evaluate the research and presented work are: the artistic quality of the core concept, the quality of the research process, the consistency of the work, the quality of the presentation or the quality of execution of the work, and finally the poetry of the result. The progress of the student is evaluated based on five student qualifications: the visibility of artistic identity, the ability to reflect on the student’s own process, the ability to innovate, the ability to communicate and the awareness of context and current developments related to the research topic. Public Toolkit This course is focusing on professional preparation. An important part of this course will be a reflection on the position of the student in the field, a discussion that is especially important for students ArtScience, since there work can often be presented in very different contexts. Curators and organizers from the media arts, experimental theatre, the visual arts, sound art, music and the creative industry will be invited to elucidate practical and organizational aspects specific to their field. Practical aspects like the writing of project proposals and a business plan, publicity, and documentation will be discussed, together with the financial aspects of being a self-employed artist. Alumni will be invited to share their experiences. Related to this course is the academy-wide course ‘Writing a business Plan’. ‘Writing a business plan’ is forms part of the ArtScience curriculum. p.18 Thesis The fourth year bachelor’s students are asked to write a thesis in the first semester of their final year. The aim of the thesis is to articulate a theoretical and historical context for the students’ own work by investigating a topic that relates to it. Students are encouraged to develop personal forms of writing that fit their research topic, but should demonstrate their ability to do theoretical research, find good sources and discuss work by other artists that is related to their own. Individual study trajectory and portfolio Many kinds of individual activity can be part of the individual study trajectory, such as a personal research project, an internship, an international exchange, taking part in a production, attending symposia, initiating a production, organizing a festival or writing a research paper. When approved by the individual coaches such activities can be awarded study points. A written report and documentation of such a project should be included in the portfolio. Part of the individual study trajectory will consist of courses outside of the ArtScience Interfaculty. Likely choices are the Introductory Courses offered by the KABK (Moving Image, WebDesign, 3d-animation, Sound) and the courses offered at the MediaTechnology master of Leiden University. Apart from this a very wide spectrum of courses within the Royal Academy, the Royal Conservatoire and Leiden University are available. In the past students have followed courses in amongst others Sonology, Singing, Percussion, Photography, Print Making, Art History, Philosophy, Electronics, Sociology, Bio-informatics, Art and Genomics, and we would like to encourage students to explore the many other possibilities and surprise us. Points for elective courses are awarded on the basis of exams passed, certificates, a written report or another form of documentation that should be included in the portfolio the student is compiling over the course of the study year. Before the presentations in June, the teachers look at the portfolio’s of all the students and discuss their participations in lessons and extra activities. On the basis of the portfolio and their own experiences they then evaluate the year of the student and confirm the study points for courses followed outside the Interfaculty and for extracurricular activities. Credit Points (EC points) are assigned two times a year, at the end of each semester before the presentations. Each credit point represents 28 hours of study and students should earn a total of 60 credit points per year. Credit points for participation in courses, labs, research projects, KABK introductory courses, MediaTechnology courses and other KABK and KC courses are assigned on the basis of the evaluations given by the teachers of those courses. The credit points for the individual study trajectory are assigned on the basis of written reports or other forms of project documentation. The student is expected to compile a portfolio containing the documentation of individual projects and documentation of the activities in research projects, labs and other courses. The points for extracurricular activities are assigned during the evaluation of the portfolio at the end of May. Successful presentations of individual work earn eight credit points. Failed presentations must be repeated one or two months later, or at the end of the following semester. In the first year, students are required to be a member of two labs and to take part in two research projects. In the second and third year, students should take part in at least three labs or research projects. In the fourth year, students should take part in at least two labs or research projects, while the student should be member of at least one lab. 2.2.7 Admission to the bachelor’s programme of the ArtScience Interfaculty To be admitted to the bachelor programme ArtScience we ask you to demonstrate your artistic talent, intellectual curiosity and affinity with many artistic disciplines. You’ll be asked to show examples of earlier work and explain your motivation to study at the ArtScience Interfaculty. In order to be admitted to the entrance examination we ask you to send us a letter of motivation, a curriculum vitae (resume), a portfolio and a number of official documents. Also all candidates should submit their response to the assignment described below. All written materials should be in Dutch or English. Please refer to http://www.interfaculty.nl and the ArtScience studyguide 2013-2014 for the most up to date information regarding the dates for entrance exams. All candidates are asked to fill in the online admission form on www.kabk.nl. p.19 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide 2.2.6 Credit Points Overview In order to pass the propaedeutic exam the student should have enough points and should have passed both presentations, all of the first year courses, the academy-wide first year courses and the Introduction to Electronics. Students who fail to pass their propaedeutic examination within two years are not allowed to continue their studies. After this, candidates are invited to contact the study coordinator (coordinator@interfaculty.nl) for a short personal interview with the head of the Interfaculty, in person or via Skype. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide After this first assessment, candidates are invited to send the materials we ask for an application, as described below, in order to be invited for an interview. European candidates are expected to by physically present at this interview, with candidates outside of Europe we will propose a Skype meeting. Letter of motivation In the letter of motivation we ask you to give an overview of where you stand now in your artistic activities and to describe your vision for the future. The letter should cover the following points: // please give us some background to your artistic past; explain the motivation behind getting involved in art and behind the artistic choices you have made so far; // please describe the artistic disciplines you have been involved or interested in so far; // please describe the main topics you are interested in concerning art, science and culture. For instance this can include specific art forms, subcultures, genres, styles, artists that inspire you, philosophical ideas, scientific research topics, developments in society etc.; // please give an outline of what you hope to achieve during your studies at the ArtScience Interfaculty; p.20 / / please describe how you think you will be able to contribute to the learning environment at the Interfaculty and to the arts after you completed your studies; / / please describe the artistic niche you imagine you will develop during your studies; / / please ask any questions you might have about the ArtScience Interfaculty. / / Curriculum Vitae (Resume) ›› This should cover: ›› our previous education; ›› your artistic past (see also portfolio, below); ›› musical instruments played (if applicable); ›› techniques mastered; ›› work experience; ›› languages. Portfolio In the portfolio you should show us documentation of works of art you made. The original works can be in any art form or medium, while the documentation should be a short text describing each work, illustrated with photos, drawings, reviews, etc. Please include audio and video, in which case you should mark a maximum of three minutes you absolutely want to be viewed or listened to by the selection committee. Digital documentation should run on both Mac and PC, can be on CD, DVD, usbstick or online and should use standard file formats (jpeg tiff pdf mp3 flash aiff quicktime avi powerpoint).Please do not send us originals; for practical reasons we can not always return your portfolio. Assignment As part of the entrance examination we ask you to send us a proposal for a work of art you would like to make. The only requirement for the proposed work is that it should appeal to at least two senses, in most cases sight and hearing. The proposal should consist of a written description and include sketches in image, sound or other media. For the entrance examination we ask you to bring a 3D scale model of the work of art you propose (this does not apply to non-european candidates). Official documents BA candidates should fill in the online admission form on www.kabk.nl. A copy of the candidate’s passport, a visa (when applicable), a copy of relevant diplomas, two passport photos, and email address should be included with the materials sent for the entrance exam. 2.2.8 Staff at the ArtScience Interfaculty Head of Interfaculty Joost Rekveld Coordinator: Leonie Zweekhorst Core teachers: Cocky Eek Arthur Elsenaar Edwin van der Heide Kasper van der Horst Michiel Pijpe Robert Pravda Joost Rekveld Taconis Stolk Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Guest teachers: Nadine Bongaerts Eva BrinkmanLex van der Broek Evelina Domnitch Dmitry Gelfand Vincent van Gerven Oei Marcus Graf Eric Kluitenberg Maja Kuzmanovic Gosse de Kort Katinka Marac Nenad Popov Paul Prudence Sanne van Rijn Joel Ryan Chris Salter Duncan Speakman TeZ (Maurizio Martinucci) Frank Theys Caro Verbeek p.21 2.2.9 Total overview of qualifications QUALIFICATIONS Creative ability Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Capacity for critical reflection Capacity for growth and innovation Organizational ability Communicative ability External awareness Capacity for collaboration PROPAEDEUTIC YEAR MAIN PHASE, YEAR 2 At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. p.22 the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. QUALIFICATIONS Creative ability MAIN PHASE, YEAR 3 MAIN PHASE, YEAR 4 At the time of printing this guide, You create authentic work that the specific final qualifications comes from following your own of this study year had not yet artistic vision and contributes to been finalised. Please refer to the fulfilment of your personal the website for the most up-to-date ambition as an artist information. Capacity for critical reflection You are able to consider, analyse, the specific final qualifications interpret and assess your own and of this study year had not yet others' work, and are capable of been finalised. Please refer to constructively considering your the website for the most up-to-date findings in relation to your own information. work At the time of printing this guide, You are able to further develop the the specific final qualifications breadth and depth of your artistic of this study year had not yet practice in an ongoing process, and been finalised. Please refer to in this way contribute to develop- the website for the most up-to-date ments in your artistic discipline information. Organizational ability At the time of printing this guide, You are able to establish and the specific final qualifications maintain an inspirational and of this study year had not yet functional working environment, and been finalised. Please refer to to organize your research, work and the website for the most up-to-date practice information. Communicative ability At the time of printing this guide, You are able to effectively present the specific final qualifications and discuss your artistic vision, of this study year had not yet research and work been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. External awareness At the time of printing this guide, You are able to relate your the specific final qualifications artistic practice to both the of this study year had not yet artistic and social context been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. Capacity for collaboration At the time of printing this guide, You are able to make an independent the specific final qualifications contribution to a collaborative of this study year had not yet product or process been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. p.23 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Capacity for growth and innovation At the time of printing this guide, 2.2.10 Study points overview ARTSCIENCE Year 1 2 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Practical Courses 4 5 4 4 2 2 2 Labs 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 Presentation 1: assignment 8 Presentation 2: propedeutic exam 8 4 8 Presentation 3 8 Presentation 4 8 Presentation 5 8 Presentation 6 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide 4 Course 8 Presentation 7: final exam 19 Excursion Ars Electronica 1 Research Projects (*) 6 0 or 6 6 Public Toolkit 6 6 6 6 or 0 4 2 Business Plan Writing 2 Organisation graduation preview 1 Research and Discourse 3 3 Theoretical Courses 3 3 4 4 4 ArtScience Seminar 1 1 1 1 1 1 3 3 5 or 11 9 or 3 6 6 Thesis 1 9 IST (*) Total 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 EC after individual assessment 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 EC after collective assessment 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 * In the third year, the research project can be done in either semester 5 or semester 6. It has a study load of 6 EC. If the research project is done in the fifth semester, 5 EC will be available for the IST in semester 5 and 9 in semester 6. If the research project is done in the sixth semester, 11 EC will be available for the IST in semester 5 and 3 in semester 6. 1st year: Due to the changed Research & Discourse programme minor adjustments of the EC is an possibility. p.24 2.3 Fine Arts 2.3.1 General description of the discipline History of the discipline Until the mid-nineteenth century, artists worked primarily on behalf of monarchs, the church and the upper middle class. Around 1850 the idea was introduced that art should not longer be made on commission, but purely for the art itself. The autonomous artist was born. Nowadays, in the beginning of the twenty-first century, artists make use of a huge range of artistic media, which can sometimes be clearly distinguished, while at other times overlap. As a result, the area has become multidisciplinary. Painting, once the main discipline, still plays an important role but no longer dominates. The fine arts represent, above all, a dynamic world in which firmly rooted traditions compete with fierce trends of innovation. The result is a constantly changing landscape where few certainties exist. Boundaries are blurring, not only between the arts, but also between the so-called high and low arts. There is no longer a dominant Western culture. Innovative cultural expressions can come from anywhere, from, for example, Africa, China, Korea or Mexico. This results in an international art and cultural production. New media (video, internet, etc.) have explosively expanded the artistic toolkit and scope. Artists do no longer exclusively position themselves as traditional creators, but also as researchers, entrepreneurs, commentators or engaged participants in social or political processes. They reveal hidden qualities, provide critical commentary on social phenomena and/or are actively involved with these phenomena. Female artists are increasingly setting the tone in artistic discourse. Today, photography, video and other lens-related disciplines are flourishing like never before. In the digital world, Internet users appropriate and process countless images and transmit them as new works of art. The current situation creates an enormous number of opportunities, but also poses new challenges for the arts and art education, which can only be successfully addressed if they are understood and accepted. The Fine Arts department addresses these issues with vigour. p.27 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Artists were forced to reconsider and redefine themselves and their public function. The twentieth century thus became the century of the self-aware modernist movement that was characterised by its high appreciation for experimentation and innovation. In concurrence with the far-reaching technological, political and social developments of the era, new types of artists were born and old types considered lost forever, were reborn. After the Cold War ended, the internationalisation that was manifesting everywhere also conquered the art world. The confrontation with previously unknown aesthetic cultures yielded hopeful amalgamations, but also put pressure on established (Western) art notions of modernity and autonomy. Current situation of the discipline Traditional stylistic or thematic issues no longer dominate contemporary visual art. Although the artist who works on his oeuvre in the privacy of his studio will continue to exist, there are other artists who have developed a keen sense for the changes in society and have decided to actively place their work in that field. The vast increase of mobility and means of communication have led to the emancipation of cultural areas that were hitherto considered to be fairly obscure. 2.3.2 Study profile Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Below we describe the professional profile on which we based the programme of the Fine Arts department at the KABK. Visual artists create art to give significance and meaning to the lives of others and their own. By doing so they fulfil an important social function. In the professional field, their work is appreciated for the authentic way in which they express their artistic vision and ambition in the public domain, and also because of their innovative ideas regarding the discipline of fine art and how those ideas can function in a social context. The work of visual artists appears in many different forms, from material objects to materialised (thinking) processes, performances, business ventures, lectures and other verbalized concepts that are visual and/or theoretical in nature. International setting The international setting has become an important element in contemporary professional practice: the playing field of the young artist has grown immensely. This makes him an artistic nomad, who may or may not travel the world to find hotspots, or places that are on the verge of becoming one, to present work or proposals for new work. In addition to producing work, it is becoming increasingly important that the contemporary artist is able to claim a position in artistic and social environments. He is a researcher, producer, networker, organiser and administrator all at once, and employs this combination of functions to achieve his artistic ambitions. Description of the study programme The propaedeutic year is specifically tailored to the fine arts, with orientation, selection and reference as its objectives. Specific to the department Fine Arts at the KABK is the division of the programme into p.28 four (small) departments after the propaedeutic year, the so-called sections: / / Free Graphics / / Painting / / Interdisciplinary Attitudes / / 3D The content of these sections depends on the conditions of the funding structure and its relevance in respect to the field. The part-time programme, because of its lesser number of contact hours, is separated into the sections 2D and Interdisciplinary Attitudes after the propaedeutic year. These sections represent the differentiation from the full-time programme. After obtaining the propaedeutic year diploma, the student chooses to continue his studies in either the 2 or 3 Dimensional domain. In the third semester, the teams of lecturers from Free Graphics and Painting partially merge to intensively confront students in the 2 Dimensional domain with the disciplines of graphics and painting. In each block, one of the disciplines is the subject of an extensive assignment. The same happens in the 3 Dimensional domain with the teams of lecturers from Interdisciplinary Attitudes and 3D. At the end of the third semester the student chooses on of the four sections to graduate in. This set-up creates the necessary conditions for working in small student groups, and for the organisation of specific workshops, external activities and guest lectures in the sections. In the sections we create a climate in which the boundaries of the discipline are examined and exceeded. Here we build the foundation that enables interdisciplinarity. If the development of the student gives cause to a change of section, he is able to change on the basis of his own, well-motivated, initiative or on the advice of his team of lecturers. Inspirational contacts between students of different sections are encouraged, and in the course of the academic year numerous cross-section activities and projects take place. studies with a final exam is able to independently research on behalf of an authentic oeuvre and by placing his work in the public domain. He is also aware of the context in which his art practice develops, both in an autonomous as in a commissioned situation. Final qualifications Fine Arts The programme is aimed at creating an understanding of the conditions under which that happens, and stimulates the ambition to excel, partly because of a teaching staff with international professional practices. The programme is centred on the idea that the artist is part of the national and international social mechanism, and that the artist has a function in it. The artist defines his significance in this context by discovering, developing and expressing his own abilities and ambitions. The reservoir of past and present artists’ knowledge and skills, and their theoretical and practical positions plays a critical role in this. The curriculum and associated teaching methods are consequently strongly orientated on the world around us. The student is challenged by the various teaching formats in the curriculum to discover and reveal his talents and ambitions. He does so in a continuous process of clarification, revision and renewal, with the perspective of a lifelong artistic practice and building an oeuvre of international stature. A student who has successfully completed his // Y ou create authentic work that comes from following your own artistic vision and contributes to the fulfilment of your personal ambition as an artist (creative ability) // Y ou are able to consider, analyse, interpret and assess your own and others’ work, and are capable of constructively considering your findings in relation to your own work (capacity for critical reflection) // Y ou are able to further develop the breadth and depth of your artistic practice in an ongoing process, and in this way contribute to developments in your artistic discipline (capacity for growth and innovation) // Y ou are able to establish and maintain an inspirational and functional working environment, and to organize your research, work and practice (organizational ability) // Y ou are able to effectively present and discuss your artistic vision, research and work (communicative ability) // Y ou are able to relate your artistic practice to both the artistic and social context (external awareness) // Y ou are able to make an independent contribution to a collaborative product or process (capacity for collaboration) p.29 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The final phase, the fourth year, is concluded with the final exam where the student demonstrates in an exhibition and thesis that he is qualified to start a professional practice. Throughout the programme, the student is made aware of the fact that the programme is the basis on which he can further develop his personal artistic ambitions and abilities in his future professional practice. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Diploma Graduates are awarded a Bachelor of Fine Arts (BFA) and are then eligible to enter post-graduate programmes in the Netherlands or abroad. Post-graduate studies After receiving their Bachelor’s degree, graduates can enrol in a master’s programme in design (M Design) or art (M Fine Arts) or another master’s programme at an art academy. Our graduates have continued their studies at: MAR (Master Artistic Research) at the KABK, the Frank Mohr Institute Groningen, Sandberg Institute Amsterdam, Post St Joost Fine Arts Breda, Piet Zwart Institute Rotterdam and the Dutch Art Institute Enschede. It is also possible to apply to the so-called third phase programmes: the Rijksacademie or De Ateliers in Amsterdam and the Jan van Eijck Academy in Maastricht. Many alumni choose to continue their studies abroad, for example in Glasgow, London or New York. Admission procedure The candidate is first invited to an exploratory interview, where he can ask questions about the programme and is questioned about his own artistic ambitions and social and cultural orientation. After this conversation the candidate receives, if he is deemed suitable to participate in the admission procedure, an invitation for the entrance examination. When the candidate fails in only certain respects, he is given an additional assignment that will be assessed separately during the entrance examination. During this examination, the candidate shows a varied selection of his work to the admission committee of the programme, including dummies, sketches, blueprints, digital files, movies and notes of ideas. The admission committee consists of teachers and students. p.30 Specific admission requirements / / The candidate must demonstrate: / / a constant tendency to transform experience and imagination into two and/or three-dimensional products, movies, DVD’s and so on, which testify to an early sense of artistry; / / a developing grip on the formal issues related to the above; / / the need to enter the public domain with these works; / / a developing awareness of his artistic context; / / an inquisitive, self-critical and ambitious attitude. The candidate is considered for acceptance when he shows a persistent tendency to transform experiences and imaginings into two-or three-dimensional images, when he has a budding sense of artistry, and when he demonstrates the start of his development of insight into the artistic context. Candidates who are potentially suitable for the programme, but who show specific shortcomings, can be given an assignment or task after the exploratory interview. The results are discussed during the entrance examination. 2.3.3 Study programme overview full-time / part-time The Fine Arts programme at the KABK is offered as full-time and parttime education, both which have to be completed in four years. Applicants for the part-time programme in the academic year 2013-2014 are accepted on the condition that there are sufficient registrations for the first year. After the propaedeutic year, students choose either the 2 or 3 Dimensional domain for the third semester. For Propaedeutic year The propaedeutic year consists of a study programme of 60 EC. During this year, the development of talent is linked to the orientation of the main phase, the student’s artistic practice and the research into the student’s suitability for the programme. The propaedeutic year includes elements in which all disciplines of the main phase are featured, and it also includes the courses General Art History and Field Orientation that place the student in the middle of a very lively art practice, by means of visiting studios, galleries and museums. The programme is scheduled in four sessions (afternoon/evenings) of theory and practice courses. The courses and credits can be found below. in their studios and learn, at the hand of numerous assignments, to create a production flow of visual works, to investigate the works for weaknesses and strengths, how to publicise work, in what artistic and social context they operate, and what the business and professional aspects of an artistic practice entail. The description of the main phase and courses can differ for the full-time and part-time programmes due to a different set-up. Part-time students can have a studio in the final year of study. Final Phase The last two semesters of the main phase are referred to as the final phase. This final phase is concluded with the final exam, in which students must demonstrate with a coherent set of authentic works, which are presented in a convincing way, and a thesis, that they meet the qualifications necessary to become a professional artist. The work must ‘speak’: the student talks about his work and his thesis, and in the following conversation the student is questioned on his motivations, the way of exhibiting and his ambitions for the future. The graduation candidates from all sections organise a pre-exam exhibition at the end of the seventh semester, where they are responsible for solving the problems associated with making an (group) exhibition. The exhibition takes place outside of the academy at a location the students choose themselves. The main phase, including the final phase, consists of three academic years, or six semesters. For courses and distribution of credit points, see the overview below. Main Phase The curriculum in the main phase is arranged as a foreshadowing of the professional practice. Students work p.31 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide the fourth semester students have to choose one of the four sections. In the part-time programme, students make a choice after the third semester between the 2 Dimensional and the Interdisciplinary Attitude domain. The different sections are represented in these two domains. Teachers advise students in their choice. A strong and continuous line of learning characterizes the entire four-year programme. This means most of the propaedeutic year teachers also teach in the main phase and adapt their courses to the study programmes of the higher years. Party because of this, students are able to make an informed choice at the end of the propaedeutic year, and parttime students in the fourth semester, between the 2 or 3 Dimensional domains. During the course of study there are several occasions when, if a section change enhances the development of the specific talents of a particular student, students can transfer to a different section. 2.3.4 Educational and professional goals The programme is described on the basis of three, partly overlapping, areas of competence: // artistic technical domain; // theoretical domain; // professional social domain. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Artistic technical domain In the artistic technical domain students mostly develop their creative ability and the capacity for critical reflection. These abilities or competences are considered the most characterizing and important for graduating students in fine arts education. All art and design courses develop the students’ abilities in this domain. Theoretical domain Making art and designing is intellectual and investigative work. Art and design are evaluated on the basis of artistic objectives for their relevance to (inter-) national standards of professional practice. This implies the necessity for the artist or designer to possess adequate theoretical knowledge of the field. Professional social domain This field touches upon most of the competences or abilities addressed: capacity for critical reflection, capacity for growth and innovation, organisational competence, situational awareness and collaborative competence. Propaedeutic year Competences propaedeutic year The student needs to master the following competences during this phase of the programme: These competences are under construction, please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. / / Creative ability: The student is able to independently apply the acquired skills and knowledge to the production of his work, and to complete the given assignments in coherence with his artistic ambition. / / Capacity for critical reflection: The student is able to reflect on his work and can evaluate its quality and effectiveness. / / Capacity for growth and innovation: The student acquires new knowledge, skills and insights and is able to apply them on a theoretical and practical level. / / Organisational competence: The student is capable of organising internal and external factors in order to facilitate an effective and inspiring work and research process. / / Communicative competence: The student is able to speak about his work and development, and can indicate his position in the contemporary art world, both verbally and in writing. / / Situational awareness: The student demonstrates a strong interest in historical and contemporary art and its social significance, and is able to actively participate in critical analyses of his work and that of others. / / Collaborative competence: The student is able to make a p.32 positive contribution to group projects, excursions and the pedagogical climate in the classroom and the academy. The propaedeutic year competences are activated by the offered courses, in the framework of the orientation, selection and referencing phase of the programme (see Description of Study Programme). The student’s organisational competence is activated by learning to organise the formal problems that occur when connecting content to form, and are inextricably linked to the process of making: first you create something, which is followed by critical reflection and assignments for new work, but it is also the incentive to review the production process and adjust its formal aspects. The theoretical aspects of organising are discussed in the course Field Orientation, in which the student is confronted in an intensive programme with professional practice and its organisational aspects. In the second semester the student learns to document his development in the form of a portfolio. Additionally, students participate in an Inauguration Programme and keep a file in which they keep track of their developments and comment on them. The Inauguration Programme is a cycle The course General Art History sheds light on the principles and factors that have shaped art and culture from the early days until Romanticism. During the propaedeutic year the students develop their collaborative competence by organising presentations for evaluations and progress meetings together with their peers, by joint ventures during the Open Day, and by making proposals in groups for the academy-wide project week. Moreover, the didactic climate encourages students to learn from each other’s insights, ideas and problems. Artistic technical domain The general visual development in the propaedeutic year concerns the acquiring of skills associated with aspects of working in 2D, in the course Drawing 1,2 and 3. Drawing 1 covers observational drawing, where eye-hand coordination is practiced on the issues of shape, size, plasticity, tonality, colour, line, composition, materiality etc. Drawing 2 deals with observational drawing on the basis of the imagination. Drawing 3 concerns drawing as a tool for research, idea development and processing. In the courses Painting and Graphics, watercolour, oil and p.33 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The ability to create is encouraged in all the practice courses, by assignments in the 2 Dimensional, the 3 Dimensional and lens-related and digital spectrum of the visual arts. The same goes for the capacity for critical reflection and the capacity for innovation and growth, because the results of the assignments are analysed, by teachers and students, for their formal and substantive qualities. The results of these analyses fuel new assignments. of exhibitions at various locations in the academy, where students are introduced to all aspects of making a solo or group exhibition: setting up, design invitations, opening the show, public discussion documenting, cleaning. Their communicative ability is developed in all situations that force students to present and explain their own or other’s work: in the Inauguration Programme, in the reports they write for the course Art Orientation and during the presentation for the course General Art History. The situational awareness of the students is developed in the course Field Orientation, and during excursions such as the annual trip to Berlin, the Venice Biennale and Documenta. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide graphic techniques are covered. The course Spatial encompasses all aspects of working with and in space, in the material in immaterial sense. The Optics course moves beyond the boundaries of the general formulation of the concept into the direction of the concept development, because the lens is seen as an extension of the eye and is used as a search tool that is able to collect personal topics and themes. The skills of cinematic expression are taught starting from the camera obscura, the analogue and the digital camera, to the video camera and digital imaging. Concept development Concept development is understood as the organisation of a step-by-step process, in which an inspiring idea is revealed and gradually conceptualized through theoretical and practical means. The process starts with the visualisation of an inhibited idea, and then the idea is captured in sketches followed by models, designs and drafts, and finally a suitable context for the idea is researched. The new course Meaning plays a central role in this process, supported by the course Drawing 3. In the second semester one session is reserved for the so-called free space, which anticipates the Individual Study Trajectory in the main phase. The first year has no supporting courses, other than the film programme, which can be seen as an annex to the General Art History course. The film programme PLAY/TIME presents monthly screenings of film history classics accompanied by an introduction. Theoretical domain The General Art History course covers the developments in art and architecture from the early days to Romanticism at the hand of ‘A World History of Art’ by Honour and Fleming, and various articles. Each semester is concluded with an exam- p.34 ination, students are given writing assignments, and give presentations at least once a year. In the first semester of the second year students go on excursion to Berlin. This excursion is prepared for by attending a lecture series on the cultural state of the city in relation to historical, political, social and geographical factors. This cycle is concluded with an examination. The excursion includes visits to institutions of classical and modern art, artists’ studios, theatres and architectural points of interest. In the course Field Orientation students investigate the field of tension between artistic ambitions and how these ambitions can function in the public domain by visiting places where this tension is generated and/or expressed. These places are, for example, studios, artists’ initiatives, galleries and museums. Conversations and interviews are part of these visits and students write up their findings in reports. Professional social domain The career preparation in the propaedeutic year is taught in the course Field Orientation as described above. Students gain additional experience by participating in the Inauguration Programme, designing a trophy in a (simulated) professional assignment, organising the evaluation and progress meeting presentations, and assisting the graduates with the organisation of the pre-exam exhibition and the graduation show. After the first semester assessments, students intern for one week at an art-related situation or institution. Descriptions of the various courses are available in separate dossiers. Main Phase / year 2 Section profiles Section: Painting All conceivable forms of painting and drawing and amalgamations thereof, define the disciplinary domain. The most well known examples of this are the gouache, watercolour, oil and acrylic paint and tempera techniques. But where the transfer of images is, to a large extent, determined by colour, numerous other new means of expression occur in this domain, such as photography, animation, (cinematic) projections and digital media. Section: Interdisciplinary attitudes The section Interdisciplinary Attitudes is characterized by the absence of a disciplinary concentration or limitation. Students and teachers unite in an artistic ambition. By gradually revealing this ambition, the most suitable discipline or combination of disciplines is determined. Social structures provide material for research and productions. This results in theatrical productions, video installations and photographic works, and also drawings and/or paintings. Section: 3D The disciplinary climate of the 3D section is established in the second year. In this section, the classical sculpture is problematized in The student controls a significant part of his study material by creating works and reflecting on them. Because of this, the main learning objective for the second year is to start and maintain an on-going production of experimental and investigative visual products. The second year competences are related to achieving this. The described sections are imbedded in the part-time programme in two modular directions: 2D and Interdisciplinary Attitudes. The module 2D includes painting and free graphics, and module Interdisciplinary Attitudes also includes the 3D section described above. Differences may occur between full-time and part-time study programmes. Competences year 2 The student needs to master the following competences during this phase of the programme: These competences are under construction, please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information // Creative ability: The student is able to initiate and maintain the production of a wide and diverse selection of investigative visual works. // Capacity for critical reflection: The student is able to reflect on his own work and that of others, and can evaluate p.35 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Section: Free Graphics This disciplinary domain is defined by all conceivable graphic techniques, such as etching, lithography, woodcut, mezzotint, silkscreen and offset printing, and photographic and digital techniques. Working with various graphic techniques creates the possibility to print numerous copies of the work. An interesting option is then to create a unique work from the copies. Another possibility is to produce books, posters and artworks, and publish them periodically by traditional or digitised means. the ‘Large Model’ project, and the significance of space and three-dimensionality is researched in all its facets. This confronts students with the scope of contemporary ideas of sculpture and space. They are guided by research, assignments (some in the public domain) and presentations. This process has led students to create sculptures in the traditional sense of the word, architecture or proposals to that end, video installations and photographic works. its quality and effectiveness. // Capacity for growth and innovation: The student can make use of newly acquired knowledge, skills and insights, and the criticism of others to advance the development of his work. // Organisational competence: The student is able to create the ideal work environment that advances and enhances the production of, and reflection on, his work. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // Communicative competence: The student is able to discuss and explain his work and production process in oral and visual presentations. // Situational awareness: The student is able to research artistic and social settings to intensify his production of visual work and the reflection process. // Collaborative competence: The student is capable of collaborating with his fellow students and/or external parties, and employs the experiences gained by these collaborations to progress and intensify his production and research process. These competences are applicable to all sections. Although the competences are developed in the difference disciplinary frameworks, they are active for the entire department in the courses Content/form, Process, Transfer and Theory. Creative ability, the capacity for critical reflection and the capacity for growth and innovation are worked on in the Content/form and Process courses, where the constant flow of images is used as a study of the various aspects of the formation of meaning in an image, to investigate the articulation of size and space, to determine weaknesses and strengths in form and content, and to analyse p.36 the consequences that result from all of the above, in relation to the use of different media and disciplines. The theoretical component of the Process course stimulates the search for a suitable context, as a factor of growth and innovation. Students also develop organisational competence in the Process course, where the source materials and work plan function as documentation. Communicative competence and situational awareness are part of the courses Content/Form and Process/ Research, but it is mainly in the course Transfer and Theory where these skills are centralised by the making of exhibitions, the exercises in verbal and written communication about the students’ own and others’ work, and because these courses reveal historical and contemporary artistic contexts and the factors that have (had) a formative influence on these contexts. Collaborative competence is stimulated by the fact that the students, together with their peers, work in a large studio space, organise internal and external projects and exhibitions, and make a time and space planning for the evaluations and progress meetings. Artistic technical domain General visual development General visual development in the second year manifests itself in four distinctive sections within the field of study, and also in relation to the most important objective of the second year: the creation of a flow of images that is employed for numerous analytical and reflective interventions. / / In the Painting section, students paint and draw in all conceivable media, and various workshops are organised, such as a tempera workshop and a Photoshop course. / / In Free Graphics, students are acquainted with all graphic techniques by producing a thematic portfolio to which all students contribute. A bookbinding workshop provides students with the necessary skills to create the portfolio. / / Interdisciplinary Attitudes is, as the name states, an interdisciplinary environment, but also includes workshops in the fields of theatre, sound and various sensory fields. Concept development Concept development as defined in the propaedeutic year, is also applicable to this year and focuses on students gaining control of their flow of images in order to steer it in a recognisable thematic direction. Concept development is covered in all practice courses because students are searching for their theme in all elements of the curriculum. In the Process course students organise of a functional work environment, in order to create an effective foundation for the deepening and broadening of the research into the theme and/or artistic ambition. Additionally, the course Artistic Research is offered department-wide and enables students to apply concepts of process and research, and methods of materialisation, to their own research based on personal ideas and visual development. // electives and minors in collaboration with Leiden University; // optional activities in the framework of the Studium Generale and ‘t Hart; // the film programme; // guest lecturers who contribute specifically to internal and external projects. Theoretical domain Even though all practice courses have theoretical components, for example exhibition theory in the Transfer course, the addressing of metaphors, symbolism, style and stylization in the Content/Form course, and the theoretical component in the Process course, the Theory course remains the most important foundation for theoretical knowledge and intellectual skills. The theory programme for the entire department is set up as follows: students gain knowledge of art history from Romanticism to the present by attending lectures, taking day trips to exhibitions, and having group discussions in relation to a topic prepared by a fellow student. Students keep a sourcebook with inspiring texts and images, and each semester write a paper on a self-chosen topic from the field of art, and a statement about their own work, including motivation, inspiration, relationships with other artists and so on. Professional social domain The career preparation is constructed in two parts. The first part is integrated in its set-up. For example, aspects of professional practice are discussed during in-class group conversations. This also happens in other classes when necessary and p.37 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide / / In 3D, students research materiality, structure, design and meaning, and spatial quality and status. They create images and objects in all available materials, but the emphasis is on the ‘Large Model’, where students work on a sculpture based on a live model during the course of the year. This process includes all stages involved when producing of a ‘classical’ sculpture. Furthermore, a bronze-casting workshop is organised. Supporting courses Supporting courses are available in the form of various introductory courses offered academy-wide: Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide useful, according to the situation in the students’ studios. The second part of the preparation is programmed. Below you will find an overview of that programme, based on the programmes of previous years. An important element of the programmed part is the collaboration with external partners in the field. Some of the collaborations take place annually, while others differ year to year. The following elements are offered academy-wide: the course in Rhetorics/Context, the Inauguration Programme, presentations in project spaces, studio visits, and incidental internships with professional visual artists as part of the Individual Study Trajectory. Alternating per section and study year, the department collaborates with the following external partners: // Nest, The Hague // Committee Room, municipality The Hague // Filmhuis The Hague // Diligentia, The Hague // Mama, Rotterdam // Stroom, The Hague // Tent, Rotterdam // Metropolis M Second year students of all sections prepare group exhibitions, as prelude to an exhibition in the third year. Main Phase / Year 3 The completion of the second year has rewarded students with a rich harvest of formal and substantive questions. In the third year, these questions are employed in all sections for the research into their interrelation. p.38 Competences year 3 The student needs to master the following competences during this phase of the programme: These competences are under construction, please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information / / Creative ability: The student is able to create thematic and formal coherence in the continuous production of visual works. / / Capacity for critical reflection: The student can pinpoint weaknesses and potential strengths in the process towards thematic and formal coherence. / / Capacity for growth and innovation: The student is able to continuously develop his artistic ambitions by focusing on coherence in his work. / / Organisational competence: The student can organise his work and research process to such an extent as to optimally advance the revealing of thematic and formal coherence. / / Communicative competence: The student is able to discuss and explain the coherence in his work in oral and visual presentations. / / Situational awareness: The student increasingly positions himself in relation to artistic and social settings, which intensifies his research into thematic and formal coherence. / / Collaborative competence: The student is capable of collaborating with his fellow students and/or external parties, and employs the experiences gained by these collaborations to advance the research into thematic and formal coherence. Artistic professional domain General visual development The description of the second years’ general visual development also applies to the third year, with the difference being that all the produced works serve the research into the coherence of the artistic production. Central to this research is the continuing revelation of the personal artistic abilities and ambitions. All practice courses contribute to this, including the Theory course, in which students further develop their insight and understanding of their own situation by relating it to an inspiring and critical context. Concept development The description of the second years’ concept development equally applies to the third year, but additionally relates to the central objective of this study phase. The concept development is thus focused on the structuring of all formal and substantive questions that arise in the search for coherence, and the unveiling of the authentic artistic practice. The Process course is the most important in this development. Supporting courses Specific courses and workshops in the framework of the career preparation are described in the professional social domain below. The other possibilities of supporting courses are described under ‘Supporting courses’ in the Year 2 section. Theoretical domain In the third year, students are intensively confronted with various philosophical, aesthetic and social models of thinking. The teaching material consists of the book ‘De Donkere Spiegel’ (‘The Dark Mirror’) by Frank Vandeveire and a wide range of art historical literature, magazines and newspapers. The students learn to name artistic problems, concepts and principles, and get a hold of the theoretical issues present in their work. Each semester the student writes a statement about his own work and a research paper. The topic of the first paper is an art movement in relation to social development, and the second is the question ‘what is art’. At least once a year each student gives a presentation on a theoretical topic. At the end of the academic year, the student determines the subject of the thesis. For further information about the theoretical domain in year 3 please refer to the description of year 2. Professional social domain The activities described for the second year also apply to the third year. Additionally, projects and collaborations are organised for the third year students each year. These activities specifically relate to their stage of development. Students in all sections participate in the Documentation Workshop. This workshop consists of several sessions spread out over the academic year, and teaches students to: p.39 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The student’s creative ability, the capacity for critical reflection and the capacity for growth and innovation are further developed in the course Content/Form and in the practical and theoretical components of the Process course. Organisational competence is developed in, among others, the practical component of the Process/Research course, and communicative competence and situational awareness in the courses Transfer and Theory. The student’s collaborative competence is stimulated in a similar situation as described in the second year competences above, and happens in the course Transfer by means of several internal and external presentations and exhibitions. // document work for presentations and/or grant or subsidy applications; // compile and present a portfolio; // give verbal presentations; Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // write texts for presentations, grant or subsidy applications, job assignments and postgraduate studies. Additionally, students follow Finance and Business Plan courses, and participate in a Grant/subsidy Application Writing workshop and a workshop on presenting. Students in each section collaborate to organise an exhibition. The projects with external partners as mentioned in the description of the second year, are employed in the third year in relation to the students’ stage of development. Main Phase + Final Phase / final phase In the final phase, the learning objective is the full development of the personal signature in content and form, as has been revealed in the third year. All aspects of the research process, including the process-based structure in which it takes place, is tailored to the unique convergence of content and form. These aspects are addressed in the courses Process/Research and Content/Form. Furthermore, the student masters the practical and theoretical aspects of making his work public in the Transfer course, as well as the financial/administrative side of being an artist. The competences for this phase are related to this learning objective. Artistic technical domain General visual development All painted, graphic, sculptural and other disciplinary works are employed to hone down the merging of form and content. This is a process of refine- p.40 ment in the already acquired visual idiom, to which the practice courses and the Theory course contribute. The Theory course addresses inspiring and refining contexts in the theory lessons, through which students are encouraged to further personalise their work. Concept development Concept development, according to the definition given above, focuses on the structuring of all formal and substantive questions that occur when the student makes the final decisions (in the framework of the programme) concerning his theme and the form it will take. The Process course is of importance in this phase, and also the Transfer course, because the work tends to reveal itself more easily, in all its formal and substantive peculiarities, in public situations than in the studio. Supporting courses Supporting courses are not part of the final phase of the programme, except in the professional practice workshops and activities. These are described in the paragraph on the professional social domain. Theoretical domain In the final phase of the programme, the Theory course is primarily focused on the writing of the thesis, for which the student has decided on the subject at the end of the third or fourth year. The thesis is a report of a comprehensive investigation, which is related to the student’s work. It should show the student’s ability for reflection, an extensive understanding of the history of art and insight into the context of his work. The theses are discussed in groups in the first semester, and are individually supervised in the second semester. The minimum size is 25 pages of typed text, excluding images. The sourcebook is again a means of inventory, inspiration and documentation that is directly related to the student’s stage of development. Professional social domain Most of the external activities that are available in the second and third year are also available for fourth year students. attend guest lectures, workshops and lectures that are scheduled during the day. The following activities are organised specifically for fourth year students from all sections: / / The day of post-graduate studies: Dutch institutions that offer post-graduate studies present and international Masters are discussed. Third year students are welcome to attend on the condition it does not interfere with their schedules. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide / / The ‘Day of the Future’ consists of lectures on the local cultural policies (Stroom), presentations by het Fonds voor de Kunst (Fund for the Arts), lectures by various gallery owners and artists’ initiatives, presentations by the Chamber of Commerce, and talks by alumni from different years about their experiences after having graduated. / / The pre-exam exhibition: the exhibition is organised by students and takes place outside of the KABK building. It also includes a publication. / / The portfolio/networking day: artists’ initiatives, galleries and curators present themselves and view/evaluate students’ portfolios. / / The graduation show: the final show is the masterpiece (in all respects) of the starting professional practice. Graduating part-time students are able to use studio space at the academy during their final two semesters. Other part-time students follow the programme by attending classes or at the hand of individual talks. Part-time students can also p.41 2.3.5 Department organisation The head of department is responsible for the department’s policy and all aspects related to this policy. The team of lecturers reflects the content of the programme and its professional set-up. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide All teachers have a professional practice. Because of the diversity in experience and expertise, the student is confronted with numerous aspects and approaches of the discipline. Specific knowledge of the professional field is offered by means of guest lectures. Jeroen de Leijer Frank Lisser Alexander Mayhew Janice McNab Willem Moeselaar Anja Novak Johan van Oord Reinoud Oudshoorn Maria Pask Hans van der Pennen David Powell Ewoud van Rijn Hester Scheurwater Onno Schilstra Els Snijder Michel Snoep Elly Strik Martijn Verhoeven Pim Voorneman Head of Fine Art department Johan van Oord Coordinator Fine Art full-time Martijn Verhoeven Head of part-time programmes Ernst Bergmans Coordinators Fine Art part-time Willem Goedegebuure Onno Schilstra Team of lecturers Marijke Appelman Rachel Bacon Channa Boon Maura Biava Engelien van den Dool Irene Droogleever-Fortuyn Marion Duursema Pieter van Evert Willem Goedegebuure Christie van der Haak Cecile van der Heiden Eric Hirdes Anja de Jong Winnie Koekelbergh Ton van Kints Klaas Kloosterboer André Kruysen Frans Lampe p.42 Guest teachers in 2012-2013: Laurence Aegerter Karla Black Bonno van Doorn Blazej Ostaja Lniski Marcel van Eeden Nare Eloyan Robert Florzak Katinka van Gorkum Kaleb de Groot Voebe de Gruyter Sigitas Guzauskas David Haines Adosh van der Heijden Maria Hlavajova Roos Hoffmann Vlatka Horvat Karin de Jong Ad de Jong Robertas Jucaitis Heringa/van Kalsbeek Xander Karskens Frank Koolen Luk Lambrecht Kaisa Leka Christoffer Leka Joris Lindhout Eelco van der Lingen Rinke Nijburg Nishiko Olafur Olafsson Willem Oorebeek Femmy Otten Philip Peters Rory Pilgrim Willem Popelier Andrej Radman Arno van Roosmalen Niels Schrader Jim Shaw Marleen Sleeuwits Francesco Stocchi C. Torres Mayans Dani Tull Renee Turner Ola Vasiljeva Adam Zdrodowski Italo Zuffi Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide p.43 2.3.6 Total overview of qualifications QUALIFICATIONS Creative ability Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Capacity for critical reflection Capacity for growth and innovation Organizational ability Communicative ability External awareness Capacity for collaboration PROPAEDEUTIC YEAR MAIN PHASE, YEAR 2 At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. p.44 the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. QUALIFICATIONS Creative ability MAIN PHASE, YEAR 3 MAIN PHASE, YEAR 4 At the time of printing this guide, You create authentic work that the specific final qualifications comes from following your own of this study year had not yet artistic vision and contributes to been finalised. Please refer to the fulfilment of your personal the website for the most up-to-date ambition as an artist information. Capacity for critical reflection You are able to consider, analyse, the specific final qualifications interpret and assess your own and of this study year had not yet others' work, and are capable of been finalised. Please refer to constructively considering your the website for the most up-to-date findings in relation to your own information. work At the time of printing this guide, You are able to further develop the the specific final qualifications breadth and depth of your artistic of this study year had not yet practice in an ongoing process, and been finalised. Please refer to in this way contribute to develop- the website for the most up-to-date ments in your artistic discipline information. Organizational ability At the time of printing this guide, You are able to establish and the specific final qualifications maintain an inspirational and of this study year had not yet functional working environment, and been finalised. Please refer to to organize your research, work and the website for the most up-to-date practice information. Communicative ability At the time of printing this guide, You are able to effectively present the specific final qualifications and discuss your artistic vision, of this study year had not yet research and work been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. External awareness At the time of printing this guide, You are able to relate your the specific final qualifications artistic practice to both the of this study year had not yet artistic and social context been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. Capacity for collaboration At the time of printing this guide, You are able to make an independent the specific final qualifications contribution to a collaborative of this study year had not yet product or process been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. p.45 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Capacity for growth and innovation At the time of printing this guide, 2.3.7 Study points overview FINE ARTS FULL-TIME Year 1 2 Course 1 2 Drawing 1, Drawing 2 (*) 3 3 Meaning 3 3 Spatial 3 3 4 4 5 6 7 12 12 12 12 12 Programmed career preparation (**) 3 3 3 3 3 Integrated career preparation 3 3 3 3 3 Free Space 3 3 Graphics 3 3 Painting 3 3 ATT/3D Academy-wide propaedeutic year 1 project week End exam Professional field orientation 18 6 Week internship General Art History 2 2 Berlin excursion 2 2 Theory Research and Discourse 3 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 30 30 30 30 30 30 3 Thesis 6 IST Total 29 31 * Drawing 1 and 2 are taught spread out over semesters 1 and 2 ** Incl. Business Plan Writing in year 3 1st year: Due to the changed Research & Discourse programme minor adjustments of the EC is an possibility. p.46 8 3 Optics Main phase PAI/FR GRA/INT Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide 3 3 FINE ARTS PART-TIME Year Propaedeutic Module 1 module Semester 1 2 1 Drawing 5 5 4 Spatial I 4 Spatial II 2 Module Exam 5 6 7 12 12 12 12 2 3 4 4 4 4 3 3 Visual Development 4 4 Painting 4 4 Sculpture 4 2 2 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Orientation 2D/Interdisciplinary 2 Attitudes Main phase 2D/Interdisciplinary Attitudes Programmed career orientation a.o. presentations Integrated career preparation 2 3 4 4 4 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 End exam Art History 8 4 Photography Presentation collective assessment Module 2 24 Theory 5 5 5 5 Final thesis 6 Total 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 EC after individual assessment 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 EC after collective assessment 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 p.47 2.4 Photography 2.4.1 General description of the discipline Current situation of the discipline Almost everyone makes photographs and knows how to communicate with them. Nevertheless, students are still being educated to become professional photographers. Over the course of history, photographers have developed their own high-quality image culture. Contemporary photography covers an enormous spectrum and branches out into all levels of society and holds an important position in the world of the visual arts. A lot is demanded from a contemporary professional photographer. He does not only understand his profession in a technical and aesthetic sense, but has profound knowledge and an understanding of the meaning, symbolism, value and impact of the photographic image. In addition, he must possess the wide-range of artistic abilities necessary to achieve a desired effect or have it function inde- Contemporary professional practice: the professional profile Below we highlight the professional profile on which the Photography programme is based. The current professional is an author, in the sense that he is a maker, finder, and creator. He can practice the profession in the traditional sense and is able to help the evolution of the discipline. A photographer in our current time is an entrepreneur who knows how to create support for his work. He has an extensive frame of reference of the field and the discipline, particularly in an international context. He has a vision of the discipline’s position in the world of art and culture and in social developments. He is aware of the multitude of platforms that offer opportunities, such as the Internet and traditional journals. He has an extensive network of and is able to work with others. Our society is witness to an increasing number of people using the medium of photography without considering the technical quality of the images, and as a response, professional photography is seen to be moving in the opposite direction. Each genre or specialism has increasingly specific requirements. The professional practice of the photojournalist has become more significantly distinguished from that of the conceptual documentary photographer. This trend appears across the entire field of photography. As a consequence, the young professional has to comply with increasingly higher and specific demands. He should be well informed about how he wants to enter the professional field and on which p.49 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide History of the discipline Since the beginning of the nineteenth century, photography has evolved into an independent visual medium. This has had far-reaching consequences for socio-cultural developments from that time onwards. When the Kodak Company, founded in 1888, made photography accessible to the common man, the whole world started to take photographs and send them to each other. This became the basis of what later would be referred to as ‘the image culture’. Communication through photographic images has since been prominently embedded in our society. This has happened to such an extent that the images we encounter via media technology increasingly determine our view of the world. Simultaneously, the communicative power of these images influences and organises our lives. The virtual reality is becoming more and more important in relation to the physical reality. pendently. He must also claim a position in the contemporary cultural field and distinguish himself, which means he has to be able to express his personal vision verbally and in writing. platform he can present his work in order to be recognised as a professional. mind, and then vigorously research them. This requires an interest in the content, background, and diverse ways to represent a subject. 2.4.2 Study profile Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide As the only photography department at a Dutch art academy, we focus on the four major areas in professional photography: conceptual documentary photography, photojournalism (Documentary), fashion/lifestyle photography and photography on commission (Fiction). In the first year of study these areas are thoroughly introduced to the students. After the propaedeutic year, students choose for a threeyear programme in either documentary photography and photojournalism, or in fashion/lifestyle photography and advertising photography, where they position their work in one of these areas on the basis of further choices. They study in only one of these areas. The department’s objective is to educate students to become self-aware and independent photographers with a recognisable visual language and a personal vision, and who are able to work on commission and independently, by developing concepts and initiating projects. Their motivations, themes and ethical standards are evident to others. Characteristic of our programme is that we take the professional field of photography as our point of departure. Students are given assignments resembling, or based on, professional assignments, and usually work on several projects simultaneously. We pay close attention to how the student develops his initial ideas into to a final series, with all the accompanying production activities. Another characteristic is the strong emphasis we place on the development of intellectual and visual qualities. We ask the students to approach their subjects with curiosity and an open p.50 While investigating, the students develop their own visual language and discover how their vision on topics and on the profession of photographer relates to the visions of others. Our aim is to teach students how to be independent thinkers, who, from a personal vision on the medium as well as on the world, are constantly searching for authentic images. The curriculum consists of alternating work discussions, workshops and lectures and is dynamic in character. In a short period, students gain knowledge of various fields and develop skills to operate independently. Because their subjects are often situated outside the academy, students regularly work on location. In the academy they edit their images, work on prints and participate in collective work evaluations and the preparation of publications and presentations. The students thus do not only learn from their teachers, but also from their peers. The educational process is dominated by a commitment to continuously strive for research, authenticity, depth and professionalism, and is supported by a programme of electives and guest lecturers from the international field. Expertise from other disciplines is employed when necessary, which allows students to develop strategies to present their work optimally and in a suitable context. The main aim of our programme is to educate our students to become the professionals of tomorrow, who connect their own visual language with a professional way of working on a national and international level. Fiction as departure point for Photography: specialization “Fiction” ‘Documentary’ is the umbrella term used by the KABK for the professional practice of conceptual documentary photographers and photojournalists. Although the practice of photojournalists differs from that of conceptual documentary photographers, they are similar in their depiction of subjects with news value or with significance for the target group of the photograph’s medium. This practice is most commonly used to reflect on contemporary history or its documentation. These photographers identify with social processes and concrete subjects, wonder about them and are curious. Fiction at the KABK consists of the closely related sub-fields advertising photography and fashion/lifestyle photography. Fiction photographers are photographers who produce high-quality work from a staged situation or with the suggestion of staging. Most fiction photographers have impressive technical skills and possess an artistic streak that allows them to adequately represent their subject. They are strongly committed to their assignment. Photographers, who work from facts, offer us a window to reality. However, subjectivity is essential for their individual style. A position statement is important for the impact of their photography. These photographers must pay attention to the preliminary phase of research. This means they have to read about, and empathize with, the subject, consult specialists and tap new markets. The artistic autonomy enjoyed by these photographers is closely linked with the policies of the platform for which they work. Photographers who employ photography as an informative medium focus their loyalty on the user of the photos: the public. Yet there is a clear distinction between the photojournalist, who describes reality and is constantly aware of news value, and the conceptual documentary photographer. Both disciplines revolve around current events, but the centre of gravity of photojournalism is direct reporting while conceptual documentary photography will more likely be used to depict a subject. Their work is the result of intensive research into the nature of the image and photographic visual language in particular, and is intended to distinguish itself in the torrent of images. Therefore, advertisement and fashion photographers are increasingly developing their own concepts to work from. On the basis of their authorship they are active in different contexts, which they creatively adapt to suit their needs. They have a rich imagination, representational skills and a clear mind. The emphasis in their work is on the creation of concepts and the pursuit of the right visual presentation in combination with a sophisticated technical execution. They often collaborate in multidisciplinary teams. Final qualifications Photography The graduate meets the following final qualifications: // Y ou are able to develop an innovative concept arising from your artistic ambition and research, elaborate it into a distinctive image, product, means of communication or spatial design, and to contextualize it in a meaningful way (creative ability) // Y ou are able to consider, analyse, interpret and assess p.51 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Facts as departure point for Photography: specialization ‘Documentary’ your own and others’ work, and are capable of constructively considering your findings in relation to your own work (capacity for critical reflection) Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // Y ou are able to further develop your vision, work and working methods in breadth and depth through an ongoing process of research, and in this way contribute to your discipline and to society (capacity for growth and innovation) // You are able to establish and maintain an inspirational and functional working environment and to organize your research, work and practice (organizational ability) // Y ou are able to effectively present your vision, research and work and engage in a dialogue with clients and other interested parties (communicative ability) // Y ou are able to relate your artistic practice to the artistic and social context (external awareness) // Y ou are able to make an independent contribution to a collaborative product or process (capacity for collaboration) are discussed in the course of the morning and candidates get advice on how they might improve their work. It is recommended that candidates sign up for the trial-morning as early as possible. It is possible to participate in multiple trial-mornings. Candidates who are deemed suitable to apply receive an invitation for an entrance examination. During the entrance exam the candidate works on an assignment and the admission committee assesses the candidate on the basis of his portfolio and an interview. The work consists of a diverse selection of both visual and photographic work, supplemented by the home assignments. The candidate has one or more conversations about the work. The committee consists of students and teachers. Specific admission requirements The candidate should sufficiently meet the following requirements: / / has a passion for the visual, especially for the medium of photography; / / has a particularly broad social interest; / / has the need to constantly visualise his interests and ideas in photography; / / wants to make his own ideas public; Diploma Graduates are awarded a Bachelor of Design (BDes). / / has good communication and social skills; Post-graduate studies After receiving their Bachelor’s degree, graduates can enrol in a master’s programme in design (M Design) or art (M Fine Arts) or another master’s programme at an art academy, or the MA Photographic Studies at Leiden University. // t akes initiative and has an entrepreneurial spirit; Admission Procedure Candidates are invited for a trialmorning at the department. The portfolio and take-home assignments p.52 // h as organisational talents; / / h as perseverance; // c an operate both as a soloist and collaborate with others; // i s able to think critically; // i s also able to develop on a textual level; // i s somewhat aware of the infrastructure of the photographic field in the Netherlands; // d emonstrates some experience in the use of the medium to reach his visual goals; // w orks on photographs in serial form; // i s aware that photography is one of the visual disciplines and that this requires more than just excellent technical expertise or an eye for aesthetics. should be available for one full workday a week. For the set-up of the semesters in the full-time programme please refer to descriptions per year below. The part-time programme Photography has the same programme as the fulltime programme, but with a different organisation and set-up. No internship period is included in the programme (as of yet). Career orientation should therefore be independently undertaken in addition to the programme. Part-time students are able to follow parts of the full-time curriculum, albeit with permission. 2.4.3 Study programme overview Full-time programme The full-time programme covers four years. For the set-up of the semesters in the full-time programme please refer to descriptions per year below. Part-time programme The four-year programme is also divided into semesters. The programme consists of modules that together form a complete package and can also be taken separately (coming soon) on the condition that student’s level of competence is deemed sufficient. After the student has successfully completed the exam module he has met the final qualifications of the current bachelor’s programme in Photography. This educational set-up also allows us to offer the part-time programme in four years. The lessons are mostly given on two days; one day will most likely start at 14:00 and the second day at 16:00. The last class ends at 21:45. In the final phase students Individual Study Trajectory The Individual Study Trajectory (IST) is available for all students from the second year onwards, and has as aim to broaden and deepen the programme. To this purpose, space has been created in the schedule. The study load and appointed credits are allocated to the IST in consultation with the team of lecturers. There are several possibilities to organize the Individual Study Trajectory, such as to following a minor at Leiden University. In addition to the electives, students can use the IST to deepen the programme by giving more attention to the compulsory courses or by choosing from the academy-wide IST offer. The IST is accompanied by a study plan that requires the approval of the team of lecturers and is supervised by a coach. In the main phase, 12 EC are allocated to the Individual Study Trajectory. The part-time students can profit from the offer of electives mostly during the daytime. They are also allowed to take courses in the full-time curriculum (only if space is available and with permission). For general information about the IST please refer to the chapter 6.1.3. p.53 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Overview study full-time/part-time The full-time programme offers the specialisations ‘Documentary’ and ‘Fiction’. The part-time programme only offers the specialisation ‘Fiction’. Propaedeutic year (Exploration and visual development) Full-time / Part-time: semesters one and two Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The propaedeutic year programme is focused on visual development. The properties of photographic visual language are extensively researched, with technical skills supplying a solid foundation. The student’s individual abilities are explored in a wide range of subjects. These are, when possible, offered coherently. Field orientation of the discipline and its professional opportunities is centralised in the programme. This happens in both theory and practice courses, and also during field visits outside the academy. The emphasis is on learning to study and structuring the individual work process. The student is encouraged to pose questions to himself and attempt to find the answers. A coach and a professional practice programme for the general development of study skills support the study process. This phase creates the foundation for a professional attitude that enables students to develop their authorship necessary for their future after the academy. At the end of the year, the programme has provided sufficient insight for students to choose their profile for the rest of the programme. The motivation for this choice is reflected in a final presentation and in the composition of the portfolio. The course descriptions on the website describe the content, teaching methods, instructional forms and assessment of the programme components. The study components covered in the first two semesters are: // O rientation of the discipline // A cquisition of professional and study skills; // V isual development; p.54 / / C onceptual documentary photography, photojournalism, advertising photography and fashion/lifestyle photography; // P hotographic skills and digital techniques // T heory/art and photography history and reflection; / / G raphic design; // I nstruction software programmes, colour management, archiving and workflow. Main Phase / year 2 (In-depth research and professional competences) Full time/Part time: semesters three and four In this phase students engage in more extensive and substantive research into the world of photography and the professional practice of the chosen specialization: ‘Documentary’ or ‘Fiction’ (full-time only). Much attention is given to the competences required for the practice of the specialisation, with the social functioning and the development of social skills being the key concepts. The ethical side of the profession is also extensively discussed. Photography in ‘Documentary’ focuses on the acquisition of background information (research) on a diverse range of subjects before the actual act of photographing. In ‘Fiction’ photography the emphasis is on the creation of concepts and the pursuit of the appropriate visual execution in combination with a sophisticated technical execution. Students regularly work together in multidisciplinary teams. An important motivation is to change the attitude of involved third parties. Moreover, the student is confronted with the specific possibilities of applying his work in the following, very diverse, markets: // p rinted media newspaper, magazines, books; // v arious electronic media; // a utonomous museum space. / / Within these three frameworks, both specialisations focus on: // C onceptual photography: the image as guidance to and/or translation of ideas, texts, thoughts, experiences; The second year is also divided into semesters. Each semester is then divided into two thematic blocks (when possible). The themes are, where necessary, adapted to the chosen specialisation, or the three markets mentioned above. The course descriptions on the website describe the content, teaching methods, instructional forms and assessment of the programme components. Fixed course components applicable to both study profiles are: // g enre photography specific to the selected profile; / / a utonomous photography; // p hotographic and digital techniques; // i mage and concept development; // p rofessional practice skills; // a udio-visual media, AV and film theory (as elective after an introduction block); / / g raphic design; // i nteractive media and media philosophy (as elective after an introduction block); // s ociology; // c ommunication. Specific to the specialisation ‘Fiction’ are advertising photography and fashion/lifestyle photography, and for the specialisation ‘Documentary’ these are photojournalism and conceptual documentary photography. Main Phase / year 3 (Professionalisation) Full-time / part-time: semesters five and six Full time In the third year, the focus shifts from research and skills to ‘professionalisation’. The previously acquired knowledge and skills are placed in relation to the field and the professional practice. From a personal standpoint the student chooses to engage with the world outside the academy: the portfolio is geared towards this, and a thematic, project-based semester offers the student the possibility to test and define his position in the professional world. The components photojournalism and conceptual documentary photography are specific to the specialisation ‘Documentary’, and are supported by a course in Sociology. The specialisation ‘Fiction’ offers the sub-fields advertising photography and fashion/ lifestyle photography. In a related project description as a result of a research period, students substantiate their choice for one of these sub-fields. Special attention is paid to visual investigation, so-called artistic research, and the student’s ability to work with different visual strategies. The student works independently and makes highly individual choices. The realisation of the described plans and study content p.55 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // A utonomous photography: the photographer researches his personal artistic goals and possibilities. // a rt and photography history, theory and reflection; within the central project, as well as the possible participation in practice projects, is done in close consultation with the coach, fellow students and the team of lecturers. The programme includes a number of elements for students from all specialisations: // A utonomous photography; // P rofessional skills; // a rt and photography history, theory and reflection; Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // a udio-visual media, AV and film theory (as elective in the second year); // i nteractive media and media philosophy (as elective in the second year); // g raphic design; // v isual development aimed at spatial presentation. In the sixth semester, students intern at one or two internships. These internships are very diverse and are related to the specialisation and at least one of the markets mentioned above. During the internship students learn to work in teams, with formulated assignments, with a time limit and together with a client. In addition, the students gain useful experience about how to network. Moreover, the internship enables the students to test their expectations about their own possible specialisation in the field. At different moments during the internship, students return to the academy to discuss their experiences with the internship supervisor and to receive information about the internship report. These are also moment to exchange experiences with fellow students (second year students are also present in these meetings as preparation for their choices in the following year). The internship supervisor writes a report, which is part of the evaluation. For more p.56 general information on the internship, please read chapter 6.1.9. Part-time The part-time programme does not include an internship period. Therefore, the student independently initiates his career orientation, but it is still a part of the programme. In the sixth semester, the student enters the examination trajectory, in addition to a few fixed courses. This includes a properly substantiated choice of specialisation in relation to the discipline as a result of the professional practice orientation. The goals associated with this stage are that the student: // h as composed a study plan (professional profile), with an updated accompanying argumentation; // h as achieved the study objectives of the projects and programme components associated with this phase; // h as demonstrated to have gained the qualities, skills and insights to claim his position within the field of photography; // h as deepened his research; // d emonstrates an interest in all aspects of the work and design process and expresses interest in all aspects of the profession; // s hould be able to bring the final phase of the programme to a successful conclusion; // h as explored and experienced the field; // h as demonstrably prepared to become a professional photographer. Fourth year (Profiling and positioning) Full / part time: semesters seven and eight Full time / Part time This phase is characterised by ‘profiling’. The conclusion of the internship/ career orientation period is the prelude to the final year of study. Students write another study plan written with a revised professional profile: After the exam the graduating students focus on a group exhibition that is open to the public. A catalogue accompanies the exhibition. The examination consists of the director, the head of department and an external assessor, in addition to a representation of accompanying teachers from the senior year. The external assessor is an expert in the field of photography. 2.4.4 Professional objectives // p ractical documentary / photojournalistic / fashion/ lifestyle / advertising photography, related to the written professional profile; // p roject of the student’s choice, which relates to the chosen profile, presented in two of the presentation options/platforms: one that matches the methods of the professional practice and one that centralises the student’s possibilities for use (interdisciplinary); // t hesis, in which research for student’s projects is further expanded and explained; / / p ortfolio; / / c areer preparation. The final exam The programme is concluded with a one-day examination. Each student presents work that is made specifically for the exam, a well-designed thesis and portfolio. The professional profile, business plan and project descriptions provide information about the presented work. Each student is allocated a space where he can build up the presentation from at least four days prior to the exam onwards. On the examination day the student is given the opportunity to explain and justify his work. The exam committee poses additional questions. The propaedeutic year is concluded with an exam during which the student is assessed on the basis of his suitability for the discipline. The student presents and substantiates his work and shows its accents. The work done for theory courses is part of the exam. The study attitude, especially the student’s commitment and level of independence, in the work process are also taken into consideration. The vision and depth demonstrated in both the process and the end result are of importance in passing the exam, but also for the selection of the specialisation. The student must be deemed able to complete the programme in the specified period and then work as an independent photographer. The objectives are: // L earn to study and organise the work and design process. This includes the acquiring of knowledge, understanding and skills related to the employment of substantive and formal visual means. Apply the acquired knowledge, understanding and skills to improve given assignments. // D evelop an inquisitive, examining and self-critical p.57 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // e ntry in an international photo festival (IST) or participation in a prestigious competition; Propaedeutic year (Exploration and visual development) Full-time / part-time: semesters one and two attitude, own initiative regarding the work, verbal and written communication skills and reflective and analytical ability. // A cquire theoretical knowledge and insight regarding the study content of the project. // G ain technical skills related to photographic tools and techniques and 2D tools and techniques such as drawing, painting and graphic techniques. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // G ain insight into the desired professional field: editorial, commercial or otherwise. Competences The competences for the propaedeutic year are: These competences are under construction, please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information // T he student can create new work in which he explores new methods based on the experiences and insights he has gained through the programme. // T he student is able to reflect on his work and can evaluate its quality and effectiveness. // T he student demonstrates the will to make new discoveries and acquires new knowledge, skills and insights and is able to apply them on a theoretical, practical and photographic level. // T he student can organize his own work process and is able to document and archive his work. // T he student is able to substantiate his choice for, and deployment of, resources, materials and/or visual solutions. // T he student shows a broad interest in social, sociological and cultural developments and is able to distinguish different photographic visions. p.58 // T he student can achieve his own goals while collaborating with others. // T he student is able to substantiate his choice of specialisation. Artistic technical domain The development of a photographer/ image maker commences at the start of the programme. A professional photographer is not just someone taking pictures: he shows strong similarities with other artists in the visual arts. That is why the student’s general visual development is primarily prioritized in the curriculum. Additionally, attention is given to specific visual aspects related to the medium. The focal point is the work process with concept development as its goal. It is equally important that students develop skills with regard to photographic tools and techniques and in the digital field. Theoretical domain All propaedeutic year students are taught general art and cultural history and academic skills. Furthermore, students participate in a programme covering art and photography history and reflection, which offers them an extensive frame of reference. Students visit exhibitions and museums throughout the year, where they analyse and reflect on the work of others. This is done both verbally and in writing. Debating skills on various topics are developed in the course Field Orientation. In different courses students are asked to write reports. Professional social domain Professional development takes place throughout the year, mostly through self-study. Students are required to independently visit exhibitions and create and maintain a personal archive of reviews, book reviews and general information relating to the profession. In the module Career Orientation this is connected to the attitude necessary to work in the field and meet to the demands of the discipline. In addition, a project week focused on the professional field is reserved at least twice a year. In one of these weeks the students visit photographers, editors, agencies and bureaus. In the other project week students engage in fieldwork or visit a photo festival. Guest lectures are organised regularly in the academy in relation to current events in the field. Participation in lectures and workshops in the field is encouraged. Main Phase / year 2 The first part of the main phase has as its main objective to provide students with a clear understanding of the field and the professional practice of the specialisation ‘Documentary’ or ‘Fiction’. This means that the programme is both broadened and deepened. At the end of the academic year, the student’s professional competence must be fully applied to the creative process. This refers to both a command of the profession itself and the student’s professional attitude. The execution of assignments is therefore assessed according to the field’s requirements. Competences The competences for the second year are: These competences are under construction, please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. // T he student can undertake methodical and well-organised research and develop his own idea. // T he student can evaluate his own images and those of others on their content and visual and // T he student knows to use research to acquire new knowledge, skills and insights, and can appropriate external criticism to benefit the development of his work. // T he student is able to prioritise and time-effectively manage his work process. // T he student can interpret an assignment and express it in word and image. // T he student refers to social and cultural resources to formulate a precise hypothesis for his work, and he can name the target audience and aim of his photography. // T he student is able to collaborate with others and can apply his talents and those of others to benefit the collaboration. Artistic technical domain In the second year, the focal point of general visual development shifts to the replication and interpretation of methods. Students gain insight into the coherence of content and form by learning to control the creative process. Concept development is examined in different courses to create understanding of the working methods. This includes analysing assignments, substantive research, idea development, image development and implementation. It also allows students to broaden their work area with the electives Audio Visual Media and Interactive Media, which support the research into the possibilities of the artistic process. Theoretical domain Art and photography history and reflection are taught throughout the p.59 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide (Proficiency and in-depth research) Full-time / part-time: semesters three and four communicative qualities, and is able to justify the choices he makes in his photography. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide year, and students are encouraged to, in addition to the fixed course content, independently extend the framework by engaging in research related to the practice course and/or projects. The building of a personal file is indispensable in this research process. The student is also asked to substantiate his opinions. In the courses Film Theory and Philosophy of Media, which are chosen in conjunction with the electives Audio Visual Media and Interactive Media, the frame of reference is widened and compared to that of photography. The student is assessed in debates, at the hand of an exam and a paper. Professional social domain The demands of the functioning in, and influencing of, the profession(al field), are the points of departure for assignments in the curriculum and are the guidelines for the assessment. The method of working that is used in the field sets the criteria. Additionally, the practice courses of the specialisations are supported by the subjects Communication and Sociology, which focus on the start of the assignment, objectives, target audience and its consequences. Main Phase / year 3 (Professionalisation and presentation) Full-time / part-time: semester five and six The entire year is dedicated to career preparation. The student must now demonstrate he meets the requirements to make a unique contribution to the field and that he can live up to standards of the outside world. The objectives of this study year are to exhibit own work and function in the professional field outside the academy. Over the course of the year, the internship is successfully completed; the written professional profile is assessed and adjusted after the internship. The written report, with conclusions about the internship period, is the impetus for p.60 the final year, in which the student is supposed to bring this final phase to a successful conclusion. At the end of the third year the individual and collective assessment reviews are merged into one comprehensive assessment. Competences The competences for the third year are: These competences are under construction, please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. // T he student is able to formulate an idea, identify his goals and employ research to develop an image concept and make it into a work. // T he student can relate his work to developments in the field in a cultural and social context and define his position. // T he student develops an authentic vision on photography and is able to keep developing this further. // T he student can create a balance between journalistic / commercial, logistic, facilitating and technical activities. // T he student is able to convincingly present and explain his own work (methods) and remains true to his goal and target audience. // T he student is able to connect his own work to that of others, and his own work to the public; the student can adequately address his target groups with his work. // T he student can purposely place himself in the work process in different roles and with different responsibilities, and employ his individual talents to achieve common goals. Artistic technical domain Theoretical domain In the course of the year, the student’s theoretical knowledge expands further. The art and photography history and reflection are specifically applied to further develop the critical reviewing of the medium in relation to the student’s individual position in the field. The visual art and cultural world keep playing an important role in this, and the subjects communication and sociology support the determination of the position. The theoretical component of AV and Interactive Media is used to extend and expand the boundaries of the photography medium. Students are assessed at the hand of debates, oral presentations and a written paper. Professional social domain During the entire year, the professional social domain guides the curriculum. The outside world is brought into the academy by giving students assignments based on professional assignments. Students present work in a professional setting and are assessed accordingly. The assembling of a portfolio is of great importance in preparation of the p.61 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The student explores the medium and determines his own position. The attention is centred on students’ individual projects or on the distinguishing features of the execution of assignments. Authorship is evident in the breadth of the work and portfolio. The student demonstrates his ability to use the contexts and settings in which the creative work can manifest itself, such as in exhibitions, in printed media such as magazines and/ or books, interactively and on the web. Concept development is specifically aimed at the outside world. Whether he is working on a job assignment or on an individual project, the student should demonstrate awareness of the outside world and should know how to take advantage of this. internship. The internship is, after all, the opportunity for students to experience working in a professional environment. Additionally, the completed assignments and projects are assessed on the basis of project proposals and plans, budgets, funding and the meeting of deadlines. Main Phase + final phase Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide (Profiling and positioning) Full-time / part-time: semesters seven and eight In the final phase, the student proves his abilities by applying his professional skills to position himself in the field. By doing so he demonstrates his views on the photographic visual language, that he is able to give an artistic interpretation of the work, and that he can manifest himself in such a way that he does not only acquire a starting position in his chosen field, but also manages to influence it. The exam work is professionally presented including descriptions, budget and funding. He also creates support for the exam work outside the academy by getting at least one part of the work published or by finding a commissioning party or sponsors for the project. Students work on the exam work during the entire year. The competences of the final phase correspond to the final qualifications of the programme. / / forms his points of departure from a personal artistic vision and places it in a broader cultural and social perspective; / / uses artistic and technical problems to develop comprehensive solutions and demonstrates that he makes use of his knowledge of, and insight in, the way images, shapes, materials, proportions and colours evoke experiences and transfer meanings. He also finds relevant resources to photograph in an effective manner; / / employs a method that, on several occasions, questions the concept (and/or process) and uses his findings to come to a better design; / / shows in the work that he transfers meanings and can cause experiences. Capacity for critical reflection The student: / / is able to analyse, interpret and assess his own work and that of others, and can apply the ensuing outcomes to benefit his own work; / / evaluates the result on the basis of communicative effectiveness and artistic value, oversees the implications of choices and decisions and can justify these; These competences are under construction, please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information / / demonstrates awareness of different views that exist in the field; Creative ability The student: / / shows the ability to investigate all matters that are important for a design; // can create an innovative concept and develop it into a unique and significant image, product, means of communication or spatial design, and place it in a context in an innovative way; p.62 / / extends his knowledge of traditions and theories related to the discipline, of different visions on, and approaches to, the chosen profession, from both historical and contemporary philosophical insights (especially ethics and aesthetics) that may be of importance to a photographer. Capacity for growth and innovation The student: / / continuously develops his work and method in both depth and intensity, in a way that suits him and relates to his discipline; / / shows he wants to further develop his personal artistic vision; / / demonstrates the ambition to excel; / / is able to acquire new knowledge, insights and skills concerning techniques, legislation, processing and application possibilities, and public and professional approaches; / / uses criticism of others to further develop. Organisational competence The student: // can create and maintain his own inspiring and functional work environment; // develops his own work process and is able to see how various aspects of the medium in the discipline are interconnected; // makes business arrangements to be able to eventually work as an (independent) photographer; // is able to manage the work process and can find a balance between substantive research, photography, logistics, facilitating and public activities; // knows how to document and archive his work. Communicative competence The student: // can present and explain his artistic vision and work, and negotiate about it with clients and others involved; // is able to obtain and interpret job assignments; // shows the ambition to publish and exhibit his work and proclaim is own opinions; // has an overview of the market and the mass media; // is able to find a support for his work; // communicates verbally, visually and in writing about his work; // makes and maintains contacts that are relevant to its own network. External awareness The student: // has a vision on the role and position of his discipline and is able to relate his work and convictions to those of others and to developments in the cultural and social contexts; // focuses in his work on the user and acquires knowledge necessary to adequately adapt to these (user) groups; // is able research all aspects relevant to the work; // studies the work and visions of his peers, also internationally; // places his own work in the perspective of traditions and theories related to the field; // recognises a wide range of views p.63 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide / / shows a critical and inquiring attitude regarding his work. He is able to further develop this into a body of work and an individual position; // knows how to locate possible expertise of colleagues or specialists from other disciplines and collaborate with them; in relation to the profession of photographer, both from a historical and contemporary perspective; // is inspired by a range of cultural and social sources and can recognise and name these in his own work; // reflects on the function of the discipline in society. Collaborative competence The student: Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // is able to guide collaborative efforts and provide content and quality; // is able to achieve his goals while working with others; // is able to utilise his talents and abilities in a collaboration; // can effectively and respectfully employ different roles, responsibilities and interests in the process of photographing. Artistic technical domain Now that the professional field has been extensively explored, the student uses the last phase to hone down and make explicit his own visual signature. Specialisation and profiling within the medium are the starting points. The student consciously strives to find the boundaries of the discipline and move beyond them if possible. This applies in particular to the way of presenting the work. The experience of the work plays an important role in the development of the communication concepts. Theoretical domain The thesis is the culmination of the research for the practical work. In the thesis, students establish their work and their position as maker in the broader context of the discipline. The student demonstrates he can engage both the historical and p.64 current situation of the medium in this, as well as the situation of culture in general. The determination of standpoints is crucial to this. Professional social domain The activities of the exam are placed in the context of the professional practice and further developed. This means that special attention is given to all matters related to the entrepreneurship of the photographer. One part of the exam includes a project in which the student demonstrates he can place the work in the context of the discipline. In addition to the exam work, students are expected to write a business plan and to generate publicity for their exam work. The content of the final stage of the part-time programme corresponds to that of the full-time programme. The projects are adapted to fit into three semesters. The objectives associated with the final phase of the programme are the same as the final qualifications and the associated competences. 2.4.5 Department organisation The head of department is responsible for the department’s policy and all aspects related to this policy. The team of lecturers reflects the content of the programme and its professional set-up. With the exception of some, all teachers have a professional practice and work either independently or in a team. Because of the diversity in experience and expertise, the student is confronted with numerous aspects and approaches of the discipline. Specific knowledge of the professional field is offered by means of guest lectures. Head of part-time programmes Ernst Bergmans e.bergmans@kabk.nl Coordinator Documentary and Fiction Lotte Sprengers l.sprengers@kabk.nl Coordinator part-time Leo Erken l.erken@kabk.nl Internship Coordinator Lotte Sprengers Lecturers Anna Abrahams Vincent van Baar Ellen Dosse Theo van Dusseldorp Leo Erken Jan Frederik Groot Johan Gustavsson Sebastiaan Hanekroot Tom van Heel Anja de Jong Ton van Kints Ben Krehwinkel Ola Lanko Deen van Meer Hans van der Meer Krista van der Niet Corinne Noordenbos Louise te Poele Pawel Pokutycki Carla van de Puttelaar Marga Rotteveel Lotte Sprengers Ewoud Traast Edel Verzijl Loek van Vliet Rob Wetzer Raimond Wouda Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Heads of Photography department Corinne Noordenbos c.noordenbos@kabk.nl Judith van IJken Lecturers theory / art history Elke van Eeden Ingrid Grootes Bert Rorije Martijn Verhoeven Ellie Smollenaars Guest lecturers Kim Knoppers, extern deskundige 2012-2013 Ruud Visschedijk , extern deskundige 2010-2011, 2011-2012, 2013 Gerrit Scheurs, extern deskundige 2008-2009, 2009-2010 Wim van Sinderen, extern deskundige januari 2008-2009, 2009-2010 Bart Sorgedrager, extern deskundige 2008-2009, 2009-2010 Harvey Benge Lars Boering Koos Breukel Sarah Carlier Anton Corbijn Ad van Denderen Hans Eijkelboom Miklos Gaal David Goldblatt Brian Griffin Vincent van Gurp p.65 2.4.6 Total overview of qualifications QUALIFICATIONS Creative ability Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Capacity for critical reflection Capacity for growth and innovation Organizational ability Communicative ability External awareness Capacity for collaboration PROPAEDEUTIC YEAR MAIN PHASE, YEAR 2 At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. p.66 the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. QUALIFICATIONS Creative ability MAIN PHASE, YEAR 3 MAIN PHASE, YEAR 4 At the time of printing this guide, You are able to develop an inno- the specific final qualifications vative concept arising from your of this study year had not yet artistic ambition and research, been finalised. Please refer to elaborate it into a distinctive the website for the most up-to-date image, product, means of information. nication or spatial design, and to commu- contextualize it in a meaningful way. Capacity for critical reflection You are able to consider, analyse, the specific final qualifications interpret and assess your own and of this study year had not yet others' work, and are capable of been finalised. Please refer to constructively considering your the website for the most up-to-date findings in relation to your own information. work. At the time of printing this guide, You are able to further develop the specific final qualifications your vision, work and working of this study year had not yet methods in breadth and depth been finalised. Please refer to through an ongoing process the website for the most up-to-date of research, and in this way information. contribute to your discipline and to society. Organizational ability At the time of printing this guide, You are able to establish and the specific final qualifications maintain an inspirational and of this study year had not yet functional working environment and been finalised. Please refer to to organize your research, work and the website for the most up-to-date practice. information. Communicative ability At the time of printing this guide, You are able to effectively present the specific final qualifications your vision, research and work and of this study year had not yet engage in a dialogue with clients been finalised. Please refer to and other interested parties. the website for the most up-to-date information. External awareness At the time of printing this guide, You are able to relate your the specific final qualifications artistic practice to the artistic of this study year had not yet and social context. been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. Capacity for collaboration At the time of printing this guide, You are able to make an independent the specific final qualifications contribution to a collaborative of this study year had not yet product or process. been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. p.67 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Capacity for growth and innovation At the time of printing this guide, 2.4.7 Study points overview PHOTOGRAPHY FULL-TIME DOCUMENTARY Year 1 Semester 1 Photojournalism 4 Photography fashion/lifestyle 4 2 2 4 Photography commercial 4 4 3 4 3 2 4 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide 3 4 2 3 3 Graphic design 2 Academy-wide propaedeutic year 2 1 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 1 project week Audiovisual/film theory or Interactive media design /media theory Final Year project(s) 1 (assignment) 10 Final Year project(s) 2 (personal profiling on two platforms) Art/Photography History and 3 3 3 Sociology 2 2 1 Film Theory or Media Theory 2 2 Reflection Research and Discourse 8 4 Photography fine art Digital skills 7 4 Photography documentary 2 (presentation in the 3rd year) 4 6 4 Photography documentary 1 Image Development 5 4 Photography documentary Photography tecnical skills 3 2 2 3 3 Thesis Career orientation 3 3 Programmed career preparation 2 2 2 3 1 Integrated career preparation ( BV) 1 1 1 1 3 Internship preparation, 2 internship and report IST & Projects 5 18 6 3 3 3 24 6 6 6 6 6 6 Total 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 EC after individual assessment 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 EC after collective assessment 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 1st year: Due to the changed Research & Discourse programme minor adjustments of the EC is an possibility. p.68 PHOTOGRAPHY FULL-TIME DOCUMENTARY Year 1 Semester 1 Photojournalism 4 Photography fashion/lifestyle 4 2 2 4 Photography commercial 4 4 3 4 3 2 4 3 2 3 3 2 Academy-wide propaedeutic year 2 1 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 1 project week Audiovisual/film theory or Interactive media design/media theory Final Year project(s) 1 (assignment) 10 Final Year project(s) 2 (personal profiling on two platforms) Reflection Research and Discourse 2 2 3 3 3 3 3 1 Sociology 2 2 Film Theory or Media Theory 2 2 Thesis Career orientation 3 Programmed career preparation 2 2 2 3 1 Integrated career preparation ( BV) 1 1 1 1 3 5 18 6 3 3 Internship preparation, 2 internship and report IST & Projects 3 3 24 6 6 6 6 6 6 Total 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 EC after individual assessment 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 EC after collective assessment 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 p.69 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide 4 Graphic design Art/Photography History and 8 4 Photography fine art Digital skills 7 4 Photography documentary 2 (presentation in the 3rd year) 4 6 4 Photography documentary 1 Image Development 5 4 Photography documentary Photography tecnical skills 3 PHOTOGRAPHY PART-TIME Year 1 2 Semester 1 2 3 Photography technical Skills 5 3 6 Digital Skills 3 3 Photography Fine Art 3 4 5 8 Photography documentary 4 4 theory Audiovisual/film theory Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide 4 6 2 Graphic Design 2 3 2 Final Year project(s) 1 (assignment) 10 Final Year project 2 personal profiling on 2 podia) Art /Photography History and Reflection Research and Discourse 2 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 Film Theory or Media Theory 3 3 3 Programmed career preparation 16 3 3 3 1 3 3 3 2 (trip) Integrated career preparation ( BV) 4 3 Thesis (also through self-study) 6 3 Sociology Career orientation 8 4 8 Interactive media design/media (Presentation in the 3rd year) 7 8 Photojournalism Image Developement 4 6 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 4 4 5 5 0 0 0 4 3 1 3 2 6 6 6 6 Totaal 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 EC after individual assesment 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 EC after collective assesment 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 Internship proposal, internship and report EVC ( Elswhere Acquired Competences) IST p.70 2.5 Graphic Design 2.5.1 General description of the discipline Graphic designers are researchers. They look critically at their profession and the world, and reflect on change. They continuously ask questions, and by doing so they discover where information is hidden, what form to present it in, and how it can be made accessible. The profession of graphic designer is related to the visual arts, science, journalism and other creative disciplines. Designing is a combination of inventing and imagining. For example, the design of a website is not just the website in itself, but is, instead, a unification of images and descriptions of what the website looks like and how it works. Because of the increasing availability of technological means of production, for example user-friendly software and affordable high quality printers, designers are able to control the production process. As a result, the gap between design and product diminishes. There are infinite ways to design graphically. A graphic designer can draw with pencil or with a design programme, he can rip and paste paper, create patterns in sand with his fingers, arrange led letters, copy objects on a copier, organise stacks of photographs, and so on. The products that result from these processes are equally diverse. Graphic designers design websites, So what exactly is the discipline of graphic design? To keep it simple, we say that graphic design is the development of, and giving form to, communication concepts by arranging, adapting and visualising the available information. This happens in so many different media and according to an equal multitude of different approaches, that the discipline is often described as heterogeneous. The connotation with printed matter, which can literally be found in the name of the discipline, is a relic from the pre-digital era: the label no longer fully represents the content. This is why some refer to the discipline as ‘visual communication’ or ‘visual design’. Graphic designers practice their profession in numerous ways. Some work alone, while others work for small studios and bureaus. Some of these initiatives have been set up as a cooperative effort or as collaborative ventures of independent designers, and others as small businesses with staff and a designer as director. On the other end of the spectrum are the large firms with large numbers of employees. These firms mostly focus on strategic communication p.73 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Graphic designers work on commission and also initiate their own projects. They work with existing information and also create it themselves. In the latter case they are no longer simply designers, but assume the role of initiator, editor, project manager and publisher as well. There is a strong emphasis on the research and development of concepts that form the basis of information transfer. apps, browsers, book covers, books, magazines, experiences, forms, flyers, newspapers, interactions, campaigns, letters, signs, agendas, games, logos, flags, boxes, money, and so much more. When the image by itself is not sufficient, they work with sound, texture, and even with smell and taste. Some graphic designers like to break through the boundaries of their discipline, by, for example, working in the fields of visual arts or theatre. Others have expanded their area of work to include film, and it is interesting to observe that the background of graphic design is visible in the films these designers create: their vocabulary, imagery and signature transcends the medium in which they work. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide and the development of identities and campaigns. Where individuals and small bureaus are often specialised, these large firms cover almost the entire field. Additionally, many companies, such as marketing firms, media corporations and multinationals, have an in-house graphic designer. The commissioning parties vary just as greatly, from individuals to multinationals, from cultural institutions to ministries, from shop-owners to media giants. The discipline of graphic design includes, to sum up, everything that happens in graphic design and everyone who plays a part in it. Current situation of the discipline What happens in the discipline? If we take a look from a distance, it becomes apparent that many of the current developments in graphic design are connected to three comprehensive themes: information, technology and the globalisation of society. It is impossible to escape from information in our contemporary information society. Over the last few decades, the amount of information and the speed with which it is disseminated has increased enormously. This has huge consequences for graphic designers. The abundance of information is often not recognised as a problem, and designers are increasingly given the responsibility of finding solutions to communication problems. Designers are all of a sudden expected to work on this extra task, in addition to finishing the actual design. Contrary to the promises of the contemporary template culture, the need to structure information has clearly become more and more important. It is becoming increasingly difficult to stand out in the overwhelming flow of images and texts. This is perhaps why graphic designers have become concept developers, and have taken charge of communication processes. In the commercial field, there is a desire p.74 for bigger and crazier designs, as long as they get the message across in a clear manner. At the same time, it is expected that users have a pleasurable experience when coming in contact with a design. It is a complex task. Independent spirits refrain from responding to trends and hypes, and attempt to create visual silence in the whirlwind of screaming images. Some try to approach the tradition in its purest form, while others experiment with unconventional alternatives. If one conclusion can be drawn from this, it is that graphic designers cannot avoid reflecting on their role in the contemporary information society. One of the main questions they ask themselves is a moral one: do I contribute to this dissemination of information, or are there limits to what I send out into the world? Graphic design is founded on technique and technology. The message is inextricably linked to the medium, and this is reflected in the history of graphic design. For a long time, the profession was connected to the art of printing, which slowly but surely reinvented itself over time. The digital revolution led the profession into the fast-paced world of bits and chips. It is difficult to imagine that 25 years ago, designers did not use computers, and that there were hardly any designers who designed for the computer. Paper will not disappear completely, but eventually almost all information will reach us through digital systems. Consequently, graphic designers have to be knowledgeable about technological possibilities, and preferably are able to work with the technology. Additionally, they have to understand how technology transforms relations and practices. Technology enables interaction, and thus encourages substantive input from the public. These new developments provoke exciting reactions. Young designers seek out hidden treasures of the What becomes clear, in short, is that the digital revolution leads the graphic designer in different directions. In all these directions he can set the tone. Technologically, he does so by constantly being aware of the latest developments and by participating in the development of applications. Conceptually, he can achieve this by doing research and by delving into his subjects and the development of the profession in its current social context. Formally, he has to either experiment with the non-existent or become highly skilled in traditional techniques. advocated the international, internationalisation is already very much underway these days and is no longer the concern of pioneering designers. In our global society everyone is in touch with everyone. For graphic designers this has far-reaching consequences. A design does not just stay in the Netherlands, but travels into the world, especially when it comes to Internet applications. Designers must know the codes of the new international visual culture that has emerged. Simultaneously we want them to use their own codes. We are also more aware of the situation in other countries and of back room politics. Maybe because graphic designers are so involved with information, they have a strong sense of responsibility for the world. This can take many forms. For example, there are designers who distance themselves from the deceptive rhetoric of the commercial field. In media circles there are advocates for a humane information society in which people are not crushed by a torrent of superficial images. Slightly more practical are the designers who are committed to social projects. Agencies sometimes offer affordable services for charitable campaigns, or dedicate means to their immediate environment. Graphic design is a committed discipline. 2.5.2 Study Profile Social ideals were once a driving force behind the emergence of graphic design. Designers desired better living conditions for all. Especially in the period between the two world wars this social commitment was strong. The KABK was at that time a bastion of progressive modernists. Professional Objectives Graphic designers are increasingly working on the boundaries of the discipline. Therefore, the department strives for a broad definition of the discipline and encourages students to explore these boundaries, and when necessary, cross them. Today’s designers resemble their colleagues from the past. They are fully engaged with the world. The conditions are different, however. Where the socialists in the 1930’s In general, the design process can be divided into four major phases: collecting, examining, visualising and publishing information. This methodology enables the designer to p.75 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide analogue era and tackle the challenges of the digital age. They research the concept of manual labour in contemporary society, and how automated processes influence design results. They give new life to vintage design traditions and invent new applications for existing technologies. This distinguishes them from designers who solely employ the possibilities of design programmes, and from those that only work with pencil. They also distinguish themselves from the capable amateur with their conceptual abilities and knowledge of the field. In addition to the capable amateur there is also the incapable one, who, for some designers, is a true source of inspiration. This amateur represents open-mindedness, authentic style and uncontrived simplicity in presentation. appropriate the following attitudes and skills: // develop concepts for the transfer and exchange of information and shape them with the use of image, typography and other means; // examine, organise, edit, visualize and manage information; // work from a personal, thoughtful vision of the discipline, from fascinations and from the social context; Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // work on commission and/or initiate projects; // make statements about the profession and the world through the work; // trigger new developments in the discipline or advance existing developments; // not only meet the needs of the user and/or the client with the work, but also, and above all, further deepen and develop the personal vision and work. Description of the study programme The Graphic Design department educates students to become versatile designers in the field of communication. The ideal graduate is an investigative designer who is fully aware of current affairs, who, depending on the concept and the situation, chooses his medium wisely, and who is familiar with both traditional and new social media. The graduates stand out because of their conceptual and visual abilities, knowledge of the profession and the world, technological curiosity and highly developed social commitment. The department offers an extensive curriculum. The programme is founded on four pillars: design, interaction, image and typography. The attention to the study of letters distinguishes the programme from other graphic design studies. The study of letters p.76 takes place in the first year, in combination with typography. In the second year, students can choose the elective Letter Studio to continue the research. The electives Playlab and Design Office are equally unique, where the first course is fully dedicated to avant-garde research and the second to practical assignments for external clients. Each year, the department uses the programme’s strong content and the composition of the teaching staff to achieve actuality, versatility, depth in theory and practice, and interaction between text and image. The programme offers students the freedom to develop their personal qualities. Students work from their own preferences towards a general or specialised graduate profile. The social orientation of the programme is reflected in assignments, projects and theory classes. Additionally, a pioneering and questioning attitude prevails in relation to the discipline. With foreign students, foreign guest lecturers, field trips and collaborations with academies abroad, the programme is remarkably international. The department is well known internationally, both in the field and beyond. Its graduates include many influential designers. Some have a strong social profile, and others have made unique achievements in the field of typography and type design. As described above, we consider the notions of image and interaction to be important points of interest in contemporary design, and they are therefore given a prominent place in the programme. Final qualifications Graphic Design The final qualifications have been summarised in seven competences. The KABK has established these competences on the basis of the national final qualifications for Graphic Design programmes. // Y ou are able to develop an innovative concept arising from your artistic ambition and research, elaborate it into a distinctive image, product, means of communication or spatial design, and to contextualize it in a meaningful way (creative ability) // Y ou are able to consider, analyse, interpret and assess your own and others’ work, and are capable of constructively considering your findings in relation to your own work (capacity for critical reflection) // Y ou are able to establish and maintain an inspirational and functional working environment and to organize your research, work and practice (organizational ability) // Y ou are able to effectively present your vision, research and work and engage in a dialogue with clients and other interested parties (communicative ability) // Y ou are able to relate your artistic practice to the artistic and social context (external awareness) // Y ou are able to make an independent contribution to a collaborative product or process (capacity for collaboration) Diploma Graduates are awarded a Bachelor of Design (BDes) and are then eligible to enter post-graduate programmes in the Netherlands or abroad. Post-graduate studies Admission Procedure The candidate applies online. He fills out a questionnaire and receives three assignments to prepare at home. The candidate will then be invited for the entrance examination. The admission committee consists of both teachers and students. The head of the department is present during the admission. The admission takes place in Dutch or - with foreign candidates - in English. The candidate is expected to bring his portfolio, which consists of a diverse selection of his work. Basically everything that gives an impression of the way of working should be included in the portfolio, such as sketches, blueprints and notes of ideas. The candidate also presents the aforementioned assignments during the examination. An additional assignment is given on the selection day, and a personal discussion with the admission committee takes place as well. The Committee formulates an opinion to the Board of Directors on the basis of all these elements, after which the candidate will receive a written answer as to whether he has been accepted or not. Specific admission requirements During the selection day, the candidate’s eligibility for the programme will be tested according to various methods. p.77 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // Y ou are able to further develop your vision, work and working methods in breadth and depth through an ongoing process of research, and in this way contribute to your discipline and to society (capacity for growth and innovation) After receiving their Bachelor’s degree, graduates can enrol in a master’s programme in design (M Design) or art (M Fine Arts) or another master’s programme at an art academy. In addition to our own Master Type and Media graduates have gone to pursue master’s degrees at, among others: Royal College in London, Yale School of Art in New Haven, Typography Workshop ArtEZ, Sandberg Institute and the University of Leiden. The take home assignment, which changes annually, provides information about: // providing creative solutions; // being research orientated; // being sensitive to material; // being sensitive to one’s surroundings; // curiosity; // enthusiasm; // ability to combine text and visuals. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The drawing assignment(observational sketches) provides information about: // powers of observation; // drawing skills; // use of surface/composition; // personal approach; // personal signature. The design assignment provides information about: // flexibility in dealing with an assignment; // employing different media; // combining text and visual information; // frame of reference; // (basic) insight into the profession; // personal approach. The day assignment provides information about: // speed in originality; // improvisational skills; // switching between different starting points; // translating content to image or typography; // imaginative processes; // abstract thinking. p.78 2.5.3 Study programme overview full-time / part-time The graphic design programme is offered as both full-time and parttime education. The set-up of both programmes is similar in content. Both programmes have a curriculum that focuses on three domains of knowledge and ability: an artistic domain, a theoretical domain and a professional-social domain. Sometimes the domains are directly recognizable in the courses, such as theory and professional preparation. Other courses focus on more than one domain. For example, design and typography both have an artistic and a theoretical dimension, which are inextricably linked together. Artistic technical domain The pillars of the programme are four design disciplines: design, interaction, image and typography. All courses have a conceptual nature. Design centres on the examining, organising, editing and visualising of information and controlling processes of information transfer. In Interaction, as the name implies, interactive processes are designed for new media and other contexts. Image focuses on the creation, editing, deploying and organising of images and the creation of concepts in which image plays a role. In Typography, the visual form of texts is centralised, independently and in relation to image; there is a focus on the development of concepts, typographical notions and ideas, techniques and materials. In the first year, Typography coincides with Letters, where an initial understanding of letters and letter designs is obtained. The Coding course functions as the foundation to all courses. In Coding, students gain basic knowledge in programming and technical competences. They are introduced to the properties of algorithms, functions and loops and the possibilities to apply them in the design process. Theoretical domain The department’s theoretical programme establishes an exchange between the acquisition of knowledge and understanding of current graphic design in its artistic, historical and social context, and the work of the student. The first year focuses on contemporary graphic design in relation to the visual arts, other design disciplines and visual culture. The second year is devoted to theory in the history of design. In the third year philosophy is centralised, with attention for the relationship between graphic design and social issues. In the fourth year the theory teacher guides the students in the writing of the thesis, which linked to the graduation project. An important goal of the theory programme is to teach students to position themselves in relation to the work of others, to form opinions and to admit when personal feelings and taste are involved. In addition to the theoretical programme offered by the department, students take academy-wide courses in art theory and academic skills, and they can participate in the academy’s Studium Generale. It is also possible for students to follow courses in other departments or at Leiden University, in the framework of the Individual Study Trajectory (IST). Professional social domain What is the social significance of graphic design? What position do you aspire as a graphic designer in society? What do you need to do to achieve it? These questions are discussed throughout the programme. The aim is to prepare students for their future professions. During the propaedeutic year this happens in a playful and explorative way. In the subsequent years, assignments mimic realistic situations. There is contact with the professional field, the public and clients. Some projects take place outside the academy, while others are derived from professional practice. In addition, all students are required to do an internship. In the fourth year the focus is very explicitly placed on the students’ future professional practice, with a Career Orientation course, assistance in compiling a portfolio and the graduation projects. During these activities the consequences of the students’ choices are examined. For example, students have to ask themselves the question what kind of designer they would want to be, if they want to work for a firm or independently, and what suits them best. Possibilities for post-graduate education are also discussed. In the final year, students are expected to present themselves during evaluations as a designer and explain their position in the field. Also part of the domain are the Reading Groups, which are small groups set up each semester and led by a teacher to intellectually engage students with challenging texts. p.79 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide From the second year onwards, the notion of ‘courses’ is gradually released, and instead supervision in different specialisations becomes more important in completing assignments. From that moment on there is a strong relation with the professional social domain. In the second and third year, students choose between two electives at the beginning of each year. In the Letter Studio letters are researched in relation to typography. Playlab searches for the boundaries of the discipline with an experimental research programme. The Design Office has been created as a studio in which students work in teams on special assignments for real clients, often in the cultural field. Full-time programme Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Propaedeutic year The first year is an adventurous exploration of the student’s qualities in various aspects of graphic design. The qualities are explored with challenging assignments that appeal to the student’s curiosity and creativity. Small and larger assignments alternate and take the students to the far corners of their field. Much emphasis is placed on open-mindedness, the joy of working and only evaluating afterwards. Students try out different ways of working and get a first glimpse into their visual ability and the value of their ideas. This way, the students gradually move towards the development of their own visual language and vision. In the first year it is important to create a large body of work that provides confidence and creates resilience useful during the rest of the programme. of the profession and the culture, both substantively and technically, and broaden the frame of reference. In addition to scheduled courses, two project weeks take place in the propaedeutic year: a departmentwide week for all years, and an academy-wide course for all first year groups, plus an excursion week. Career preparation projects are offered in the framework of the lessons. Study programme components // Design // Image // Typography and Letters // Interaction // Drawing // Theory: Current Visual Culture // Academy-wide: Art Theory and Introduction to Science Year 2 Throughout the year, students complete assignments for which they must make use of the workshops. In the theoretical programme the emphasis is on familiarising students with contemporary graphic design, with attention to a large variety of views and approaches. In the final assessment, the student has to be able to answer the question whether graphic design is suitable for him, and if he is suitable for the profession. The student must then be able to clearly specify the elements of the profession that primarily interest him. Points of departure // Introduction to the field, both practically and theoretically. // The creative and intellectual development of the student is central. // Scheduled courses are offered parallel to each other. They focus on certain aspects p.80 In the second year, students work on a series of challenging design assignments. The emphasis is on expanding the understanding of the profession and strengthening the student’s qualities as a designer. Ample space is reserved for research. The assignments address, among other things, the concepts of public space and audience groups. There are realistic and fictional, optional and compulsory assignments. In the course of the year the taught courses are replaced by supervision by different teachers in joint assignments. Each teacher covers another area of expertise: Design, Photography, Typography or Interaction. Students can discuss their work with different teachers. Additionally, they follow Letterstudio, Playlab or Design Office and they set up their own Individual Study Trajectory. The theory programme is dedicated to the history of graphic design in its cultural and social context and establishes a relationship with the work of the students. The students also focus on the presenting and exhibiting their work. Points of departure / / Expanding the understanding of the discipline. / / Strengthening the personal qualities as a designer. / / More focus on research. / / Supervision by teachers with different specialisations in joint assignments. / / Students choose between Letterstudio, Playlab or Design Office. / / Career preparation projects, both in the context of the lessons and the Individual Study Trajectory. / / Organisation of exhibitions and presentations. Study programme components Design Assignments, with supervision in: / / Design / / Image / / Typography / / Interaction / / Theory: History of Design / / Elective: Letter Studio, Playlab or Design Office / / Technique: Coding / / Individual Study Trajectory Year 3 The third year also focuses on complex design assignments. In this year, the emphasis is placed on the relationship between graphic designer and society. This is reflected in the theory programme, the assignments and p.81 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide / / The Individual Study Trajectory serves as a tool to broaden or deepen the study programme. the internship. One of the departure points of the course is that students become more and more in charge of their trajectory as the programme progresses; in the third year a lot is expected from them. The students are largely responsible for organising their own supervision and have great freedom in how they approach the assignments. Consequently they can decide to, for example, increase their focus on designing for new media, to centralise the unification of text and image, or to approach assignments typographically. The emphasis in the curriculum will be on interdisciplinary collaboration and multidisciplinary knowledge. By optimally using Playlab, Design Office, the Letterstudio and the Individual Study Trajectory, students can broaden their knowledge, specialise and acquire additional skills and techniques. The theory programme in third year teaches philosophy, and is dedicated to reflection on current social themes. Its aim is to make students develop a vision on their personal responsibility as a designer and to support their ideas of designing according to their social vision. The internship takes place in the second semester. Points of departure // After the first year’s emphasis on the discovery of student’s qualities, and the second year’s focus on deepening the understanding of the discipline, the third year is centred on the relationship with society. // The courses continue to fuse together; in the second semester the assignment-teachers supervise a large assignment with a socially relevant theme. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // The students choose Letterstudio, Playlab or Design Office. // The Individual Study Trajectory serves as a tool to broaden or deepen the study, career preparation projects take place in the framework of the Individual Study Trajectory. Study programme components Design Assignments, with supervision in: // Design // Image // Typography // Interaction // Theory: Philosophy // Elective: Letter Studio, Playlab or Design Office to present enough work of a sufficient level to pass to the final phase. The theoretical part of the final year is the thesis that functions as the theoretical preparation for the graduation project. Additionally, the students prepare for the final exam and their future professional practice, and they are assisted in constructing a portfolio. Points of departure / / In the final year, the focus is on the position and positioning of the student as a graphic designer in his discipline and society. / / The entire year is devoted to the final examination; from the start of the year the students work on projects on which they can graduate. / / The Individual Study Trajectory serves as a tool to broaden or deepen the study. / / Students who graduate with a letter-project make use of supervision from the Letter Studio. Study programme components Graduation projects with supervision in: / / Design // Technique: Coding / / Image // Individual Study Trajectory / / Typography / / Interaction Year 4 / / Theory: Thesis / / Career Preparation This year is entirely focused on the final examination. The first semester is exploratory in nature, with students doing various design assignments that have both visual and content-based elements, and which can be possible precursors for the central theme of the graduation project. From the second semester onwards the final phase commences. The students are motivated by deadlines and they work hard to be able p.82 / / Individual Study Trajectory Part-time programme The part-time programme is set-up very similarly to the full-time programme. However, the Individual Study Trajectory and electives Letterstudio and Playlab are not offered (yet). There is also no compulsory internship. Students are expected to initiate relationships with the professional field themselves. 2.5.4 Educational and professional objectives Propaedeutic year The assessment in the second semester, the propaedeutic year assessment, may lead to a binding negative study advice. Referral indicates that the student can be advised to enrol in another study programme in or outside of the academy. // Collaborative competence: The student is able to realise his goals in consultation with others. The propaedeutic year competences are reached with the help of the previously described study programme elements. Because of a revision of the programme, the courses are being re-written at the time of assembling this Study Guide. As soon as the descriptions are available they will be published on the KABK website. This also applies to the study programme elements of the subsequent years. Year 2 These competences are under construction, please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information / / Creative ability: The student is able to independently apply the acquired skills and knowledge to the production of his work. / / Capacity for critical reflection: The student is able to reflect on his work and can evaluate its quality and effectiveness. / / Capacity for growth and innovation: The student acquires new knowledge, skills and insights and is able to apply them on a theoretical and practical level. / / Organisational competence: The student is able to develop his own work process and is capable of documenting and archiving his work. / / Communicative competence: The student is able to support his choice of sources, materials and/or design solutions. / / Situational awareness: The student has a wide interest in The students are expected to master the following competences during the course of the year: These competences are under construction, please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. // Creative ability: The student can work on a design problem methodically and on the basis of his own ideas. // Capacity for critical reflection: The student is able to reflect on his own work and that of others, and can evaluate its quality and effectiveness. // Capacity for growth and innovation: The student can make use of newly acquired knowledge, skills and insights, and the criticism of others to advance the development of his work. // Organisational competence: The student is able to manage his work process, time-effectively and priority-based. // Communicative competence: The student is able to interpret an p.83 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The student needs to master the following competences during this phase of the programme: social and cultural developments and is able to recognise different visions of designing. assignment and can debrief in word and image. // Situational awareness: The student finds inspiration in social and cultural developments and is able to name them in his own work. He can also name the target groups for his work. // Collaborative competence: The student can work with others and is able to employ his talents in collaborative projects. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Year 3 The student is expected to master the following competences during this phase of the programme: These competences are under construction, please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. // Creative ability: The student can formulate a design problem and employ research to develop a design solution. // Capacity for critical reflection: The student is able to relate his work to developments in the field in a cultural and social context and position his work accordingly. // Capacity for growth and innovation: The student is able to develop a personal vision on designing from an open-minded attitude. // Organisational competence: The student is able to find balance between subjects, facilitating and production-aimed activities. // Communicative competence:The student can convincingly present and explain his work and method. // Situational awareness: The student is able to make connections between his work and that of others, and between his p.84 work and the public. The student can adequately adapt his work to his target groups. / / Collaborative competence: The student can purposely place himself in the design process in different roles and with different responsibilities. This implies that students: / / Possess the skills, insights and intellectual capacity to play a role in the professional field; / / Can express their personal style in different joint assignments; / / Show interest in the various aspects of professional practice in the joint assignments and in the formulation of own assignments; Graduation year The competences that the student is expected to master in the final phase are the same as the final qualifications of the programme. The heads of the Graphic Design department are Roosje Klap and Niels Schrader. They are responsible for the department’s policy and for every aspect that directly relates to this policy. The team of lecturers reflects the content of the programme and its professional set-up. A large number of teachers have a professional practice, in which they work independently or in a team. Because of the diversity in experience and expertise, the student is confronted with numerous aspects and approaches of the discipline. Specific knowledge of the professional field is offered by means of guest lectures. Heads of Graphic Design department Roosje Klap & Niels Schrader roosjeandniels@kabk.nl Coordinators Graphic Design Full-time Pauline Schep p.schep@kabk.nl Reba Wesdorp r.wesdorp@kabk.nl Head of part-time programmes Ernst Bergmans e.bergmans@kabk.nl Coordinator Graphic Design Part-time Koen Geurts k.geurts@kabk.nl Lecturers Graphic Design (full-time and part-time) Lauren Alexander Bart de Baets Frank Blokland Erik van Blokland Pieter Boddaert Marjan Brandsma Thomas Buxó Susana Carvalho Maarten Cornel p.85 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide / / Gain enough positive experience during an internship, while undertaking research or while participating in a student exchange programme with a similar educational institution abroad. 2.5.5 Department organisation 2.5.6 Total overview of qualifications QUALIFICATIONS Creative ability Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Capacity for critical reflection Capacity for growth and innovation Organizational ability Communicative ability External awareness Capacity for collaboration PROPAEDEUTIC YEAR MAIN PHASE, YEAR 2 At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. p.86 the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. QUALIFICATIONS Creative ability MAIN PHASE, YEAR 3 MAIN PHASE, YEAR 4 At the time of printing this guide, You are able to develop an inno- the specific final qualifications vative concept arising from your of this study year had not yet artistic ambition and research, been finalised. Please refer to elaborate it into a distinctive the website for the most up-to-date image, product, means of information. nication or spatial design, and to commu- contextualize it in a meaningful way. Capacity for critical reflection You are able to consider, analyse, the specific final qualifications interpret and assess your own and of this study year had not yet others' work, and are capable of been finalised. Please refer to constructively considering your the website for the most up-to-date findings in relation to your own information. work. At the time of printing this guide, You are able to further develop the specific final qualifications your vision, work and working of this study year had not yet methods in breadth and depth been finalised. Please refer to through an ongoing process the website for the most up-to-date of research, and in this way information. contribute to your discipline and to society. Organizational ability At the time of printing this guide, You are able to establish and the specific final qualifications maintain an inspirational and of this study year had not yet functional working environment and been finalised. Please refer to to organize your research, work and the website for the most up-to-date practice. information. Communicative ability At the time of printing this guide, You are able to effectively present the specific final qualifications your vision, research and work and of this study year had not yet engage in a dialogue with clients been finalised. Please refer to and other interested parties. the website for the most up-to-date information. External awareness At the time of printing this guide, You are able to relate your the specific final qualifications artistic practice to the artistic of this study year had not yet and social context. been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. Capacity for collaboration At the time of printing this guide, You are able to make an independent the specific final qualifications contribution to a collaborative of this study year had not yet product or process. been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. p.87 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Capacity for growth and innovation At the time of printing this guide, 2.5.7 Study points overview GRAPHIC DESIGN FULL-TIME Year 1 2 Semester 1 2 Design 6 6 Image 6 6 Typography and Letters 6 6 Interaction Design 6 6 Design cluster assignments (*) 3 4 3 4 5 6 14 14 14 7 Letterstudio, Playlab, DO. (choice) 4 4 4 2 Coding 2 2 2 1 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Final Exam Projects Academy-wide propaedeutic year Internship 18 3 3 2 Theory: Design History 4 4 Theory: Philosophy 4 2 Theory: Thesis Theory: Research and Discourse 18 12 Career preparation and Art 8 1 project week Theory: Contemporary Design 7 3 6 3 3 6 6 6 6 6 6 Total 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 EC after individual assessment 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 EC after collective assessment 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 Individual Study Trajectory (IST) * The design cluster assignments include aspects of Design, Image, Typography and Letters and Interaction Design 1st year: Due to the changed Research & Discourse programme minor adjustments of the EC is a possibilty. p.88 GRAPHIC DESIGN PART-TIME Year 1 2 3 Semester 1 2 3 4 5 Image 5 5 5 5 6 Design 1 6 5 5 5 5 Design 2 Design 3 5 Typography 5 Letters Design Orientation 5 5 5 5 5 4 7 8 7 8 7 5 6 5 7 6 6 4 Final Exam Projects 24 5 Philosophy 4 4 4 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Art & Design History 8 8 7 5 5 Interactive Media 4 6 2 Thesis 6 6 Total 30 30 34 26 30 30 30 30 EC after individual assessment 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 EC after collective assessment 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 p.89 2.6 Interior Architecture and Furniture Design No matter – try again – fail again – fail better. [Worstward Ho, Samuel Beckett ,1983] ‘Learning by Doing: Empirical Creative Education and Training’ The programme Interior Architecture and Furniture Design at the Royal Academy of Art covers the full width of the spatial domain by focusing on spatial conditions that determine how we experience our daily living environment. Our didactic principle is learning by doing. The development of skills, knowledge and competences is linked to relevant assignments that preferably correspond to professional design practice. We strongly emphasise the students’ personal position and the way they approach their identity from a professional perspective. We attach great value to the development of an individual approach and work process, and encourage the student to develop an independent mind-set, a reflective design attitude and empathic ability. In our view, the designer with the title Bachelor of Design represents an After the first year, the programme offers students the choice between the specialisations Interior Architecture (full-time/part-time) and Furniture Design (full-time only). The programme duration is four years. The new Bachelor of Design corresponds to the educational vision of the KABK and the National Final Qualifications for design. After graduating and receiving the title Bachelor of Design, the KABK offers students the opportunity to continue their studies in the new Master Interior Architecture INSIDE. Graduates’ possibilities for, and rights to, register with the ‘Bureau Architectenregister’ (Bureau Architects Register), in accordance with the ‘Wet op de Architectentitel (WAT)’ (The Academic Titles (Architects) Act), can be found on the website of the KABK and that of the ‘Architectenregister’ (Architects Register). The law was adapted in January 2011. Any student who graduates after 31 December 2014 and wants to register in the Netherlands as an architect, urban designer, garden and landscape architect or interior architect is obliged to complete a professional experience period. In the academic year 2011-2012, the thoroughly renewed curriculum of the bachelor’s programme was introduced. The renewal went hand in hand with the introduction of the Master INSIDE. The implementation of the renewal in the fourth year takes place in 2014-2015. In 2015 the first students will graduate from the new bachelor’s curriculum. p.91 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The core aim of the programme is the personal development of each individual student into a creative, inquisitive and independent designer. We pay close attention to discovering the possibilities and potential of our students, and have designed the programme in such a way that we have achieved a precise balance between the attention given to the concept and to empiricism: abstract thinking versus pragmatic and professional embedding. The curriculum focuses on experimentation and research. This enables us to encourage the development of an independent inquisitive design attitude that generates unexpected and surprising results and perspectives, and that makes the impossible possible. all-round designer with an entirely personal approach. He is a good observer, and has both strong conceptual and empirical skills. He is a designer who approaches every thinkable – spatial – challenge head on. 2.6.1 General description of the discipline Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Interior architecture and furniture design The discipline is populated by product and spatial designers who regard space, in the wider sense of the word, as their field of expertise. This field covers a wider area than that of just the interior or furniture, and the designers also focus on other objects and products, and on public and open space. They increasingly cross the traditional boundaries of their discipline and explore other domains, think cross-disciplinary, establish interconnections and always try to find the larger context. With a curious attitude they continuously question, search and fight for their position and that of the discipline. These designers are increasingly creating their own context and conditions to work in a permanent state of research. They do not just position themselves in relation to clients, but also pose their own questions, define their own projects and by doing so transfer their own vision. This vision prioritises society and questions concerning contemporary times. In their work, contemporary product and spatial designers anticipate possible future changes to improve the quality of the living environment. Furniture Design In this versatile approach, the product designer centralises the object and the relationship between man and space. The object - furniture piece or product - has a close relationship with the human body, which determines many aspects of the object’s use or experience. The furniture piece is also an object in the (architectural) space. The piece may exist as an independent object or as an integral part of the inhabited space, and will influence the perception and use of the space. An important aspect of the furniture p.92 piece or product can be its relation to emotional, social or cultural values. A product can thus transmit a message or visualise a story. The development of new techniques, production processes and materials is of importance in the expression of the product, its manufacturability or the new user possibilities that the product gives rise to. Sustainability and a conscious approach to materials and their application is therefore of great importance. Interior Architecture In recent decades, the interior is increasingly defined as a space that generates specific meanings and emotions through shapes, colours, scents, materials and objects, and can thereby deliberately orchestrate experiences. This space can be interpreted broadly; it can refer to private space, public space, and also to the urban and open space. Not only is the inhabitation of these spaces centralised; movement and mobility are equally important. Concepts such as identity, communication and experience are crucial in the design of these spaces. The spatial designer starts with the big picture and works from there on towards the smallest detail. It involves the development of spatial concepts that form the foundation for the intended perception and experience, to the materialisation and production techniques that eventually support the realisation of these concepts. Important to this is the relation to current and future issues concerning the use of space(s) and the sustainability of both material and space. Overlap exists between interior architecture and other design disciplines, such as design, textile and product design. Knowledge and skills from disciplines other than design are also applied to interior architecture, such as ergonomics, engineering, marketing, anthropology and psychology. Interior architecture relates to all these areas. 2.6.2 Study profile ‘Learning by Doing: Empirical Creative Education and Training’ Creating Learning by doing. The programme centres on the designer’s individual position and identity from a professional perspective. Great value is attached to both the student’s work process and approach. A graduate with the title Bachelor of Design can easily complete any assignment with a highly individual approach, and keep up with the incredibly fast and continuous transformation of the 21st century world. Education Characteristics of the programme are the tension between the development of the student’s design personality (to learn to design on an individual basis), the required professional skills, and the contribution to social issues in contemporary society and the cultural context. The motto “Learning by Doing: investigative practical education’ as an integrating activity is central to the new bachelor’s programme. Courses are integrated with, complementary to and supportive of the student’s development. The keywords of our educational approach are dialogue and interaction. We work in small teams. The For each task the student has to pose different questions and solve different problems. This gives the programme agility and connects it to the unpredictable dynamics of current events. Full time and part-time Interior architecture is offered as a full-time and part-time programme. Furniture Design as specialisation is only available in the full-time programme. In the full-time programme Interior Architecture and Furniture Design all students follow a joint programme in the propaedeutic year. At the beginning of the second year, students make the choice between the specialisations Interior Architecture and Furniture Design, where the design projects are offered separately. Interior versus Furniture In the second year, students choose to specialise in Interior Architecture or Furniture Design. The courses in the domain Design and oriented on the professional practice of the chosen discipline. The remaining study programme is composed for students of both specialisations. Final qualifications Interior Architecture and Furniture Design p.93 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Inquisitive The curriculum focuses on experimentation and research, and its core aim is to discover possibilities and unlock the student’s potential. The new bachelor’s KABK Interior Architecture and Furniture Design is based on the precise balance between conceptual and empiricist education: abstract thinking versus pragmatic embedding. This programme encourages the development of an independent inquisitive design attitude that generates unexpected, surprising results and perspectives. studio context stimulates exchange, supplementation and confrontation, and we focus specifically on social interaction and collaboration. We also pay much attention to the development of empathetic ability in the broadest sense of the word. This includes empathy towards users, target groups, context, society and contemporary themes. Additionally, we address the student’s mentality, personal responsibility and independent functioning in the department team. The student will not graduate by simply completing the assignments and satisfying the teacher’s demands. He also has to develop a flow to keep up his development. As a participant of the final exam you must meet the following final qualifications: Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // You are able to develop an innovative concept arising from your artistic ambition and research, elaborate it into a distinctive image, product, means of communication or spatial design, and to contextualize it in a meaningful way (creative ability) // You are able to consider, analyse, interpret and assess your own and others’ work, and are capable of constructively considering your findings in relation to your own work (capacity for critical reflection) // You are able to further develop your vision, work and working methods in breadth and depth through an ongoing process of research, and in this way contribute to your discipline and to society (capacity for growth and innovation) // You are able to establish and maintain an inspirational and functional working environment and to organize your research, work and practice (organizational ability) // You are able to effectively present your vision, research and work and engage in a dialogue with clients and other interested parties (communicative ability) // You are able to relate your artistic practice to the artistic and social context (external awareness) // You are able to make an independent contribution to a collaborative product or process (capacity for collaboration) The overview of the competences per academic year can be found at the end of this chapter. p.94 Diploma Graduates are awarded a Bachelor of Design (BDes) in Interior Architecture or Interior Design. Post-graduate studies After receiving their Bachelor’s degree, graduates can enrol in a master’s programme in design (M Design) or art (M Fine Arts) or another post-graduate programme at an art academy, such as an Academy of Architecture. At the Royal Academy, graduates can choose to continue their studies at the Master’s Interior Architecture INSIDE. For more information on the admission procedure please visit: www.enterinside.nl. Admission Procedure Interested parties can find information on the programme and application procedure on the KABK website. There they can register for the entrance examination that takes place during the selection day. After registration, the candidate will receive an invitation to the selection day, to which he needs to bring a letter of motivation, the completed questionnaire, home assignments and a portfolio. We prefer that the portfolio does not contain work based on school assignments. On the selection day the candidate presents his work and completes two practical assignments. One of the assignments covers conceptual design, in which the candidate should demonstrate spatial understanding, inventiveness and a feeling for form. The second assignment should show the extent to which the candidate is able to perceive visual information and record it. In a portfolio interview with the admission committee, which is composed of the department’s head or coordinator, teachers and students, numerous issues are discussed which determine whether the candidate’s potential is sufficient to start the programme. Specific admission requirements In the entrance examination during the selection day, the candidate is assessed on various aspects at the hand of different methods. The practical assignments provide information about the candidate regarding: / / providing creative and/or innovative solutions / / spatial understanding / / material sensitivity / / research skills / / perseverance / / drawing skills / / expressive ability / / insight / / personal approach The discussion of the portfolio provides information regarding: / / the environment the candidates lives in / / personal interests / / dexterity and/or sensitivity to materials / / organisational skills, initiative, abilities / / the ability to reason / / general knowledge / / knowledge of art, history, culture, architecture, etc. / / motivations and ambitions / / personal goals The emphasis is on the candidate’s artistic production (sketchbooks, objects, notes, collections) that has been created outside the framework of school. Please note: the description below applies to the new Bachelor of Design, which was implemented at the start of the academic year 2011-2012. For the current curriculum of study year four in 2013-2014 please refer to: Curriculum old style below. Full-time programme Main structure The four-year programme of the new Bachelor of Design has three phases: the propaedeutic year, the main phase and the final phase. Each phase has a specific mission. These missions follow the substantive structure of cross-pollination (year 1), depth and connection (years 2 and 3) and positioning (year 4). This chronological structure is organised in four directions, ‘the domains’, which return in each academic year. The four domains are design, morphology (labs), media & materials and knowledge & context. Characteristic of the study programme are the experiment and research elements. Each year, the research focuses on a specific area or contemporary theme. At the core of the curriculum lies a solid historical and cultural basis, and students are given the possibility to interpret this basis and integrate it into their designs. Domains The Design domain Designing is the main component and foundation of the programme. The design domain has a thematic structure. Especially in the first year, the conceptual framework is simple in set-up in order to discuss and question everyday concepts. In Interior design four subject areas are centralised: Private interior, Public Interior, Urban interior and Object 3D. From the second year onwards, the Furniture Design program focuses on the areas: Private object, Public p.95 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide / / perception 2.6.3 Study programme overview Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide object, Urban object and Object 3D. During classes, the student works under the guidance of teachers but also independently on projects in the studio space at the academy. The Morphology domain In a simulated laboratory atmosphere, autonomous exercises, examinations and free (form) studies take place in the morphology component. This domain differs from the design assignment in that students only ‘create’. The process stages from analysis to end design, which are regular to the assignments, are explicitly ignored here: it’s not about the end result, but about the process. From a certain approach or method, students instantly create, visualise and experiment. Morphology has as aim to examine, familiarise and control the phenomenon of space and form, with numerous methods and approaches. The medium or the approach partly determines the form of expression. The integration of visualisation is also an important element in this domain. The morphology domain amply addresses topics such as light, texture, relief, shape, acoustics and sound, colour, smell, etc. The Media & Materials domain In the media & materials domain, basic skills and tools are discussed, not so much to develop them, but as a means of discovery and to teach students how to apply them in design projects. This domain is therefore also a source of inspiration and functions as a trigger. Media, techniques and materials become the terrain of expertise and research. The domain covers, among others, the skills hand drawing 2D and 3D, model construction, photography, graphic design, textiles and ceramics, computer 2D and 3D, rapid prototyping, augmented reality and image processing. The teaching and mastering of the techniques and skills is not an independent element and is not the primary learning objective. This domain is equally p.96 cross-disciplinary and extends across the boundaries of the design disciplines. This study component is the student’s primary source to get optimally introduced to all departments and the wealth of facilities/workshops of the institute. The Knowledge & Context domain The knowledge & context domain covers theoretical knowledge in the form of seminars and (work) assignments relating to art philosophy, architectural theory and design theory. Additionally, lectures and excursions are organised. The Interior Architecture department offers its own annual lecture series consisting of eighteen lectures. The lecture series gives an extra theoretical impulse to the programme and matches, as closely as possible, the on-going study programme and the theme of the semester. The direct link between the selected semester theme and the programme of lectures and films (and the academy-wide Studium Generale) strengthens and supports the theoretical framework and also, specifically, the semester programme. We especially invite young (hot) talent to speak in the lecture series. Students organise a debate after each lecture or film. Excursions and tours are an essential aspect of the programme. The propaedeutic year starts with an introduction week in which the students go on excursion. In the annual excursion week, students also go on an excursion, which is often abroad. The main study programme is complemented by a number of smaller theoretically and practically themed excursions, museum visits, exhibitions, and so on. Individual Study Trajectory The Individual Study Trajectory (IST) is available for all students from the second year onwards, and aims to broaden and deepen the study. Students can follow courses in the IST on the condition that their Programme per year Year 1 [semesters 1 and 2] Propaedeutic year Mission: cross-pollination The first year of study focuses on the following core issues: Cross-disciplinary, test limits, experiment, (broad) orientation and confrontation, design, learning by doing, interaction and social network/student mixing. In the propaedeutic year students make optimal use of the workshops and facilities offered by the institute. This introduces students to all possible development and production methods. We also aim to interact with the other disciplines at the KABK. Project work is central to the first year. Each semester, students work on two main projects in the form of design assignments that are completed in different stages. Students work highly concentrated for a period of 16 weeks on these projects. The morphology domain is represented in four blocks throughout the year. The rest of the weekly programme is more or less appointed to the design projects. The knowledge & context domain, the theory component of the first year, consists of three main components: // Architectural theory and reflection: concepts and frameworks, contemporary current situation and context. // Design theory: concepts and frameworks, contemporary current situation, design, visual art and context. In the first year in the media & materials domain, the student is introduced to all departments and facilities/ workshops at the KABK. // Research and Discourse: all first year students follow the course Research and Discourse as part of the academy-wide programme. The KABK also organises a Studium Generale for all students. Additionally, we organise an annual lecture series consisting of eighteen thematic lectures. p.97 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide choice is connected to their design assignment of that period, and that the relationship between the IST choice and the assignment can be clearly demonstrated in the final assessment. The study load and the associated credits are appointed for this purpose in consultation with the team of lecturers. There are several possibilities available, such as following a minor at Leiden University. In addition to the electives, students can use the IST to deepen their study by appointing more time to the obligatory courses, or choose from the academy-wide IST offer and/ or the interdisciplinary Research Labs of the department(s). As part of the Individual Study Trajectory, students compose a study plan that requires the approval of the team of lecturers and is supervised by both the coach and the study advisor. The coach supervises students for the duration of one academic year, while the study advisor guides students throughout all their years of study. Coaches stimulate their students to work cross-disciplinary as much as possible, and to use all the expertise, facilities and workshops available. 12 EC are appointed to the IST per year. Part-time students can benefit from the offer of electives. Students can also follow courses from the fulltime or part-time curriculum in the framework of the IST (on the condition that places are available and permission has been granted). For general information about the IST please refer to chapter 6.1.3. Year 2 [semesters 3 and 4] Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Main Phase Mission: depth and connection Key concepts of the main phase are forecasting, back-casting, visionary thinking, dreams, future, here and now. Students also reflect on international and national contemporary issues, connect to the real world, and find their own position in the framework of the theme: ‘who am I’. After an introduction to the discipline, the academy and the workshops in the propaedeutic year, students apply this basic knowledge in the second year to position themselves in the framework of more complex assignments. The reality of the field and its specific focal points are addressed. Students are simultaneously encouraged to formulate the beginning of their own vision and dreams for the future as a designer. Students are expected to show more initiative and they are challenged to develop and employ their personal preferences. In the second year, two blocks Morphology are compulsory. Each academic year, the research component in both the design courses and the Morphology Labs increases in size. The department offers Research Labs in the framework of the Individual Study Trajectory (IST), which are also offered academy-wide and thus become more interdisciplinary. For more information about the IST please refer to the section ‘Individual Study Trajectory’ above, and to chapter 6.1.3. The knowledge & context domain of the second year consists of three main components: // Art reflection: visiting exhibitions, museums, galleries, platforms of contemporary art, architecture and design projects in the city, art in public spaces and buildings. p.98 / / Architectural theory: concepts and frameworks, contemporary current situation and context, anthropology and sociology. / / Design theory: concepts and frameworks, contemporary current situation and context, anthropology and sociology. Architectural and design theory in the second year are linked to project work (Mondays or Tuesdays), so that students receive direct theoretical input and are motivated to (also) explore the theory. This forms the first attempt to develop individual preferences and (private) research. In addition, we organise lectures and seminars for both architectural and design theory in line with the research themes. In the second year, in the framework of architectural and design theory, attention is given to anthropology of space and to the way students observe our relationship with spaces and objects from an anthropological and sociological perspective. Students examine and experience space and object from different perspectives: from the various spaces (public/ private), the various users (visitor, cleaner), (often culturally determined) actions, (social) behaviour and scripts that (should) take place, and the senses (what does it smell like?). The use and development of empathy plays a major role. Year 3 [semesters 5 and 6] Main Phase Mission: depth and connection The key concepts of this part of the main phase are forecasting, backcasting, visionary thinking, dreams, future, here and now, reality check, skills, knowledge, practical and professional experience, internship. Students also reflect on international and national contemporary issues, connect to the real world, and find their own position in the framework of the theme: ‘who am I’. This year also centralises the reality check: knowledge of the practical and professional environment, employee versus entrepreneur, relation to the field, industry and government, and business. An important aspect of the third year curriculum is the practice assignment: students work for external clients on real assignments in which the production and realisation within strict budgetary frameworks and with stringent planning is an important aspect. This direct link to professional practice is also made in presentations in the Netherlands and abroad, such as the annual presentation at the Salone di Mobile in Milan. Students are encouraged to work cross-disciplinary, optimally utilise the available expertise, and all facilities and workshops at the KABK. The media & materials and knowledge & context domains are expanded focusing on specific themes and techniques. These overarching themes emerge from annual themes, often related to a social context, that also guide the rest of the domains. In the fifth semester students write an internship plan. In the sixth semester they take part in an intensive period in the professional field by interning at a carefully chosen and suitable (inter)national design or architectural bureau. The main phase is concluded with the Curriculum old style Year 4 [semesters 7 and 8] Final phase: positioning Key concepts: manifestation, oeuvre, statement and portfolio, more research, in-depth research, essay/ thesis, collection development. In addition to an intensive period in the professional field in the form of an internship in semester 7, the student creates an interior architecture or furniture collection in semester 8, masters the associated techniques and is able to give his collection a position on the market. The primary goal of the final phase, which is concluded with an examination, is the candidate’s demonstration of his qualities as a designer. This means that he is able to transform his ideas into concepts, architectural solutions, furniture and product solutions, form, material, technique and detail; in the context of one or more assignments. The exam Interior Architecture or Furniture Design consists of the following components: // The creation of a design or multiple designs that address a collection of interior architecture, furniture or related subject, in its totality and broadest sense of the word. This happens within the framework of both a thematic and a self-chosen assignment, in which an interior or piece of furniture can be intensively produced. The use of technical and spatial conditions should be interesting enough to arrive at a qualitative plan. One requirement is that the plan should allow both architectural furniture and object solutions and interventions. p.99 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The third year follows the same structure as year 2, with as additional aspect the link with professional practice. In the assignments in the design domain, depth of study is achieved by emphasising the manufacturability of the designs. The students are made aware of the consequences in relation to construction, materials and costs that result from a developed concept: the reality check. Memento: an assessment of the portfolio of work created in year 2 and 3. // The creation of a design or multiple designs, which express the student’s personal mission and quality. This design determines the student’s position and his collection in its totality, and can be in line with previous projects completed in the Individual Study Trajectory. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // Previously completed designs (from previous study years) can be part of the candidate’s overall presentation, the collection. // The writing of a thesis about a subject relevant to the discipline/profession, with the aim of formulating and applying theoretical backgrounds in relation to the personal mission and beliefs. // Graduation exhibition and presentation of the collection. An important aspect of the final phase is the visual and verbal presentation of the collection, during which we expect student to position himself and to critically reflect on the discipline, his fascinations and his relationship to his collection. A schematic overview of the new and old curricula of the Interior Architecture and Furniture Design fulltime and part-time programmes, with the corresponding credits in ECs, is included at the end of this chapter. Schedule Each semester students work on two main projects, the design assignments that consist of several stages. Students are able to work very intensely on the projects over a period of sixteen weeks. On Tuesdays or Wednesdays, Morphology, the IST and the Research Labs are scheduled in. The rest of the weekly programme is more or less available for work on the projects. Students usually receive theory classes on Thursdays. p.100 On Fridays, the media & materials domain is scheduled, for the more autonomous skill exercises. The part-time programme The part-time course is predominantly similar to the full-time programme. The Individual Study Trajectory (IST), however, is offered as a taught programme. There is no compulsory internship; students are required to make their own connections in the professional field. 2.6.4 Educational and professional objectives Integral feedback At the end of the first and third block, students give a short presentation on the work done in the previous period to all teachers and fellow students. This is an informal feedback session, informative and intended as an exercise in presenting. This presentation may lead to a set of customized goals/ objectives for the next block. Individual assessments At the end of each semester, students present work done in the previous period per subject to the relevant teacher and fellow students. This can lead to a set of customized goals/ objectives for the next semester. Collective assessments Each semester is concluded with a short presentation by the student on his work from the previous period and includes the (re)presentation of the design assignment and other exercises. It is a formal assessment that is informative and intended as a presentation exercise. During the collective assessment, the student presents his work directly to the (examination) committee, the team of lecturers and the audience (fellow students). The student receives immediate feedback on his work during the presentation, and there is room for dialogue. The final assessment and internal committee deliberations take place without the student. The aim of the interaction with the team is to get an idea of the student’s work, his capacity for reflection and together formulate fitting shortterm goals/objectives for the next quarter or study year. The formula contributes to the protection of the overall quality of the programme, the student’s individual input, his progress and his continuity in the study process. Competences At the end of the programme, the student must master the Interior Architecture and Furniture Design competences of a spatial designer. This means that the student can function independently as a designer in the professional field. His development as a generic all-round designer is the programme’s primary aim. He has developed in such a way that he can apply the gained knowledge and experience to professional situations. This demands certain things of the person and the personality of the designer. Of equal importance is the student’s awareness of the cultural, social, technological and economical developments surrounding him. Engagement is the breeding ground for his method. If the designer wants to play a relevant part, he must show empathic ability; he has to be aware of his audience. The student learns to develop and profile his own position as a designer. This requires him to discover, investigate, research, question and shape his own preferences. To do so, he needs to have an independent mind-set and a reflective design attitude, and sufficiently broad theoretical and artistic knowledge and insight. The student should have ample critical reflection skills, to observe, analyse, interpret and evaluate his own work and that of others. The complete overview of the competences can be found at the end of this chapter. A designer educated at the KABK has a personal vision on the profession of designer and his place in society. He knows, in a surprising and layered manner, how to transfer meanings and to reflect on developments in the discipline and society. p.101 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Propaedeutic year assessment Students receive a binding study advice after the first year: the propaedeutic year. The student is assessed halfway through and at the end of the first year to determine whether he has acquired sufficient design skills and demonstrates visible talent to further develop into a potentially good designer. He is also assessed on the basis of his ability to connect with his environment from the position of designer. An overview of the propaedeutic year competences can be found at the end of this chapter. From an investigative attitude and an independent working process, the student is able to set new developments in motion, pick up old existing ones and continue working with them, and develop his vision, mission and oeuvre. By doing so he considers problems and subsequently solves, materialises and translates them. 2.6.5 Department organisation The head of department is responsible for the department’s policy and all aspects related to this policy. The team of lecturers reflects the content of the programme and its professional set-up. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Many of teachers have a professional practice and work either independently or in a team. Because of the diversity in experience and expertise, the student is confronted with numerous aspects and approaches of the discipline. Specific knowledge of the professional practice is offered by means of guest lectures. Head of Interior Architecture and Furniture Design Claudia Linders Wim De Vos Adjo Vreeburg Julian Wolse Morphology Krijn Christiaansen Cathelijne Montens Ellen Vos Media & Materials Marie Ilse Bourlanges Marijke Cobbenhagen Vanessa van Dam Corine Datema Sanne Dijkstra Chantal Hendriksen Elena Khurtova Harold Linker Willem Moeselaar Sanne Peper Michaël Snitker Frans Willigers Head of part-time programmes Ernst Bergmans Coordinators Roosmarijn Hompe r.hompe@kabk.nl Paul Moor p.moor@kabk.nl Internship coordinator Willem Moeselaar Study Advisor Ellen Vos Team of Lecturers Design Gert Anninga Amber Beernink Jan Harm ter Brugge Maarten Collignon Lars van Es Ingeborg Horst Barend Koolhaas Sophie Krier Jeroen van Mechelen Aura Luz Melis Wendy Legro Paul Moor Wim Ros Christoph Seyferth Ramin Visch p.102 Knowledge & Context Liesbeth Fit Inger Groeneveld Ernie Mellegers Eric Vreedenburgh Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide p.103 2.6.6 Total overview of qualifications QUALIFICATIONS Creative ability Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Capacity for critical reflection Capacity for growth and innovation Organizational ability Communicative ability External awareness Capacity for collaboration PROPAEDEUTIC YEAR MAIN PHASE, YEAR 2 At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. p.104 the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. QUALIFICATIONS Creative ability MAIN PHASE, YEAR 3 MAIN PHASE, YEAR 4 At the time of printing this guide, You are able to develop an inno- the specific final qualifications vative concept arising from your of this study year had not yet artistic ambition and research, been finalised. Please refer to elaborate it into a distinctive the website for the most up-to-date image, product, means of information. nication or spatial design, and to commu- contextualize it in a meaningful way. Capacity for critical reflection You are able to consider, analyse, the specific final qualifications interpret and assess your own and of this study year had not yet others' work, and are capable of been finalised. Please refer to constructively considering your the website for the most up-to-date findings in relation to your own information. work. At the time of printing this guide, You are able to further develop the specific final qualifications your vision, work and working of this study year had not yet methods in breadth and depth been finalised. Please refer to through an ongoing process the website for the most up-to-date of research, and in this way information. contribute to your discipline and to society. Organizational ability At the time of printing this guide, You are able to establish and the specific final qualifications maintain an inspirational and of this study year had not yet functional working environment and been finalised. Please refer to to organize your research, work and the website for the most up-to-date practice. information. Communicative ability At the time of printing this guide, You are able to effectively present the specific final qualifications your vision, research and work and of this study year had not yet engage in a dialogue with clients been finalised. Please refer to and other interested parties. the website for the most up-to-date information. External awareness At the time of printing this guide, You are able to relate your the specific final qualifications artistic practice to the artistic of this study year had not yet and social context. been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. Capacity for collaboration At the time of printing this guide, You are able to make an independent the specific final qualifications contribution to a collaborative of this study year had not yet product or process. been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. p.105 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Capacity for growth and innovation At the time of printing this guide, 2.6.7 Study points overview INTERIOR ARCHITECTURE AND FURNITURE DESIGN FULL-TIME NEW STYLE (YEAR 4 IS NOT YET AVAILABLE IN THIS FORM) Year 1 2 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 Design 12 4 12 12 12 12 Morphology 6 6 3 3 Media & Materials 6 6 4 4 4 4 4 3 1 1 Academy-wide propaedeutic year 1 project week Knowledge & Context 2 2 Research and Dicourse 3 3 Essay / thesis Programmed career preparation * Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide 4 Course 1 2 1 Internship plan and internship 2 1 1 18 End exam projects IST / Portfolio / collection 6 6 6 6 Total 30 30 30 30 30 30 EC after individual assessment 24 24 24 24 24 24 EC after collective assessment 6 6 6 6 6 6 * Incl. Business Plan Writing in year 3 1st year: Due to the changed Research & Discourse programme minor adjustments of the EC is an possibility. p.106 INTERIOR ARCHITECTURE AND FURNITURE DESIGN FULL-TIME OLD STYLE (YEARS 1,2 AND 3 ARE NO LONGER AVAILABLE IN THIS FORM) Year Course 1 2 3 4 7 8 Design 1 Design 2 Visualising Career preparation Academy-wide propaedeutic year project week End exam Internship 18 24 General Art History skills Thesis IST 6 6 6 Total 30 30 EC after individual assessment 24 24 EC after collective assessment 6 6 p.107 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Intro General Art Theory / academic INTERIOR ARCHITECTURE AND FURNITURE DESIGN PART-TIME NEW STYLE (YEAR 4 IS NOT YET AVAILABLE IN THIS FORM) Year 1 2 3 4 Course 1 2 3 4 5 6 Design 10 10 10 10 10 10 Morphology 8 8 6 6 4 4 Media & Materials 6 6 4 4 4 4 Knowledge & Context 2 2 3 3 3 3 Research and Dicourse 3 3 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 Essay / thesis Programmed career preparation (*) End exam projects Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide IST / Portfolio / collection 0 0 6 6 6 6 Total 30 30 30 30 30 30 EC after individual assessment 24 24 24 24 24 24 EC after collective assessment 6 6 6 6 6 6 * Incl. Business Plan Writing in year 3 1st year: Due to the changed Research & Discourse programme minor adjustments of the EC is an possibility. p.108 INTERIOR ARCHITECTURE AND FURNITURE DESIGN PART-TIME OLD STYLE (YEARS 1,2 AND 3 ARE NO LONGER AVAILABLE IN THIS FORM) Year Course 1 2 3 4 7 (9) 8 (10) Design 1 Design 2 Visualising.presentation Career preparation End exam 18 Theory and profession theory Internshio 24 Intro General Art Theory / Academic skills IST 6 6 6 Total 30 30 EC after individual assessment 24 24 EC after collective assessment 6 6 p.109 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Thesis 2.7 Interactive / Media / Design 2.7.1 ‘History’ of the discipline Today we can assess that the rise of interactive media has partly led to the emergence of very different applications than could be predicted at the beginning of this journey. Developments have surfaced which prove rather the opposite of some of the concepts of that time; for instance the believe that internet and mobile telephones were two separated tracks or the belief that peerto-peer communication could not be commodified. But also the assumption that every social-societal development would follow the same, linear techno-economic path. Again, we know better now; the most explosively expanding economy is that of mobile communication, in which most of the Such examples show the necessity of a re-assessment of the notions of how and where new developments (will) take place. Therefore the thinking about interactive media design demands much flexibility and a keen awareness of social developments, worldwide. The awareness of one’s own relation with society (at large) and the personal position of the designer in the ever changing field conditions of interactivity are subject to constant monitoring and training, equally important to the development of skills to express oneself. p.111 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide In the short history of interactive media there have already been a number of radical shifts in the general perception of the discipline. During the rise of the internet in the early nineteen nineties, there were two major streams of thought on how this medium could develop. On the one hand there was a strong belief that the internet would play a vital role in the expansion of individual freedom and that it would contribute highly to an accelerated media-emancipation of the attuned participant. However, at the same time this freedom was celebrated, most developments were highly clustered around individual, immobile usage. Technical developments had not advanced to the current level; mobile communication was still mainly operating in the professional domain, broadband internet was only accessible to a few and only used for professional purposes and the costs of participation were still significantly higher. Most of the applications outside of the professional domain were built to serve on stationary, slow personal computers with a very limited access to the internet. capacity is not being used for making telephone-calls yet it is based on the technology developed specifically for that purpose. The fastest growing companies (like Facebook, You-Tube etcetera) are basically re-sellers of content generated by its own clients – now transformed into prosumers, being producers and consumers at the same time - proving that it is no necessity to have a central core of production (or any production capacity at all) to generate streams of sellable content. If we look at the techno-economic progression in most of the African countries, we can see that ‘the new participant’ enters on the most advanced level, in other words; there is no need to go through all the in-between stages like stationary computers, fixed telephone-lines or even traditional television to get to the most progressed level of participation. Most Africans have never seen their Facebook profile on a ‘normal computer’ but only on their smart-phone and many of these participants use the same phone also to pay for their daily shopping (through an app like M-Pesa for instance) not only in the shopping mall but also on the local market. This type of usage is very advanced in comparison with regions with a longer history of usage. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide 2.7.2 The actuality of Interactive / Media / Design As the implementation of media-convergence has probably not reached its full potential yet and as the concepts and perceptions of what interactive media are keep changing at high velocity, it serves little purpose to actually speak of a history of interactive media as a separate part of its progress. Of all the disciplines which are identified at the Royal Academy, Interactive / Media / Design is probably the hardest one to define on bases of what has been. A common misconception is that interactive media design is synonymous to interaction design. Interaction design focusses mostly on the development of software and computer-human interfaces. It is an essential part of Interactive / Media / Design, but explicitly not all inclusive - for the arguments mentioned before demand a perspective which is overarching all specific media. Designing in the trail of ‘Moores Law’ under which effects processing speed, computing and memory capacity roughly doubles every eighteen months, new potential is unlocked in a constant and predictable rate. Yet, whatever possibilities this generates is not a given. The designer stands in the middle and transduces notions from the virtual to the actual and vice versa, in which media themselves play an affording role, but not hold the key to expose the true meaning of this future development. The creation of new interaction can never be separated from the designer or the conditions it emerges from. New forms of interaction can be self-referential, but never be detached. This meta-medial perception is probably the hardest ‘skill’ to master during the studies at this department, after all there is a constant demand of producing physical products (which obviously could be digital as p.112 well, the oxymoron of modern media) and yet there is a keen awareness that the real progress in media development is not found by simply just crafting a new application for your I-phone or another MMORPG. For these reasons, the central question is always; what is interaction? If you would have addressed this issue twenty, fifteen or ten years ago you could expect a range of answers which were as true, as they were not. Today not many know what the role and importance of products like ATF-3, CD-i, altavista or second life was (or even what they were at all), yet just a few years ago these were regarded as highly innovative and exemplary in the field of interactive media. The quest for a definition of interaction is key for the involvement of all participants in this department, scholars, tutors and student alike. At the same time all share the awareness that there is no singular answer. The focus must therefore be directed on the capacities of the media we deal with, rather than their properties, not because the latter will not be able to stand the test of time, but especially because interaction only exists in relations, and not in the object itself. These dynamic, energising and agile conditions shape the ‘habitat’ of a special breed of creator; the Interactive / Media / Designer. 2.7.3 Profile of the department Description of the department Interactive / Media / Design is the youngest department of the Royal Academy of Art training students to become designers of interactive concepts and processes. I/M/D lays down the link between people and processes as well as those between people and products. Ideas are our main product and that’s why students at I/M/D are taught to think in non-media specific terms, which are later translated into a concept and meta-medial, multi-medial or cross-medial applications. Students work with real cases and commissions, focusing on the international market. To strengthen the student’s expertise and their chances of reaching an international audience the department uses English for all its courses. Since the demand for media designers is constantly growing, I/M/D provides the education necessary for independent, social, conceptual, creative and pan medial-designers. The program is built up to efficiently engage numerous media-typologies. At the start of the program the student is immersed in courses such as: Interaction Design, Graphic Design, Photography, Sound-Design and Visualizing. After this extensive introduction the focus shifts towards individual development of the student. I/M/D pushes the limits of media with courses such as Concept Development, Meta-Medial Thinking and Personal Leadership, the student will be faced with the question, “What can I do with this knowledge and what role do I play? With these questions in mind the student goes on to encounter courses such as: Multimedia Artistic Development, Creative Leadership, Critical Media, Storytelling as well as more in depth levels of Interaction Design, Concept Development and Moving-Image. I/M/D continues to be in close contact with the professional field in order to keep informed and to deepen existing insight. Students are involved in this process through dialog with the teachers; collective attendance to conferences such as C.C.C. and PICNIC; co-organizing symposia as MasterMundo; creating new knowledge and inspiring networks such as Pool of Masterminds; plus organizing challenging internships in the Netherlands as well as abroad. After graduation students will be able to maneuver in branched networks at different levels, be seekers of knowledge with the broad perspectives necessary to become independent communication specialists. This will allow graduates to compete for positions at large commercial or non-profit communication agencies internationally. I/M/D is the department for those students who have the ambition to impact society through interactive media. Professional profile A graduate of Interactive Media Design has a variety of possible positions to consider. The fact that IMD does not focus on or specialises in one particular medium, often leads to the misreading that it is not a specialisation in itself. The department was started as a reaction to the increasing demand from the professional field for a type of designer which is knowledgeable enough to communicate about media specific issues with various media special- p.113 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Students learn to detect cultural, social, technological and economic trends in society and transfer those trends into promising new concepts. During the course of the study one learns how to work with a variety of media techniques necessary to communicate with specialists on a professional level and to apply those techniques to their optimal level. Equally important are the methods enabling the student to keep an overview of the process as well as the setting and realization of goals. Collaboration is an essential part in preparing for the professional circuit. At I/M/D the students learn to assess their own expertise as well as those of their colleagues, which is the key in collaborating successfully. Many projects are executed collectively, often teaming up with students from different years. This way of working already places the students into a studio setting during their studies. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide ists, yet holds enough distance to be able to translate clients demands and wishes into media expressions. At the same time this designer should have a keen understanding of the rapidly changing field of media and their usage, which demand an attitude that embraces change and finds solidity in instability. Positions which are envisioned were that of art-director, concept developer, communication strategist or senior media developer. In spite of its short history (the first I/M/D graduates received their diploma in 2010) most alumni have found a professional position in the described category or similar. We currently find them all over the globe (Berlin, Hong Kong, Los Angeles) working for a commercial or non-profit organisation. End-qualifications These qualifications are expressed in seven competencies within three domains. The Royal Academy has drafted these competencies in line with the national guidelines for the studies in design. During the four years of study, our students will be tested on the development of these competencies, each step at a more challenging level. The competences are: // Creativity // Critical reflection // Growth and innovation // Organizing // Communication // Relating to the environment // External awareness // Ability to collaborate These competencies are the basis of the evaluation by the teachers at the end of each course and they are also used to evaluate the presentations at the end of each semester. In turn, twice a year an evaluation meeting is held for the students to evaluate the programme and suggest improvements. A more detailed description of the p.114 requirements can be found at the end this section of this study guide. The students are tested on the development in this range of professional competencies within three domains: / / Artistic Technical domain / / Theoretical domain / / Professional social domain The parameters for the development of a renewing department like Interactive / Media / Design reflect in the development of an enriched and relevant set of competences. We have chosen to handle projective approach towards the educational goals. This means we try to keep as close as possible to our original set of parameters without focussing too much on outcome. This way I/M/D will remain flexible, participatory creative/reacting and able to swiftly adjust its course if necessary. The parameters of I/M/D are: / / Creativity and innovation / / New thinking / / The I/M/D staff and students have to work with real problems, real people and real conflicts. / / Never out of touch with what is happening in society. / / Students should be brave and take risks. / / Creative, ambitious, curious, risk-taking, social engaged. / / A unique educational program for young people who wish to make a positive difference in society. / / How do we best unlock the creative and innovative forces in each individual and in society as a whole? / / The study has had and should always have a direct link with the private, public and voluntary field. // / / The idea is to help organisations and individuals master the capability for innovation and creativity, leveraging the I/M/D philosophy and methodology. / / Creating, testing, displaying, unfolding great ideas, products, services and learning. Diploma The study entitles graduates to the title Bachelor of Design (BDes) and gives access to additional study programs on the master level. Admission-procedure Candidates apply through the internet, they fill out the application form and receive a document with a specification of the documents they have to produce before the admission interview. After examination of these documents, candidates are invited for a day of admissions; during this day candidates are asked to work on a task, specifically design to test some of the specific qualifications. Besides this they will be interviewed by a panel consisting of a coordinator, several tutors and occasionally also students. During the interview all kinds of questions are put, hopefully not only by the panel; during the day it is really meant to determine if the candidate fits in the department and if the department fits the candidate, it is not an exam in anyway. Letter of motivation In the letter of motivation candidates describe: // their creative past (see also portfolio); // forms of interactivity, media and design they are interested in; // techniques mastered; // software mastered (basic knowledge of Adobe Photoshop is a big plus. Some experience of Adobe Illustrator, Adobe InDesign, Flash, After Effects is helpful.); // previous education; // what they want to achieve in their studies; // general interest in culture, society, communication, technology at large; // specific interests in genres, styles, other disciplines and technology; // what they want to contribute to the learning environment; // questions they have regarding the study (reflecting an ability to transform opinions into questions; this is important since exploration, research, clear communication and understanding are basic elements in the program); // curriculum vitae (resume); // the new niche they want to create in the design practice of creative industries. p.115 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Follow-up studies With the acquired diploma, alumni could chose to enrol in a master program. Some interesting programs can be found in Holland, to name a few: Master Artistic Research (KABK), Master Media Design and Communication (PZI), Master Interactive Media and Environments (FMI), Master Media Studies (UvA). Specific Admission requirements Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Portfolio In the portfolio candidates comprehensively describe earlier works, performances, interactive, media or design projects or other contributions to the field of communication. Illustrated with photos, drawings, reviews, etc. The portfolio may be illustrated with recordings on cd-rom, video DVD, audio cd, any commonly used data carrier that works on a modern computer or web links. Candidates should mark a maximum of 3 minutes they absolutely want to be viewed or heard by the selection committee. General note: we recommend to make a selection of a maximum of three relevant projects. The best project should always be the first project to be shown. We would like to receive (a selection of) your portfolio by email together with your letter of motivation. Make sure that you do not exceed a maximum file size of 5 MB per email. So when needed send multiple emails, with a clear subject and please number them. You can, of course, also disclose your portfolio online. Official documents A copy of your passport, a visa (when applicable), a copy of your diploma(s), two passport photos and your email address should be sent in or taken to the interview. Note that some of these documents could be handed in later if not yet available at this moment (visa, diploma etc.), but should in any case be ready to transfer at the moment of acceptance to the academy. 2.7.4 Overview of the study-program Interactive/Media/Design is offered as a full-time program, which lays the emphasis on research and self-development. The courses are structured according a logical pedagogical line of development, which does not recognize very sharp boundaries; it is unlikely that anyone would ever be able to stop learning or would p.116 disregard anything that is useful in the development of one’s interest. It is rather a fluently shaped scale, allowing for acceleration of the learning curve at almost any stage. The structure of the program unfolds into five major phases; / / Skill development / / (Advanced) Skill application / / Research-development / / Exploration of the professional domain / / Self-development These phases are divided over the four year program, but - as argued before – do not always require a hard cut in between them. For instance one could imagine that whilst mastering a certain skill, one could already be working with another skill on a much more advanced level at the same time, or that as a result of a particular research interest the necessity arises to master yet another skill-set. This is translated into a certain clustering of courses and leaves room (from the second year on) for a fully personalized, individual study-trajectory, which allows for the in-depth exploration of a specific field of interest. This program (IST) needs to be constructed by the students themselves and can contain the development of an original project in or outside the school or could be filled by taking courses in other departments or at Leiden University, varying from very practical to the very philosophical. The development of the competencies through the five phases can be divided over the three major domains as follows: Artistic Technical domain\ // Skill development // (Advanced) Skill application Theoretical domain / / Research-development / / Self-development Professional social domain These courses can be roughly divided over the three major domains as follows: Artistic Technical domain // Interaction Design I // Moving Image I / / Exploration of the professional domain // Graphic Design / / Self-development // Sound Design // Visualizing Programme Year 1 Propedeuse Skill development / / Concept Development / / Interaction Design I / / Moving Image I / / Graphic Design / / Art Theory / / Visualizing / / Sound Design / / Connecting the Dots / / Introduction into Science / / Academiebrede Propedeuse Projectweek (ABPP) // Art Theory // Introduction into Science Professional social domain // Concept Development // Academiebrede Propedeuse Projectweek (ABPP) // Connecting the Dots To give an example of one of the courses, the detailed description of Interaction Design 1: How to create intelligent, responsive media environments and shape the two-way communication between the human and the machine? What factors are essential in the design of interactive applications appealing to our senses, triggering emotions, influencing our behaviour and way of thinking? Interaction Design focuses on mastering elementary conceptual, visual and technical skills required in many interactive media productions. The students work on projects based on individual concepts, create their own visuals and animations, but mostly develop one of the most challenging and fundamental elements underlying the structure of interactive systems – the code. Exercises in scripting graphics, programming feedbacks, coding interfaces are p.117 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide In the first year students are introduced to a range of skills and will construct a set of mental models which will allow them to get control over the newly discovered domains of this department. The goal is to provide the student with enough knowledge to be able to independently produce media expressions using the mastered skill-sets and lay the foundation for the advanced development of those skills. Many students have a preferred medium they like to work with and usually this selection is made during this year. After having successfully completed the first year you will receive a diploma which gives access to the second year, but also allows to enter the second year of similar programmes in terms of requirements. The courses in the first year are: Theoretical domain // Concept Development evaluated in terms of beauty, functionality, usability and other issues related to user experience. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Year 2 (Advanced) Skill application and Research-development During the second year the emphasis of the study shifts more towards the application of the acquired skill-sets and the development of a more distinct personal interest in a specific direction. This is also the time to start the Individual Study Trajectory (IST) which allows to spend one day a week solely on one topic or course. Obviously all years are important, but the second year is rather a special year in the sense that it demands a much more outspoken view on the why rather than the how and what. This journey will lay the personal foundation for the rest of the study and is generally not regarded to be very easy. After all, it is not a light task to find a way to identify your own strengths and weaknesses and connect a set of important decisions to that. But this is not something one has to do alone, guidance is integrated into the course and there is also a special guide for devising the individual study trajectory. As writing is an essential part of modern communication, a special course is designed to improve the student capacities to express themselves in the written word, obviously using the English language: Writing Life is designed for students to achieve fluency in the art of written communication. English language skills are essential to reaching an international audience. Much of today’s information, whether through the internet or more traditional means is exchanged through the written word. Although an artist’s work is image based, written communication is required if she/he wants people to gain a deeper knowledge of their expertise. Through various p.118 writing exercises, critique and assignments covering commercial, academic and creative writing, the students will come away with knowledge and skills that will give them confidence in world of written interaction. The courses in the second year are: / / Interactive Architecture / 3D / / Interaction Design II / / Moving Image II / / Photography / / Writing / / Individual Study Trajectory / / Connecting the Dots These courses can be roughly divided over the three major domains as follows: Artistic Technical domain / / Interaction Design II / / Moving Image II / / Photography Theoretical domain / / Connecting the Dots / / Writing Professional social domain / / Interactive Architecture / 3D / / Individual Study Trajectory Year 3 Research, self-expression and exploration of the professional domain The third year consists of two very different parts, the first semester is devoted to the critical reflection of all that has been acquired in knowledge and skills and the second semester is reserved for the execution of the internship. The courses in the first semester aim to connect the personal, creative development to the possibilities and demands of the outside world, not only as a preparation for the internship, but also to reflect on trends and overly celebrated gadgetry as being almost circumstantial, rather than essential. The internships vary in execution; there have been highly commercial jobs in very competitive International environments but also fully research driven ecological awareness programs for large International non-profit organisations - and everything in between – yet all have in common that they we perceived as very satisfying collaborations, which in some cases even directly led to a job offer. The critical standpoint is clearly reflected in this course: The courses in the third year are: // Writing Life // Multimedia Artistic Development // Cultural Hacking // ALEPH // Internship // Workshop 3D These courses can be roughly divided over the three major domains as follows: Artistic Technical domain // Individual Study Trajectory Theoretical domain // Writing Life // Multimedia Artistic Development // Cultural Hacking // ALEPH Professional social domain // Internship // Workshop 3D Year 4 Self expression The final year of your studies will provide many moments of excitement and joy, but obviously demands also a long period of hard work and many difficult decisions need to be made. The final exam is not only the closure of your studies, but (equally important) the start of your career as an interactive media designer. The academy takes much pride in organising the exposition of the final work because it is very aware this could be the catalyst for the indi- p.119 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Critical Media; Engage critically with contemporary society. The Critical Media Course has the ambitious goal of critically examining contemporary society. Such critic can only be honest and prolific when based on introspection. The students of Interactive, Media, Design are proposed to first and foremost revise in a critical manner their working methodology, together with their sources of information and inspiration. Grounded on the importance of information and knowledge for contemporary society, questions of control and power are fundamental to understand and engage actively in society. “Who controls the information flow?” and “How is knowledge produced and distributed?” are questions that are discussed in this course based on insights from contemporary philosophers and thinkers such as Noam Chomsky and Jean Baudrillard. Once critical thinking has been seeded, the next step is to point creative experiments that are busy with the exposed questions. Tactical media and hacktivism are two possible approaches that include art organizations like “The yes men”, Jodi, HeHe, Ubermorgen and art project like “Google will eat itself”, “Image Fulgurator” and “anti-social networking”, etc. Finally and most importantly, during the course, critical projects are developed in order to experiment and test some of the concepts discussed. The course ends with a public event where the outcomes are discussed with a larger audience. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide vidual designer to distinguish him or herself in the professional field. During the final year, there are several important issues to address and boxes to be ticked. You have to produce a thesis, which researches a field of your interest, which is closly related to your final exam. You will also have to produce a business plan, assuring that you will have been properly introduced in the field of the legislative and financial side of your practice as (independent) designer. And of course you will have to produce a spectacular and innovative venture, which will serve as your graduation project. In order to ensure that you will have all the attention directed towards this you will be guided by several experts. During individual and/or collective meetings you will gradually progress to the final stage; the exhibition of final exams. The courses in the fourth year are: // Senior Seminar // Exam and Concept Guidance // Thesis // Business plan // Individual Study Trajectory // Final Exam Artistic Technical domain // Concept Development 3 // Interactive Architecture Theoretical domain // Thesis Professional social domain // Business plan 2.7.5 Educational- and professional goals Interactive / Media / Design does not focus on a particular medium, p.120 the development of conceptual and theoretical skills is just as important as the development of practical skills. The program offers these core values by applying a point of departure which rest on three specific parameters: / / Integrated Theory: Apart from the clearly theoretical driven courses (like Art Theory), most courses have an integrated theoretical component. This means that skills are not presented without their context and history, personal development is connected to larger systems in society and methods are always critically tested. This ensures that all students gain a built-in layer of theory, which they cannot always identify, but will become visible once they start to put their accomplishments in practice. / / Intrinsic professional bounding: Intrinsic bounding with the professional practise is reached through the expertise and connectedness of our teaching staff. Almost all staff-members have their own professional practice and they will connect the practice of the actuality as much as they can to the educational goals. This leads to a very high percentage of actual case-studies with which the students can work and several integrated projects have been undertaken in collaboration with the professional-field. / / Self-development: Although Interactive / Media / Design is a department that specifically operates in the realm of design, we are very much aware of the opportunities given by the fact that we are part of an art academy, as opposed to a being embedded in a more technical setting or being part of a very skills driven environment. We take the legacy of the fine arts tradition very seriously and strive to embrace a total conceptual freedom, although the products produced might be designed out of a concrete and pragmatic brief. In order to be able to fully address the individual students potential, we invest much time in the development of the artistic and conceptual qualities of the students. Artistic Technical domain As argued, the development of the artistic domain as a ‘freestanding’ quality is regarded as highly valuable at our department. From the very start we engage an open and constructive dialog with our students. In this specific field, where we cannot be sure of the effects of new developments, we believe it is instrumental and essential to maintain an open vision in which the (practical) research done by all participants (scholars, lecturers and students) delivers crucial information which contributes to the better understanding of future developments, both in the practical, as well as in the artistic domain. Professional social domain Modern designers cannot afford to take a fully soloistic attitude; the professional domain brings a wide variety of collaborations and hybrid forms of authorship. By the intrinsic insertion of haptic, virtual and actual communication and by constantly working with real commissions and projects, we endeavour linking our students to the emerging network of co-designers and professionals which is quintessential for the design industry. Students start building the valuable networks which will prove to be economically essential in their career from the first day they enter the academy, we help them understand the importance of that and support any kind of expansion by connecting and interlinking networks of all involved; inside and outside the academy. Theoretical domain The integrated intake of theoretical components through the application in and attachment of these notions to very concrete course goals, sets the ground for a fundamental understanding of the need to contextualize the work and leads to the investigation of one’s own position in this field of labour. Theoretical intake cannot be seen separated from its application, theory and practise are confined to each other. By deliberately steering away from the clas- p.121 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Within the three major domains in which students will master their sets of competencies, Interactive / Media / Design has attached some specific qualification to the deployment of their key values. sical models of theoretical input, we strive to prevent the ‘airlock’ which occurs when the connection between theory and practise is not made clear and theory is ‘superimposed’ on the reality of practice, rather than been made elementary part of. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide 4.6.6 Organisation of the department The coordinators have the responsibility for the department’s policy and all aspects which are directly connected to this policy. The staff reflects the content of the departmental policy and a broad professional set-up. A large number of the staff is employed in the professional field, where they work individually or collectively. By confronting the students with a wide variety of individual viewpoints and values, they will develop a positive yet critical stance towards the profession. Specific knowledge is offered in the form of Master classes, workshops and attending conferences. I/M/D can be reached through: imd@kabk.nl Coordinators: In charge of content: Marc Boumeester M.Boumeester@kabk.nl In charge of organisation: Dave Wille D.Wille@kabk.nl Lecturers (in alphabetical order): Anna Arov Marc Boumeester Arthur Elsenaar Maartje Fliervoet Johan Gustavsson Guy Hafkamp Michael van Hoogenhuyze Jonathan Looman Remus Ockels Gitta Pardoel Pawel Pokutycki Shayna Schapp Jan Treffers Raymond Taudin Chabot p.122 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide p.123 2.7.6 Total overview of qualifications QUALIFICATIONS Creative ability Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Capacity for critical reflection Capacity for growth and innovation Organizational ability Communicative ability External awareness Capacity for collaboration PROPAEDEUTIC YEAR MAIN PHASE, YEAR 2 At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. p.124 the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. QUALIFICATIONS Creative ability MAIN PHASE, YEAR 3 MAIN PHASE, YEAR 4 At the time of printing this guide, You are able to develop an inno- the specific final qualifications vative concept arising from your of this study year had not yet artistic ambition and research, been finalised. Please refer to elaborate it into a distinctive the website for the most up-to-date image, product, means of information. nication or spatial design, and to commu- contextualize it in a meaningful way. Capacity for critical reflection You are able to consider, analyse, the specific final qualifications interpret and assess your own and of this study year had not yet others' work, and are capable of been finalised. Please refer to constructively considering your the website for the most up-to-date findings in relation to your own information. work. At the time of printing this guide, You are able to further develop the specific final qualifications your vision, work and working of this study year had not yet methods in breadth and depth been finalised. Please refer to through an ongoing process the website for the most up-to-date of research, and in this way information. contribute to your discipline and to society. Organizational ability At the time of printing this guide, You are able to establish and the specific final qualifications maintain an inspirational and of this study year had not yet functional working environment and been finalised. Please refer to to organize your research, work and the website for the most up-to-date practice. information. Communicative ability At the time of printing this guide, You are able to effectively present the specific final qualifications your vision, research and work and of this study year had not yet engage in a dialogue with clients been finalised. Please refer to and other interested parties. the website for the most up-to-date information. External awareness At the time of printing this guide, You are able to relate your the specific final qualifications artistic practice to the artistic of this study year had not yet and social context. been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. Capacity for collaboration At the time of printing this guide, You are able to make an independent the specific final qualifications contribution to a collaborative of this study year had not yet product or process. been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. p.125 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Capacity for growth and innovation At the time of printing this guide, 2.7.7 Study points overview INTERACTIVE/MEDIA/DESIGN FULL-TIME Year 1 2 Semester 1 2 Visualising 5 5 Sound Design 5 Interaction Design 6 Graphic Design 5 Moving Image 3 3 4 5 4 6 6 6 6 6 Workshop 6 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Interactive Architecture 6 End exam projects 12 Academy-wide propaedeutic year 18 1 project week Ideas in Reality 4 Creative Leadership 6 Internship 24 Business Plan 6 6 6 6 6 Conceptualisation 6 6 Writing Life 6 6 Critical Media 6 Theory: thesis Research and Discourse 8 5 Photography Concept Development 7 6 3 3 6 6 6 6 6 6 Total 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 EC after individual assessment 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 EC after collective assessment 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 Individual Study Trajectory (IST) 1st year: Due to the changed Research & Discourse programme minor adjustments of the EC is a possibilty. p.126 2.8 Textile & Fashion 2.8.1 General description of the discipline Please note: at the KABK, the specialisations textile design and fashion design are represented in one programme. However, they each hold their separate place in the programme, to provide students with the possibility to graduate in either fashion design or textile design. Origins, community and tradition in textile form are global points of recognition. One can easily learn about important events, personal histories and lifestyles throughout history from textiles. Textile also reflects recognition, acknowledgment and status. Wealth, vision and aesthetics are strongly expressed by textile and party influence the behaviour and values of a culture. The influences from a rich history of textiles are an important source of inspiration for a textile designer. Textile as a status symbol and trade has evolved in such a way over time, that the two have become inseparable. Fashion, the phenomenon of an everchanging taste in clothes, did not originate until in the Renaissance according to some, while others say it came into being at the court of Louis XIV, where the mistresses of the French court started to decide what was fashionable. The real breakthrough came in nineteenth century with the emergence of the bourgeoisie, the acceptance of the Enlightenment and the appointment of concepts of individuality and personality as central to modern culture. Current situation of the discipline ‘Fashion is a temporary transient, but at some time generally assimilated, social or artistic custom, particularly of clothing and attire’ (dictionary definition). Fashion demonstrates its approaches to time and history in a specific way. Fashion design can therefore be described as a visual expression of a period, as a reflection of society and as a form of communication through the language of clothing. Those involved in fashion, especially fashion designers, will therefore constantly question the ethics and aesthetics of fashion. By exploring the boundaries of the discipline, designers are encouraged to find innovative forms, new colour combinations and ways of processing or developing new fabrics. A fashion designer has a natural interest in the unknown and the new. Each season he re-invents himself and creates a new system of meanings. Textile design is a discipline that is explored both autonomously and in relation to associated disciplines. It is equally essential that the designer finds a personal balance p.129 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide History of the discipline Textile has always been, and still is, an important expression of culture and zeitgeist. The dictionary defines textile as ‘a cloth, especially one manufactured by weaving or knitting; a fabric’. Initially, climate and weather circumstances gave textile a primarily protective function. Charles Frederick Worth (1825-1895), the Englishman and founder of French haute couture, is considered to be the first couturier. After seven years of training in the London textile industry, he arrived in Paris as a 20-year-old fashion designer. Worth was the first fashion designer who grew to stardom because he gave his garments artwork status. Furthermore, he presented a new collection every year, with which he established the sales-enhancing constant renewal of fashion, from which designers still profit today. He designed the artificial crinoline, the ‘cul de paris’, and several cutting techniques without which the fashion history would not be the same today. Worth was the first designer to combine an English cutting technique with French glitter and glamour. between the textiles and the time period. The urge to communicate by means of materials, craft and tradition through form and structure keeps evolving, whether or not connected to form, dimension and content. Fashion, and textile by association, has become an international language. Fashion designers use the semiotics of clothing to extend boundaries and to experiment with identities and appearances. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide 2.8.2 Study profile Contemporary professional practice: the professional profile Below is the description of the professional profile on which the study programme Textile & Fashion at the KABK is based. Textile designers and fashion designers have a natural interest in the new and unknown. They have that ‘visionary’ talent, which can also be observed in visual artists, that seems to enable them to predict what the future will look like and what an industry will need. This implies that the designer is aware of the time period and society, and that he is able to think and act interdisciplinary. This presupposes a flexible attitude, because in order to keep afloat in this evolution, designers have to keep re-inventing themselves. The field has laid down rules concerning research, visualisation, visual language, execution, presentation, professional demeanour and potential possibilities for growth. In order to guarantee the evolution, growth and expansion of their work and the discipline, individual designers must be able to apply, manipulate and help determine these rules. Fashion designer A fashion designer demonstrates a broad and general interest and shows social involvement. He is interested in sociology, anthropology, semi- p.130 otics, psychology and visual culture, which provide him with a sufficient artistic, practical and theoretical framework with which to develop his own views and create an authentic image in the form of a collection. Textile designer A textile designer has to be able to develop a personal view and image for independent spatial textile works related to the time period. The development and processing of materials and forms in relation to their surroundings is equally important. This can concern the beautifying an interior, clothing, industrial needs, product development or autonomous expression. Textile designers provide answers to questions posed by society and those that arise in the areas of technology, art and fashion. Additionally, textile design is the translation of a feeling about surface and/or the manifestation of form in relation to space. Description of the programme Students are educated to become textile or fashion designers. Unique at the KABK is the fact that the specialisations textile design and fashion design are represented in one programme. However, they each hold their separate place in the programme, to provide students with the possibility to graduate in either fashion design or textile design. In 2003, the specialisations were completely restructured according to the model of the fashion department at the Royal Academy of Fine Arts in Antwerp. The aim of the programme is to train students to become independent designers. Students are encouraged to develop their own personal view and signature, for which they have to create a relevant balance between the fashion and textile aspects in their work, and show the ability to interconnect these aspects. The designing of a collection is central to the programme. The programme does not have one singular perspective as its point of departure; it rather confronts students with the past, the present and the future. From these perspectives students extensively analyse fashion and textiles. For example, in assignments much attention is paid to the history of costumes and folklore. Final qualifications Textile & Fashion The graduate meets the following final qualifications: / / You are able to develop an innovative concept arising from your artistic ambition and research, elaborate it into a distinctive image, product, means of communication or spatial design, and to contextualize it in a meaningful way (creative ability) / / You are able to consider, analyse, interpret and assess your own and others’ work, and // You are able to further develop your vision, work and working methods in breadth and depth through an ongoing process of research, and in this way contribute to your discipline and to society (capacity for growth and innovation) // You are able to establish and maintain an inspirational and functional working environment and to organize your research, work and practice (organizational ability) // You are able to effectively present your vision, research and work and engage in a dialogue with clients and other interested parties (communicative ability) // You are able to relate your artistic practice to the artistic and social context (external awareness) // You are able to make an independent contribution to a collaborative product or process (capacity for collaboration) Diploma Graduates are awarded a Bachelor of Design (BDes) in textile or fashion design. Post-graduate studies After receiving their Bachelor’s degree in fashion or textile design, graduates can enrol in a master’s programme in in fashion or textile design (M Design). In these post-graduate studies the emphasis can be on the design of textile collections for the fashion and/or interior design industry, textile application for products, concept development, product styling and so on. p.131 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The programme is designed in such a way, that at a certain point the textile and fashion specialisations separate into two different programmes, which are shaped by characteristics of each respective specialisation. The Textile & Fashion department focuses on innovation, experimentation, improvisation, analysis, reflection and insight. By exploring the boundaries of the discipline, students are encouraged to search for innovative forms, new colour combinations and ways of using or creating new materials. A diverse offer of courses stimulates students’ interest in the new and unknown (characteristic of the fashion and textile designer), including art history, costume history, fashion and visual development. Drawing is an important part of the curriculum. Through observational model drawing, students learn to observe and analyse, develop their artistic talents and qualities, design and communicate. are capable of constructively considering your findings in relation to your own work (capacity for critical reflection) Admission procedure Applicants can find information about the programme on the KABK website. Those who wish to apply can register with the student administration for an entrance examination and provide the appropriate documents. The candidate will then receive an invitation for the selection day and is asked to bring the following: // p ortfolio; // own work; // sketch books; // collections; Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // subjects or images that relate to his own fascinations. During the selection day the candidate is shortly introduced to the programme and will take part in: The discussion of the portfolio provides: // i nsight into personal interests; // i nformation about the candidate’s environment and way of thinking; // i nformation about the candidate’s dexterity and/or sensitivity to materials; / / insight into candidate’s ability to organise and initiate. The emphasis is on the student’s own work (sketchbooks, notes, collections) that have been made independent of an assignment or school. The candidate’s answers during the interview illustrate his: / / p ersonal interests; // a bility to reason; // a practical test (morning); / / g eneral knowledge; // a drawing test (afternoon); // k nowledge of art, history, culture, textiles, fashion, architecture, etc.; // an interview based on partly on the candidate’s portfolio and work. / / m otivation; / / a mbition; The candidate is informed whether he has been accepted or not within two weeks of the selection day. Specific admission requirements During the selection day, the candidate will be assessed with various methods on a number of aspects. The drawing test provides information about: / / p ersonal goals. The written motivation provides: // i nformation about the candidate’s ambition and passion; // i nsight into the ability to communicate in words. // the ability to observe; // dexterity; // d rawing skills; // v isual skills; // i nsight; // p erseverance; // p ersonal approach; // p ersonal signature. p.132 2.8.3 Study programme overview full-time The study duration is four years. Completion of the first year (the propaedeutic year) entitles students to continue in the main phase of the programme. Completion of the second and third year subjects entitles students to enter the final phase, which consists of finishing an internship, a thesis and the gradua- tion project: the collection (final phase). Students make a definite choice between the specialisations textile design or fashion design for the second, third and forth year, no later than the beginning of the second year. // V isualising: Visual Development, Photography // D rawing: Model Drawing, Fashion Drawing, 2D Forms and Colour Studies // T heory: Introduction to General Art History, Introduction to Science, Art History and Fashion Theory // T extile and Fashion Design, year 1 (propaedeutic year) // T extile Design year 2 (main phase) or Fashion Design year 2 (main phase) // T extile Design year 3 (main phase) of Fashion Design year 3 (main phase) The various programme components are clustered as follows: // D esign I: Textile Design, Fashion Design // D esign II: Technical design - Textile, Technical Design Fashion // V isualizing: Visual Development, Photography // D rawing: Model Drawing, 2D Forms and Colour Studies, Fashion Drawing // T heory: Art history, Fashion Theory, Thesis // O ther: Internship, Individual Study Trajectory Textile Design Year 2 (main phase) // D esign I: Textile design // D esign II: Technical Design Textile // V isualizing: Visual Development, Photography // D rawing: Model Drawing, 2D Forms and Colour Studies // T heory: Art history, Fashion Theory // O ther: Individual Study Trajectory Fashion Design Year 2 (main phase) // D esign I: Fashion design // D esign II: Technical Design Fashion // V isualizing: Visual Development, Photography // D rawing: Model Drawing, 2D Forms and Colour Studies, Fashion Drawing // T heory: Art history, Fashion Theory Propaedeutic year Textile & Fashion Year 1 // D esign I: Textile design and Fashion design // D esign II: Technical design Textile, and Technical design Fashion Textile Design Year 3 (main phase) // D esign I: Textile design // D esign II: Technical Design Textile // V isualizing: Visual Development, Photography p.133 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // T extile Design year 4 (final phase) of Fashion Design year 4 (final phase) Main Phase // D rawing: Model Drawing, 2D Forms and Colour Studies // T heory: Art history, Business Plan Writing // O ther: Individual Study Trajectory // Fashion Design Year 3 (main phase) // D esign I: Fashion design // D esign II: Technical Design Fashion // V isualizing: Visual Development, Photography Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // D rawing: Model Drawing, Fashion Drawing // T heory: Art history, Fashion Theory, Business Plan Writing // O ther: Individual Study Trajectory Final phase In the final phase of the study programme, external assessors from the field are invited to the department of Textile & Fashion. Some of their important responsibilities include taking a critical look at the design process, reading the thesis, attending the ‘walk-through’ and concept evaluation, and the final evaluation of the presentation of the collection. The interaction between students and the external assessors helps students to better attune their final results to the situation in the professional field. Students measure their results against the external professional context. The final evaluation of the final phase is one of the important parts of the career preparation. The presentation of the textile and fashion collections is held at various locations in the city (a simulation of professional routes in Paris, Milan and New York). Students complete the final presentation by adding their own surroundings or p.134 context and by directing the presentation themselves. By following an organised textile and fashion route, the members of the final examination committee evaluate the graduation candidates and their collections. This route also offers the students the opportunity to display their work to the press and a large audience. The second phase of the evaluation is the general textile exhibition and fashion show organised by the KABK. Textile Design Year 4 (final phase) // D esign I: Textile design // D esign II: Technical Design Textile // V isualizing: Visual Development, Photography // D rawing: Model Drawing // T heory: Thesis // O ther: Individual Study Trajectory, Internship // Fashion Design Year 4 (final phase) // D esign I: Fashion design // D esign II: Technical Design Fashion // V isualizing: Visual Development, Photography // D rawing: Model drawing // T heory: Thesis // O ther: Individual Study Trajectory, Internship 2.8.4 Educational and professional objectives The basic structure and objectives of the study programme are outlined per study year. They are strictly focused on the completion of the final goal (the collections), which should serve the students as a guide towards an individual and personal final pres- entation. This basic structure can be divided into four phases and is stimulated and guided by teachers from their own specific domain. Artistic technical domain At the end of this year, students present, together with the results of all clusters, a mini-collection of three outfits (a skirt, dress and trench coat) and three textile works in relation to textile books. Second year: historical and social research In the second year of the programme, historical and social research is added to the study process in the form of the student’s individual collection. The student selects a historical costume and uses this historical period as a guideline, a source of inspiration and analytical tool to design a contemporary, personal style in the form of a collection. At the end of the academic year, the students present, in combination with the cluster results, a replica of the historical costume and a coherent Third year: delving into the diversity of population groups After having acquired historical knowledge, third-year students will expand their views and further extend their knowledge of the large diversity of population groups. These insights into personal ethnic and cultural characteristics serve as a guideline, source of inspiration and analytical tool to design a contemporary, personal style in the form of a collection. At the end of the third year, the students present, in combination with the cluster result, a replica of the ethnic costume or object and a coherent collection of six outfits or six textile works that have been inspired by the costume. Graduation year: individual collection In the final phase of the study, a synthesis of the student’s personal development is made in the form of an individual collection and a relating thesis. The emphasis in this last phase is primarily on the individual and autonomous creative process and the personality of the designer in training. The subject and the source of inspiration serve as a guideline in creating a contemporary image at the hand of the student’s personal blueprint and signature. In the final year students present, together with the cluster results, a coherent collection of ten outfits or eight textile works. Walk-through and concept discussion This is the presentation of a ‘collection’ to a team of lecturers (analogous to a presentation in the business world or of an independent designer working alone or in a team). Technical design - Textile: the materialisation and realisation of designs, the application of tech- p.135 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Propaedeutic year: orientation in the professional field The propaedeutic year is primarily aimed at the orientation of the profession of both the textile and fashion designer. The control and knowledge of materials, techniques and visual images are developed throughout the entire period of study and are an important point of departure of the programme. This introductory phase offers a wide range of supporting subjects that develop techniques and professional knowledge, and which, together with visual development, form the necessary foundation for concept development and the shaping of the design process. All the elements needed to initiate the study process are included in the propaedeutic year and are the operating base for the further study process. collection of four outfits or four textile works in textile inspired by the costume. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide niques, the preparation and creation of the intended final result are further explored and developed. In addition, students work on developing their own style, methods and character; in short, all of the aspects of the area of textile are addressed. Knowledge of textiles is extremely important for the textile designer. During their education students must master all the possible techniques and applications necessary to create his designs. Technical design - Fashion: the ingredients of this part of the study programme include gaining insight in the study of form, gaining knowledge of patterns, moulding, draping, modelling, machines and materials, converting a two-dimensional image into a three-dimensional form, experimenting with all possible techniques and finishing touches of use in the execution of a design or piece of clothing, gaining skills related to the profession, such as sewing, taking measurements and fitting. The education of the fashion designer involves a large number of technical skills that are necessary to work professionally and to develop a creative idea into a product. Supporting courses Visual development The main aim of this study component is the development and personalisation of an authentic blueprint and individual visual language. In this course, the student learns to independently develop images and solidify them. Personal orientation in relation to photography and visual development is applicable here. Students learn to transform research, experiments, ingenuity, creativity, observations, knowledge, intuitions and emotions into an image. This visual analysis will support students in their development of the individual collection and their p.136 views. They also learn to apply knowledge and insights to communicate the various meanings of images, forms, materials, relationships and colours. The various layers of the manifestation of forms are thoroughly researched. From the third year onwards, students develop their individual style, a book of collections and a portfolio for various ends, such as an internship, the press, competitions and job applications. Photography Photography teaches students in the first place how to look and, later, also how to visualise. The next step is interpretation. This means that the student is trained in developing an idea into an image through observation. Model drawing Students draw both live models and still lives. They observe, discover and document proportions in combination with technique and the development of a personal drawing style. The students’ powers of observation are strengthened and developed, with an emphasis on the discovery and documentation of proportions. 2D forms and colour studies In this subject the relationship between line, colour and surfaces is explored. Students receive supervision in the development and experience of their talents is developed by means of experiments and with the help of materials, structures and colours. Students work towards a personal signature, to learn how to document impressions and emotions, and to search for their own expression in two-dimensional forms and colours. Theoretical Domain Art history All students at the academy need a solid theoretical base. This does not only imply knowledge, but also insights into the history, paradigms, theories, processes and so on, which are related to the student’s discipline and to other disciplines, to the extent that they contribute to the student as a person and a designer. A basic knowledge of art history and philosophy is essential to meaningfully substantiate the textile and fashion design profession in the general framework of artistic development. Thesis When starting the final year, students have knowledge of the most important developments in art and design. They are able to reflect, undertake independent research and present their findings verbally and in writing. In this study component each student is individually supervised in the completion of the programme with a thesis that is relevant to the work, that has substantial depth and that provides insight into the student’s views and opinions about art and design in a contemporary and historical context. Students are also expected to provide a written explanation of the work for their final examination with a core description of themes and standpoints. Professional development: The final assessment in the final phase also heralds the completion of the career preparation. The presentation of the textile and fashion collections takes place at various locations in the city (a simulation of the professional route in Paris, Milan and New York during the fashion weeks). Students complete the final presentation by adding their own surroundings or context and by directing the presentation themselves. By following an organised textile and fashion route, the members of the final examination committee evaluate the graduation candidates and their collections. This route also offers the students the opportunity to display their work to the press and a large audience. The second phase of the presentation evaluation is the general textile exhibition and fashion show organised by the KABK. // S ynthesis of design procedure with signature (total collection of ten textile designs/outfits) // I nternship // D evelopment of personal style (image) // C ompletion and solidifying the portfolio // D evelopment of general style (textile and fashion route) // P repare to collaborate with external agencies (graphic design agency, model agency, etc.) // P repare the individual presentation and reception (showroom) // ‘ Textile and Fashion route’ // P repare the general graduation show/exhibition p.137 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Fashion theory Fashion theory addresses the relationships between fashion and society, fashion and context, and fashion and culture. Students are introduced to the social and substantial functions and relevance of fashion. The course is an orientation on surroundings, society, behaviour and standards in relation to the fashion trends. In addition, students develop a critical attitude towards fashion trends and fashion in general. Students are given a chronological overview of the history of Western costume and clothing history and research the relation between lifestyle, crafts and techniques. Professional social domain Propaedeutic Year Assignment Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // D esign and create, on the basis of preliminary studies, a dress, skirt and trench coat in a given theme. Present in a suitable context and/or background. Design and create, on the basis of preliminary studies, textile books with a personal signature. // D esign and create, on the basis of preliminary studies, textile books with a personal signature. Design and create, on the basis of preliminary studies, a dress, skirt and trench coat in a given theme. Present in a suitable context and/or background. Courses All scheduled courses serve the purpose of creating an individual collection. Students are given additional assignments and tasks in the different courses. // D esign I: Textile design and Fashion design // D esign II: Technical design Textile, and Technical design Fashion // V isualising: Visual Development, Photography // D rawing: Model Drawing, Fashion Drawing, 2D Forms and Colour Studies // T heory: Introduction to General Art History, Introduction to Science, Art History and Fashion Theory Propaedeutic year competences The competencies for the propaedeutic year are: These competences are under construction, please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. p.138 // C reative ability: the student can create new work in which he explores new methods based on the experiences and insights he has gained through the programme. // C apacity for critical reflection: the student is able to reflect on his work and can evaluate its quality and effectiveness. // C apacity for growth and innovation: the student demonstrates the will to make new discoveries and acquires new knowledge, skills and insights and is able to apply them on a theoretical and practical level; the student is driven, curious and investigative. // O rganisational competence: the student can organise his own work process and is able to document and archive his work. // C ommunicative competence: the student is able to substantiate his choice for, and deployment of, resources, materials and/or visual solutions. // S ituational awareness: the student shows a broad interest in social, sociological and cultural developments and is able to distinguish different visions of design. // C ollaborative competence: the student can achieve his own goals while collaborating with others. Main Phase / Year 2 Assignment // R esearch and create a replica of a historical costume with preliminary studies as practice in form and style. The replica must be in white and the materials should be faithful to the original. The costume must be presented in the appropriate context and with a correct casting. // D esign, create, on the basis of preliminary studies, and present a collection of four fashion outfits or four works in textiles. The self-chosen historical theme is the starting point, theme and source of inspiration. Courses // D esign I: Textile design or Fashion design // D esign II: Technical design Textile, and Technical design Fashion // D rawing: Model Drawing and 2D Forms and Colour Studies, or Model Drawing and Fashion Drawing // T heory: Art History, Fashion Theory // O ther: Individual Study Trajectory Competences year 2 During this phase of the study students should master the following competences: These competences are under construction, please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. // C reative ability: the student can methodically and organisationally research and develop his own idea. // C apacity for critical reflection: the student is able to reflect on his own work and that of others, and can evaluate its quality and effectiveness. // C apacity for growth and innovation: the student can make use of newly acquired knowledge, skills and insights, and the criticism of others to advance the development of his work. // C ommunicative skills: the student can interpret an assignment and express it in word and image. // S ituational awareness: the student refers to social and cultural resources to formulate a precise hypothesis for his work, and he can name the target audience of his work. // C ollaborative skills: the student is able to collaborate with others and can apply his talents and those of others to benefit the collaboration. Main Phase / Year 3 Assignment // R esearch and create a replica of an ethnic costume and/or object including preliminary studies. The replica and the materials are completely faithful to the original with regard to both the suggested colours and materials. The costume will be presented in the appropriate context, surroundings and with suitable casting. // D esign, create, including preliminary studies, and present a collection of six fashion outfits or six textile works with as point of departure and inspiration a self-chosen folklore theme. Courses // D esign I: Textile design or Fashion design // D esign II: Technical design Textile, and Technical design Fashion p.139 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // V isualizing: Visual Development, Photography // O rganisational skills: the student is able to prioritise and time-effectively manage his work process. // V isualising: Visual Development, Photography // D rawing: Model Drawing and 2D Forms and Colour Studies, or Model Drawing and Fashion Drawing // T heory: Art History, Fashion Theory, Business Plan Writing // O ther: Individual Study Trajectory Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Competences year 3 During this phase of the study students should master the following competences: These competences are under construction, please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. // C reative ability: the student is able to formulate a design problem and employ research to find a solution. // C apacity for critical reflection: The student can relate his work to developments in the field in a cultural and social context and define his position. // C apacity for growth and innovation: the student develops a personal vision on design from an open attitude. // O rganisational skills: the student can create a balance between design-related, facilitating and productionrelated activities. // C ommunicative skills: the student is able to convincingly present and explain his own work (methods). // S ituational awareness: the student is able to connect his own work to that of others, and his own work to the public; the student can adequately address his target groups with his work. // C ollaborative skills: the student can purposely place p.140 himself in the work process in different roles and with different responsibilities. Final Phase / Year 4 Assignment Comprehensive collection, including preliminary studies: Design, fully create and present a comprehensive image, in an appropriate context and with suitable casting, of a collection of ten fashion outfits or ten textile works based on a individually chosen, well-substantiated theme. Courses // D esign I: Textile design or Fashion design // V isualising: Visual Development, Photography // D rawing: Model Drawing The head of department is responsible for the department’s policy and all aspects related to this policy. The team of lecturers reflects the content of the programme and its professional set-up. With the exception of some, all teachers have a professional practice and work either independently or in a team. Because of the diversity in experience and expertise, the student is confronted with numerous aspects and approaches of the discipline. Specific knowledge of the professional practice is offered by means of guest lectures. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // D esign II: Technical design Textile, and Technical design Fashion 2.8.5 Department organisation Head of Textile & Fashion department Erik Verdonck, e.verdonck@kabk.nl / / T heory: Thesis // O ther: Individual Study Trajectory, Internship Competences final phase The competences of the final phase correspond to the final qualifications of the study. Coordinator Gerrit Uittenbogaard g.uittenbogaard@kabk.nl Internship coordinator Gerrit Uittenbogaard g.uittenbogaard@kabk.nl Administrative employee Sanne Jansen S.Jansen@kabk.nl Team of Lecturers Els de Baan Eric Hirdes Mirjam Ingram Nico Laan Natasja Martens Jurgi Persoons Gerrit Uittenbogaard Roy Verschuren Robert Volmer Ellen Vos Marina Yee p.141 2.8.6 Total overview of qualifications QUALIFICATIONS Creative ability Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Capacity for critical reflection Capacity for growth and innovation Organizational ability Communicative ability External awareness Capacity for collaboration p.142 PROPAEDEUTIC YEAR MAIN PHASE, YEAR 2 At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been been finalised. Please refer to finalised. Please refer to the the website for the most up-to-date website for the most up-to-date in information. formation. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. At the time of printing this guide, At the time of printing this guide, the specific final qualifications the specific final qualifications of this study year had not yet of this study year had not yet been finalised. Please refer to been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date the website for the most up-to-date information. information. QUALIFICATIONS Creative ability MAIN PHASE, YEAR 3 MAIN PHASE, YEAR 4 At the time of printing this guide, You are able to develop an inno- the specific final qualifications vative concept arising from your of this study year had not yet artistic ambition and research, been finalised. Please refer to elaborate it into a distinctive the website for the most up-to-date image, product, means of information. nication or spatial design, and to commu- contextualize it in a meaningful way. Capacity for critical reflection You are able to consider, analyse, the specific final qualifications interpret and assess your own and of this study year had not yet others' work, and are capable of been finalised. Please refer to constructively considering your the website for the most up-to-date findings in relation to your own information. work. At the time of printing this guide, You are able to further develop the specific final qualifications your vision, work and working of this study year had not yet methods in breadth and depth been finalised. Please refer to through an ongoing process the website for the most up-to-date of research, and in this way information. contribute to your discipline and to society. Organizational ability At the time of printing this guide, You are able to establish and the specific final qualifications maintain an inspirational and of this study year had not yet functional working environment and been finalised. Please refer to to organize your research, work and the website for the most up-to-date practice. information. Communicative ability At the time of printing this guide, You are able to effectively present the specific final qualifications your vision, research and work and of this study year had not yet engage in a dialogue with clients been finalised. Please refer to and other interested parties. the website for the most up-to-date information. External awareness At the time of printing this guide, You are able to relate your the specific final qualifications artistic practice to the artistic of this study year had not yet and social context. been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. Capacity for collaboration At the time of printing this guide, You are able to make an independent the specific final qualifications contribution to a collaborative of this study year had not yet product or process. been finalised. Please refer to the website for the most up-to-date information. p.143 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Capacity for growth and innovation At the time of printing this guide, 2.8.7 Study points overview INTERACTIVE/MEDIA/DESIGN FULL-TIME Year 1 2 3 4 Semester 1 2 3 4 5 6 Design 1: Textile design 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 7 6 6 6 6 7 7 5 5 5 5 6 6 4 4 4 4 7 8 Design 1: Fashion design Design 2: Textile design Design 2: Fashion design Visualising: Visual development Visualising: Photography Drawing: Fashion drawing Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Drawing: Model drawing Academy-wide propaedeutic year 1 project week End exam 18 Internship 24 Art History/Fashion Theory 1 Research and Discourse 3 3 3 3 3 6 6 6 6 6 6 3 Thesis 6 IST Total 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 EC after indiviudal assessments 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 EC after collective assessments 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 * Design in year 3: incl. Business Plan Writing 1st year: Due to the changed Research & Discourse programme minor adjustments of the EC is a possibilty. p.144 3. Preparatory courses 3.1.1 General information Preparatory Courses 3.1 Preparatory courses The Royal Academy of Art offers prospective students the following opportunities in preparation of a Bachelor’s programme at the academy: // S chool for Young Talent (vmbotl, havo, vwo) // P reparatory year (one-year, full-time programme, postsecondary education) // O rientation Course (Saturday course) // K ids Club (9-12 year olds, grades 7 and 8 of primary education) Additionally, the KABK collaborates with several secondary schools, which gives students attending these schools the possibility to participate in art class programmes at the academy. The KABK is able to provide art classes in upper secondary education (as part of the KUBV course) and meets the examination requirements set for this course. The partners are: // S egbroekcollege The Hague // B onaventura College Leiden // R ijnlands Lyceum Wassenaar // Z andvlietcollege The Hague At present, a pilot is in progress with new schools in the regions Alphen aan de Rijn en Zoetermeer, to enlarge the offer of art class programmes and their coverage in the area of The Hague. To participate in one of the Preparatory Courses it is necessary to follow a selection procedure. During this selection the candidate should bring as much (different) work as possible. To make an appointment please contact the Student Administration. Additional information Main coordinator Preparatory Courses Zanne Zwart Coordinator Preparatory year Nieke Koek voortraject@kabk.nl Office hours admission: by appointment. Office hours for students and parents: by appointment. p.147 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // C ombined Education (classes for secondary school students in the art plan programme or the School for Young Talent) The KABK offers a wide range of Preparatory Courses. All courses are aimed at introducing people to art education and to offer them a programme that matches their own needs and level. Our keywords are selection and orientation. The KABK wants to provide talented people with the opportunity to further develop, so that they can eventually enrol in an undergraduate art or design programme. The Preparatory Courses can also give participants the opportunity to investigate whether studying at the academy and the prospect of a career as an artist or designer is a possibility. Participants are able to switch between the different courses, which facilitates the finding of a suitable trajectory. Several internships are available for those studying to become an art teacher at a secondary education institution. 3.1.2 School for Young Talent Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The University of the Arts in The Hague accommodates the School for Young Talent (SYT) for elementary school students (grades 7 and 8) and secondary school students. The school offers programmes at the levels vmbo-tl (theoretical vocational secondary education), havo (higher general secondary education) and vwo (pre-university secondary education). The school welcomes students who wish to continue their education at the KABK, the Royal Conservatoire or the Dance Department of the Royal Conservatoire. The School for Young Talent is a small programme that prioritises individual attention. We offer programmes in the profile ‘Cultuur en Maatschappij’ (Culture and Society) (havo, vwo) and the sector Economics (vmbo), with a strong emphasis on the cultural formation and development of the students’ talents. Other profiles or subjects are available through intensive cooperation with the Rijnlands Lyceum in Wassenaar. The SYT collaborates on an administrative level with the Haagsche Schoolvereeniging and the Rijnlands Lyceum in Wassenaar. The schedule allows students following the art programme to attend classes at the academy at least three times a week. The regular subjects are taught in the secondary school building located in the Royal Conservatoire. Here, art students follow classes together with students of the dance and music programmes. Participation To participate in the combined education programme of the SYT and the KABK, applicants enter an admission procedure consisting of two components. Although students can apply when they are still in the final year of primary education, the SJT art programme is only available on a secondary education level. Candidates are assessed on whether their artistic level is sufficient. When p.148 the outcome is positive, the candidate meets with the director of the SYT to determine whether the level of education is adequate and corresponds with the offered curriculum. When both parts have been accorded, the candidate is accepted to the KABK/SJT. It is possible to join the programme throughout the year, in all years and at all levels. In practice, this does not apply to the senior year. When a student wishes to join the programme when the academic year has already started, this can only be done in consultation with the student’s previous school. On an individual basis there are many possibilities for the student to attend both regular secondary education, and prepare for the academy. The tuition fee for the SYT for the academic year 2013/2014 is set at € 1,650. Additional costs are the costs for materials and excursions. For more information please refer to the School for Young Talent brochure. See also www.svjt.nl / www.koncon.nl Students who have been accepted to the art and design programme follow classes at the Royal Academy of Art (KABK) in The Hague, which is located a short ten-minute walk from the Royal Conservatoire. In the lower years, students are offered various courses in which they are introduced to different materials and techniques and learn how to express and develop their ideas. In these courses they obtain a solid foundation on which to base their choices in the higher years. In the higher years they enter a more individual trajectory to prepare for their continuation of study in art education. In the final year, the students create a diverse portfolio adhering to the admission requirements of their chosen department at the KABK. The curriculum of the art programme includes, among others, the courses Drawing/Painting, Photography, Graphic Techniques, Spatial, Concept Development, Theory, Interdisciplinary and Art Theory, as well as additional modules that provide guidance on the different specialisations available at the KABK. Students can also work independently at the academy and make use facilities such as the library, the computer, wood, metal, graphic and textile workshops. Customised programmes are possible in consultation, and only if the programme allows it. Students can be found at the KABK at least three days a week. They are supervised by teachers who are well acquainted with the secondary educational system and the KABK. The teachers have active art practices. Study varieties Students can enrol in the SYT from the first year of secondary education onwards. Even younger students Director SYT Jan van Bilsen Head of Department SYT Visual Arts Zanne Zwart voortraject@kabk.nl 3.1.3 Preparatory year The Preparatory year is intended for motivated people who are inadequately prepared to already be accepted to the intended programme or have the need for a broad orientation and preparation before commencing with a programme at the academy. The Preparatory year prepares students for all study programmes offered at the academy. The objectives of the Preparatory year are orientation, selection and incentive. Admission procedure To apply for the Preparatory year candidates have to enter an admission procedure. During the selection day candidates display their work and engage in a conversation with the admission committee. After the final assessment in the Preparatory year, students might be accepted, depending on their study results, into a study programme at the academy. In addition to the possibility of applying directly for the Prepara- p.149 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Twice a year the collective assessments take place. During these so-called Christmas and summer assessments, the students present their work of the past semester at an appointed place in the academy building. All teachers view the presentation, question the student and assess him together. Should the Christmas assessment have a negative outcome, then the student is given time to improve until the next assessment. If the summer assessment is negative, then the student will generally not be able to continue with the programme. In special cases it may be decided to allow the student to redo the art component, to give him a task, or to have him conditionally enter the next year. Important components of the curriculum are the excursions, cultural tours and visits to exhibitions. Students also participate in many different projects. Students may use the facilities at the KABK, in compliance with rules on safety associated with their age. The students have their own classroom, which is reserved specifically for students of the School for Young Talent. are able to take some courses, in combination with the programme at their primary school. Students can also enrol in the programme in later years. Students with a vmbo-tl diploma from another secondary school can apply to obtain their havo diploma at the School for Young Talent in the art programme. If a student obtains his vmbo diploma at the School for Young Talent, he will usually have to take additional havo-courses, or complete the full havo-programme, on contract basis. Students who only take a few additional havo-courses may combine them with the Preparatory year. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide tory year, candidates who apply for a study programme at the KABK might also be advised to first complete the Preparatory year. The Preparatory year is intended for people who already have their vwo, havo or mbo 4 diplomas. If applicants do not meet this admission requirement, it is possible to obtain the necessary diploma at the School for Young Talent (SYT), the KABK’s secondary school. For more information on this, please refer to the section ‘Special combined education’ below. It is also an option for applicants to do a special test that indicates whether the applicant has a havo-level of thinking. We therefore advise all applicants without a havo, vwo or mbo diploma, to take this test as soon as possible. A negative outcome of the admission means the candidate cannot enrol in the programme, and the attempt is made to find another suitable programme. For more information it is possible to make an appointment during the Preparatory Courses office hours via the Student Administration: 070-3154770. Study programme The programme consists of various classes taught by teachers of the KABK. The courses can be described as ‘perceiving and processing the world around you’, ‘perceiving and processing the art world’, ‘presentation’ and ‘work groups’. The courses focus on the student’s communicative skills and the ability to transform experiences and observations into images. The emphasis is on the study attitude and mind-set needed to study at the academy. The year is divided into three periods. The period prior to the Christmas holidays has a broad orientation as its foundation, during which students are given general assignments to complete, according to their own ideas. In this first period, students gain a lot of p.150 experience by visiting exhibitions, watching films and observing other cultural expressions, and they learn how to give a response to these expressions. This first period includes a subscription to events and screenings at the Filmhuis and Theater aan het Spui. Students are expected to make a full-time commitment, show an independent attitude and actively participate. After this first semester, the student chooses in which direction he wants to continue working, and the second semester is therefore more specifically focused on a particular discipline. Contact will be made with the chosen department. The third period consists of six weeks, starting in March, during which the student works in the chosen department to prepare for the admission that takes place in the beginning of May. The programme’s structure is thus based on different levels of submergence into the chosen discipline. Deviating programmes are a possibility, if the rest of the programme allows it. Students can also participate in excursions. Assessments There are two assessment moments. The first is in December. The heads of the various departments are involved in this assessment. The second assessment takes place at the end of April/ beginning of May. Students receive a report on the basis of the final assessment. The final assessment is accompanied by an admission. The student presents his work and chooses a department to which he wants to apply. A special committee of this department assesses students from the Preparatory year during a separate selection moment. Should the student be rejected, he then has ample time to improve his portfolio and participate in the regular application rounds of the specific departments. The Preparatory year is successfully completed when the student is admitted to his chosen programme. Workplace We advise all students of the Preparatory year to create a workplace/studio, so that they can also work peacefully at home and have access to all kinds of materials. Materials The necessary materials are specified for each discipline. Within the academy building there is an art shop where students can buy materials. The final cost of materials is very individual and depends greatly on the student’s ideas and choices. In case of premature termination of the Preparatory year after November 1, 2013, the tuition fee and additional costs cannot be refunded. To apply for the Preparatory year and for further information please call the KABK at 070-315 47 70 and make an appointment for the admission interview via the Student Administration. Coordination Zanne Zwart Nieke Koek voortraject@kabk.nl To improve the relationship with secondary education and to offer secondary students the chance to adequately prepare for further study in the arts, the KABK has a number of partnerships with schools inside and outside of The Hague. Additional projects are still in the pipeline. Secondary schools focus more and more on art and culture; with a good example being the establishment of the so-called cultural profile schools. Secondary school students often find it difficult to form a realistic image of what it’s like to study at an art academy. In addition, art academies regularly require different qualities than those developed in the art classes in secondary education. The subject matter in these art classes is often insufficiently focused on talent. Nowadays, different groups of the participating secondary schools visit the academy on one afternoon a week, and students follow classes that complement their own study programme. This happens in all years. When possible, the classes at the academy, and consequently the study load, are integrated with the regular study programme. Students from these programmes continue on to more intensive forms of preparation, such as the Preparatory courses, the School for Young Talent or the Preparatory year. In the near future, students from external schools may also be able to take their art exams through the KABK. Set-up and courses In the first three years of the ‘art plan’, students get acquainted with the various studies offered by the academy. They acquire a solid base to help them make choices later on. In the first three years we meet the core objectives as stated by the Ministry of Education, namely: p.151 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide General Information Participants of the Preparatory year are not registered as a student and do not receive financial support. The cost of participation of the Preparatory year are € 2,000, which includes an amount of € 250 for the theatre and film subscription and excursions. Parents may be eligible for support in the form of child support if financial support is not available for the programme. More information can be found on: www.duo.nl. 3.1.4 Collaborations with secondary schools 1. Core objective 48: Producing art Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide “The student learns to investigate the power of expression of different artistic disciplines by using basic skills and apply them to express his own feelings, capture experiences, develop his imagination into images, and establish communication.” Reflection is an important part of each class. In all assignments students are encouraged by their teachers to make use of their imagination. Students are stimulated to represent their imaginative world in two and three-dimensional creations and digital products. They record their experiences in a notebook or sketchbook, and later use them when making preliminary studies and coming up with topics for independent assignments. The notebook is a personal journal in which the student also works outside of class. This book is an important contribution to the achieving the core objective. The objective mainly concerns the production of art, and that is exactly what takes place in every class, in the broadest sense of the term. 2. Core objective 49: Presenting personal work “The student learns to present, alone or in a group, his own artistic work to others.” The presentation of the student’s work often takes place in each separate class and after completion of a block of lessons within one discipline. In addition, the student learns to discuss his work in the context of the group and is taught the necessary concepts to optimally tell his story. At the end of an academic year, students collectively present their work to those interested. In a group exhibition, created by the students themselves, they can observe and talk about the work. p.152 3. Core Objective 50: Learn to observe and listen to art “The student learns, on the basis of some background knowledge, to observe visual art, listen to music and watch films, and theatre and dance performances.” The art plan elaborately focuses on the observation of art during the excursions. Each group can go on separate excursions per discipline, but all students also go on a collective excursion. During these excursions the student experiences art and culture, and learns to understand and appreciate art. Each excursion has a related assignment, and students also write a report in their notebook. Students can also visit the regular exhibitions in the KABK. In each discipline, attention is paid to exhibitions of the relevant discipline, so that students can take the initiative to visit the exhibition outside of class. 4. Core objective 51: reporting on experiences “The student learns, by using visual or auditory means, to report on his participation in artistic activities (as a spectator and as participant).” In his notebook, the student reports on his experiences with art and culture. The reports are discussed and reviewed in class. The student learns to write down and verbally express the experiences that he gains by observing the art works of others, including those of professional artists. Forming an opinion is very important in this. Students playfully learn to develop an extensive vocabulary that enables them to communicate about art. 5. Core objective 52: Reflecting on artistic work “The student learns to reflect verbally and in writing on his own work and that of others, including visual artists.” In the art plan, students learn to articulate their ideas and opinions, and what they have learned during the creative process. Courses This year we offer the following courses: Fine Arts, Graphic Design, Interior Architecture, ArtScience, Textile & Fashion, Graphic Design and Photography. These courses are offered in modules of approximately six classes. Collaboration The KABK currently collaborates with the following schools: // S egbroekcollege: first to third year: ‘plan visual art and design’, also referred to as the ‘art plan’. Higher years: KUBV (Art Visual Development); also see www.kunstopsegbroek.nl; // B onaventura College Leiden: all years: ‘plan visual art and design’, also referred to as the ‘art plan’; // R ijnlands Lyceum Wassenaar: first to third year, and possibility of KUBV in the higher years, also referred to as ‘art class’; The KABK also strives for an improved relation with higher vocational education (mbo). The development of continuous learning trajectories is one of the possibilities. Admission procedure To participate in one of the art plans applicants must enter an admission procedure. The admission is organised by the schools in cooperation with teachers of the KABK. Please contact the secondary schools for more information about the procedure and admission requirements. Coordination Zanne Zwart voortraject@kabk.nl 3.1.5 Special Combined Education Students can follow art courses at the KABK in combination with their secondary school education. The programme is then usually adapted to fit the individual student’s needs, because the two schedules do not always fit. Usually students are able to (partially) follow the same programme as the students at the School for Young Talent. To enrol in this programme, students must enter an admission procedure. Where possible, the student’s teachers advise on how the participation in the preparatory programme can be fitted into the regular school programme. For this form of participation payment of a fee is required, which is calculated on the basis of the amount of classes/sessions. Students can apply after obtaining the havo diploma. To apply, students enter a separate admission procedure, connected to the end exam presentation of the visual work. p.153 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The art plan is designed for students who have an above average interest in art. In the context of this plan, they are introduced to the various disciplines offered at the KABK. We aspire to offer these students the best and most diverse programme as we possibly can, which helps students reach the core objectives. We hope that students will be encouraged to continue studying and working in the art world. With the art plan we give them a solid foundation to do so. // Z andvlietcollege The Hague: first to third year, and possibility of KUBV in the higher years, also referred to as ‘art class’. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Admission procedure To participate in the combined education programme at the School for Young Talent and the KABK, students take part in an extensive admission procedure. Students can enrol at the School for Young Talent after the start of the academic year. To apply, please make an appointment with the Student Administration of the Royal Academy of Art (telephone number: 070-3154770). On the selection day the candidate should bring a portfolio: a folder carrying self-made work. The candidate is also allowed to bring a laptop, on which he can show videos, photographs and/or other digital creations. The candidate is expected to show recent work. The admission committee looks for creative ability, motivation, aptitude, idea formation, uniqueness/ originality, potential for growth, and a diverse use of materials and techniques. During an interview on the selection day these aspects are discussed. After the selection day, the committee decides whether the candidate is suitable for the programme or not, or decides to request a second interview, with or without an additional assignment. If the candidate is deemed suitable, he is invited for a second admission interview with the director of the school to discuss the educational component. If this is also sufficient, the candidate is accepted. “Speccies” Students who are enrolled in the special combined education programme, are sometimes referred to as “speccies”. Because the schedules of the academy and the schedules of their own school change each year, we ask these “speccies” to contact the coordinator at the beginning of the school year to organise the two schedule so that they do not overlap. This might mean that a student takes the course Drawing/ Painting on Thursdays during one year, and switches to the Wednesday slot in another year. Students have p.154 the possibility to take one or two classes a week. Coordination Zanne Zwart voortraject@kabk.nl 3.1.6 Orientation Course The Orientation Course is primarily intended for people who are considering applying to one of the bachelor’s programmes at the KABK. Students in the Orientation Course are introduced to the mind-set, methods and study attitude needed to study at the academy. The course takes place on fourteen Saturdays (including a one-day excursion). First course: 5 October 2013 – 25 January 2014 From 10:00 - 15:00 (break from 12:30 to 13:00) Second course: 22 February, 2014 – 21 June 2014 From 10:00 - 15:00 (break from 12:30 to 13:00) The Orientation Course at the KABK offers students the opportunity to develop their work and get to know the different disciplines. The emphasis of the programme is on working process-based and on the discovering and developing of the student’s artistic ambition. Social orientation plays a major role. Students can expect a journey that challenges them to develop an investigative, visual attitude. The offered techniques and exercises are tools to achieve this attitude, and not a goal in themselves. The emphasis is mainly on the process, and less so on the end product. Students regularly receive take-home assignments that support the process. During the classes, students work on creating their portfolio, which does not only show the student’s abilities, but also his sources of inspiration: the source of ideas and the artists to whom he relates, his ‘artistic family’. To have a complete image of the discipline at the end of the course, the student also works on his social orientation. The course is taught by teachers from the KABK. Guest teachers, students and alumni are regularly invited to give talks about their discipline and exchange experiences with the students about studying at the KABK and professional options. Admission procedure The admission procedure consists of the following components: // C ompleting the questionnaire. The questionnaire should be taken to: // T he selection day. On the selection day applicants are given an assignment, and work under the supervision of different teachers at the KABK for a full day. The results of this day are brought, together with the portfolio, to: // T he interview. During the interview the portfolio, the questionnaire and the work made on the selection day are discussed. The selection day with the subsequent interview for the first course of 2013/2014 takes place on: Saturday 21 September 2013, from 10:00 to 16:00 (for all applications The selection day with a subsequent admission interview for the second course of 2013/2014 takes place on: Saturday 8 February 2014, from 10:00 to 16:00 (for all applications after 20 September 2013) Admission and tuition fee Application is only possible by filling out the application form on the KABK website. The tuition fee for the year 2013/2014 amounts to € 475 (including the tuition fee and the one-day excursion) per course. The full amount must be paid in advance. In case of illness, absence or early termination of the course the tuition fee will not be reimbursed. After applying by sending in the application form, the applicant will automatically receive the questionnaire and an invitation for the selection day. Students need to provide their own materials for the classes. At the art store in the academy building students enrolled in the course can buy a materials package for a reduced price. For questions and further information, please contact: Zanne Zwart (main coordinator Preparatory Courses) z.zwart@kabk.nl Willem Goedegebuure (coordinator) w.goedegebuure@kabk.nl For an appointment during the Preparatory Courses office hours, please contact the Student Administration by calling 070-3154770. 3.1.7 Additional Activities In the framework of European exchange, we have an exchange agreement between the Preparatory Courses and the Instituto Statale d’Arte in Vittorio Veneto, Italy. This is a p.155 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // T he presentation of a portfolio. This is a collection of drawings, sketches, designs, models, pictures, photographs, movies, paintings, etc., that the applicant has created on his own initiative. Also important is a visual diary that shows the applicant’s inspiration, ideas, plans, experiences and insights. If you have any questions about this, please contact the coordinator. prior to 20 September 2013) Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide school where, similar to the School for Young Talent, secondary education and art education are combined. The KABK participates in several projects in The Hague that are aimed at familiarising young children with Visual Art and Design. Examples of these projects are the Kunstbende competitions, projects at Nest, Rewire Festival, TodaysArtFestival and various galleries and museums. Also included in the curriculum is the organisation of exhibitions and showing work in galleries and at other locations. We also inform secondary school students about the possibilities of studying at the KABK at information markets throughout the year. Together with the Faculty of Arts we are developing our own art pedagogical model, which will be continued to form in the coming years. Coordination Zanne Zwart voortraject@kabk.nl Kids Club The kids club is a group of children from primary school grades 7 and 8 (age ranging between 9 and 12 years old) who are interested in learning more about art in addition to what they are offered at their own school. The kids club also includes children who are considering applying for the School for Young Talent or one of the art plan schools. During the classes these children show what they are capable of and work on their portfolio at the hand of assignments. When, how and where The Kids Club takes place every Friday from 16:30 to 18:00 in room PB125 of the Royal Academy of Art at the Prinsessegracht 4 in The Hague. It is up to the student whether they want to join weekly, or just participate once. New students can send an email to the address below, and will be picked up at the reception. The costs of a class are € 7.50, which includes material and a drink and snack. p.156 Exhibition All works made over the course of six months are kept at the academy. At the end of each semester, once in December and once in June, all works are presented in an exhibition. For many children this is their first exhibition. Everyone is welcome at these exhibitions, and afterwards all works are taken home. Materials The class fee includes materials. There is no need for students to carry around around jugs of paint. We strive to use a different material in each class. In the past six months we used paint, paper, clay, charcoal, wire, plaster, fabric, ink, chalk, sheets, etching pens, etching ink, etching paper, etching press, wood, plastic bags and other materials. During their first class, students receive an overview of which materials will be used when. If students have materials at home they would like to use, they are free to bring those along. Coordinator and teacher Zanne Zwart z.zwart@kabk.nl voortraject@kabk.nl 4.1 Post Graduate Course Industrial Design The Post Graduate Course Industrial Design (ID) was founded in 1950 and is the oldest accredited course in Design and Industrial Design in the Netherlands. Prominent personalities like Gerrit Rietveld, Frans de La Haye and Renny Ramakers were associated with the course either as student or teacher. ID is a part-time course for students from an international field, and positions itself between industrial design and design: a precise mix of concept, skills, culture and industry. Schedule and location The Post Graduate Course Industrial Design consists of six separate blocks of six months. The student receives a certificate for each block and eventually the diploma. Classes take place in the KABK building at the Prinsessegracht 4, The Hague. Outside class and during the academy’s opening hours, students can make use of the various workshops. Classes take place on Wednesdays and Thursdays, from 16:00 to 21:45. Students should expect to work on assignments approximately ten to fifteen hours per week. Design Courses Industry & Culture The design assignment is based on an integrated approach to industry and culture. The combining of different (design) disciplines and skills is central: industrial design, design, Real Artist In this design course, the personality of the student is centralised in relation to the produced work. The student is given a clear overview to the world of galleries, museums, cultural events, institutions, grants, magazines, presentations and in-house production. Attention is also paid to determining the student’s position as an independent designer in relationship to curators, journalists and opinion makers. Cool Industry The design assignment is set in the context of the process side of industrial design: marketing, corporate identity, technical expertise, dealing with customers, quotations and acquisition. The reality of working in an international field is discussed. Clients, producers and consumers are, after all, often located outside the Netherlands. The student will be introduced to the world of managing directors, marketers and researchers. Design drawing & sketching and Computer skills Design drawing & sketching Hand Drawing is an extension of the student’s visual expressive abilities. Students learn basic skills in manually presenting and designing 2D with various techniques and materials. He works individually on the set assignment. The classes are taught in the context of the design courses. Computer skills Computer skills in the context of the design courses are an extension p.159 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Programme The programme is taught by teachers who have a full-time practice in the field. Teachers and guest lecturers are invited on the basis of relevance to design assignments and required knowledge and skills. This gives ID a highly realistic content. The different backgrounds of the students also provide added value. applied arts, engineering, marketing, manufacturing of small series and mass production, consumer market, retail and business to business. The student finds his way between Milan and Frankfurt, and between Delft and Eindhoven. of the student’s visual expressive abilities. Central are basic knowledge and extensions of computer skills, and extension-programmes and rendering techniques. The skills are transferred per item and in a transparent manner. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Personality, contemplation and culture Personality skills Designers should not only deliver a good design, but should also be able to communicate it from their personal perspective to all those involved. In these classes, we address matters such as personality development, communication skills (verbal and written), negotiation, and consultancy and project management skills. Contemplation The student learns to take a stand in the social and theoretical context of the design discipline and to position his design vision in this context. The teacher presents various views and opinions on this matter. Discussion and development of the student’s own vision is characteristic to this course. Culture carriers The student is introduced to the cultural and commercial embedding of design. The lecturer(s) are renowned authorities in the cultural, political or business field. They can be curators of museums, members of the municipal executive of economic affairs or representatives from a cultural fund. They familiarise the students with the context and objectives of such bodies. Students can determine their own position in these organisations. Culture Carriers provides knowledge on the contemporary context of the design. Registration and fees Potential candidates can apply by filling out an application form and sending in a CD-ROM with own work. The admission procedure includes an assessment interview with an admission committee. ID is fully funded by p.160 tuition fees paid by students. This amounts to € 1925, - per semester (2), excluding the required materials. The schedule, content and structure of the curriculum are subject to change. A list of the lecturers is available on request. The Post Graduate Course Industrial Design can only commence with enough entries. Staff Head of department Ernst Bergmans / e.bergmans@kabk.nl Coordinator Jacob de Baan / info@jacobdebaan.com Team of Lecturers Jacob de Baan / info@jacobdebaan.com Erland Bakkers / erland@bakkers.nl Roselien Steur / info@sketching.nl Alfred van Elk / www.alfredvanelk.com Jantje Fleischhut / www.jantjefleischhut.com Maaike Roozenburg / www.maaikeroozenburg.nl Guest teachers, among others: Patrick Belli / www.bellidesign.nl Joris Castermans / www.syntens.nl Maurice Ciapponi / www.ciapponi.nl Theo van Dusseldorp Maartje de Haan / www.meermanno.nl Sam van Haaster / www.dokmedical.nl Siem Haffmans / www.ragbag.eu Frans de La Haye Ineke Heerkens / ineke_heerkens@planet.nl Milou Ket / www.milouket.com Josée Koene Wilfred Löwensteyn / www.tokohome.nl Hans Menkveld / www.tesink.nl Bruno Ninaber / www.ninaber.nl Ingeborg de Roode / www.stedelijk.nl Chris Sluter / www.chrissluter.nl Nicole Uniquole / www.uniquole.nl Loes Wagemans / www.gewoon.nl 4.2 Type & Media (MDes) In September 2002 the Royal Academy of Art in The Hague started its post-graduate course in Type and Media, formerly the course in Type Design and Typography. It is a fulltime one year course that gives participants the possibility of delving deeper in type design for different media: not only type for print, but also for film, television, video and interactive media. Although we live in an increasingly pictorial culture, type design and typography have lost none of their value. Since its Accreditation it is a Master of Design in Type and Media. The regular teachers are: // J an Willem Stas (course supervisor, professor in typography); // E rik van Blokland (professor in type design); // P eter Verheul (professor in type design). // P aul van der Laan (professor in type design). Visiting teachers, attached to the regular course in Graphic Design at the Royal Academy of Art are: // F rank Blokland; The many aspects of type design in relation to typography for different media are covered in various assignments. Assignments are both practical and theoretical and in some cases in co-operation with the media industry. Discussions with a number of leading graphic designers –each with a different view- provide theoretical depth. The various excursions and conferences, like the yearly conferences of ATypI – Association Typographique Internationale – and Typo Berlin, are also worth mentioning. The master course also organizes different activities in the field of type design, like the three-yearly Gerrit Noordzij Award. Students Type and Media play an important role in the activities concerning this Award. // J ust van Rossum. Visiting teachers are: // F rançoise Berserik; // P eter Bi’lak; // P etr van Blokland; // C hristoph Noordzij; // F red Smeijers; // G erard Unger. Anyone wishing to register for the Master of Design Type and Media course is invited to make an appointment with the course supervisor, Jan Willem Stas (jw.stas@kabk.nl). Candidates must be graduates of an art or design academy and must have sufficient practical experience. The candidate should present his or her motivation to register for the master course, partly based on a portfolio of work. They should, of course, be fascinated by type design, typography and different media, and be acquainted with developments in the field. p.163 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide At Type and Media, students work intensively in small groups of no more than twelve persons. They work under the guidance of expert and enthusiastic teachers from the permanent and visiting faculty. Although the student’s personal motivation is given primary place, collaboration with other students is of fundamental importance. 4.3 ArtScience (MMus) Overview of the master ArtScience As part of the ArtScience Interfaculty, the Royal Academy of Art and the Royal Conservatoire have been offering a two-year interdisciplinary master since 2002. At the ArtScience Interfaculty students and teachers are developing new forms of interdisciplinary art, and the goal of the teaching programme of the Interfaculty is to investigate and possibly shape the intersection between artistic concepts and recent developments in science and technology. Participants in the master’s programme of the ArtScience Interfaculty are admitted on the basis of a research proposal, and depending on the research topic the student chooses two personal coaches. The three of them together then draw up a study- and research plan that will include course modules, projects and labs offered within the ArtScience Interfaculty and which can also include other courses from the Royal Conservatoire, The Royal Academy of Art or Leiden University. This choice will be based on both the research topic and the background of the student; also the ratio between self-study and course modules will be different for each student. Complementing this individual track are a number of introductory courses that are obligatory Goals of the programme The master’s programme is geared towards students who have already finished some form of higher art education and who already have at least the beginning of an independent artistic practice. During the master’s study they can pursue a two-year personal research project with the aim to develop or transform their own artistic niche within the broad field of the arts and sciences. Depending on the research proposal and the background of the student a study and research plan is made that enables the student to acquire the skills, research methods and conceptual background necessary for their research. Because of the tailored nature of the individual study trajectories, master’s students are expected to further develop their independence, self-organization and critical thought during their studies. On top of this there are a number of collective activities for all master’s students, with the aim to offer solid theoretical, methodological and historical knowledge of the ArtScience field and in order to stimulate the exchange of skills, knowledge and viewpoints between students. The students are challenged to develop a range of professional competencies regarding three domains: // The artistic-technical domain; // The professional world; // The theoretical domain. p.165 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Every year, the programme of courses and projects is partly updated according to current themes from the area where art, media, science and technology overlap. Possible artistic responses to recent developments are formulated by experimenting with new contexts and forms in which art can play a role. This discussion is continually related to an interdisciplinary base in which the continuity between media art, music, theatre, film and visual art is considered to be self-evident. for all ArtScience master students. Also there are collective activities especially geared towards the mutual contribution to the research of fellow students. The progress in the individual work is being monitored in evaluations by the ArtScience teachers two times a year. Within each of these domains students are expected to develop competencies within these areas: // Creativity; // Critical reflection; // Growth and innovation; // Organizing; // Communication; // Relating to the environment; Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // Collaboration. These competencies are the basis of the evaluation by the teachers at the end of each course module and they are also used to evaluate the presentations at the end of each semester. In turn, twice a year an evaluation meeting is held for the students to evaluate the programme and suggest improvements. Structure of the programme The open curriculum and the study plan The master’s programme ArtScience, like the bachelor’s programme, is based on the concept of the open curriculum. Because the master students are admitted on the basis of a specific research plan and because two years is too short to familiarize themselves with the Interfaculty before making choices, this research plan is translated into a study plan together with the coaches. This study plan maps out the individual path of the student through the teaching modules on offer within the Interfaculty and related departments and institutions. At the ArtScience Interfaculty there are four forms of tuition: research projects, labs, individual coaching and courses. These activities are open to master as well as bachelor students ArtScience. In the last two years, seven labs have been set up within the Interfaculty, each of which is a combination of a labo- p.166 ratory, a production facility and an ensemble of teachers, students, alumni and guests working there. Each lab is also a platform to offer coaching and space for projects by individual students, and a channel for the accumulation, documentation and dissemination of their research results and artworks. The aim is to gradually integrate the research proposals of the master’s with this new lab structure where possible, and work towards a situation where bachelors assist in research projects. Part of the study trajectory can consist of courses outside of the Interfaculty. Likely choices are the Introductory Courses offered by the KABK (Moving Image, WebDesign, 3d-animation, Sound) and the courses offered at the MediaTechnology master of Leiden University. Apart from this a broad spectrum of courses within the Royal Academy, the Royal Conservatoire and Leiden University are available. In the past students have followed courses in Sonology, Singing, Percussion, Photography, Print Making, Art History, Philosophy, Electronics, Sociology, Bio-informatics, Art and Genomics. We would like to encourage students to explore other possibilities and surprise us. Self-study and coaching Each master student has two teachers who coach the individual work, reflect on it together with the student, offer a context for it, suggest literature and other sources and often assist in solving practical problems. Depending on the nature of the research proposal each student has a certain amount of time for individual work and self-study within the masters programme. Collective activities for master’s students There are a number of collective activities for all master’s students, with the aim to offer a broader orientation on the ArtScience field and in order to stimulate the exchange of skills, knowledge and viewpoints. In the first year the master’s are expected to follow a number of introductory courses that are offered at ArtScience, of which ‘Media Art Histories‘ and ‘Nine Snapshots‘ are compulsory. These introductory courses give a historical and theoretical overview of the ArtScience field. Presentations and evaluations In January and in June there are collective presentations. The mid-term presentations in January have the form of a discussion where the students are asked to show the progress of their research and where this progress is discussed with all the teachers. At the presentations in June the student is expected to show a new work that will be judged in the context of the research of the student and with the general competences for the master programme in mind. At the end of May the graduates of the bachelor and the master will organize a public preview of the final exam projects. These should be completed by this date, so that the remaining month can be used for rehearsals and fine-tuning. Admission to the Master’s programme of the ArtScience Interfaculty Students are admitted to the master’s Those interested in applying for the MMus programme ArtScience are invited to contact head of the Interfaculty, Joost Rekveld (via e–mail joost.rekveld@interfaculty.nl) for a first, general assessment whether the profile of the applicant matches the programme and for feedback on a first draft of the research proposal. Master’s candidates should also fill in the online admission form on the website www.koncon.nl. In order to apply for the ArtScience MMus programme we ask you to send us your research proposal, a curriculum vitae (resume), a portfolio and a number of official documents. All written materials should be in Dutch or English. After a preselection based on these materials, candidates will be invited for an interview. European candidates are expected to be physically present at this interview, with candidates outside of Europe we will propose a skype meeting. The deadline for application is the 1st of april. Candidates must send all required materials in one package adressed to Joost Rekveld, Master’s Programme ArtScience, Royal Conservatoire, Juliana van Stolberglaan 1, 2595 CA Den Haag, The Netherlands. Students are admitted to the master’s programme ArtScience on the basis of their previous artistic work and a research proposal. Only candidates with a bachelor’s degree in the arts or sciences can apply. Research Proposal In your research proposal we ask you to give an overview of where you stand now in your artistic activities, to propose a research project and to indicate how doing this research would change your artistic p.167 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Twice a month there is a master’s meeting: a gathering of all master’s students under the guidance of Arthur Elsenaar and Horst Rickels. These meeting focus on presenting the reults of the research by the students in spoken and written form and on discussing matters of methodology. Students will be helped to develop a critical context for their research and to structure their research process. Master’s students are asked to produce a written account of their critical context and research process, as part of their third presentation, half-way the second year. programme ArtScience on the basis of their previous artistic work and a research proposal. Only candidates with a bachelor’s degree in the arts or sciences can apply. future. You are free to choose a text format that suits your proposal and background, but it should be between two and four pages A4 of text long. The text should cover the following points: // P lease give us some background to your artistic past; briefly explain the motivation behind getting involved in art and behind the artistic choices you have made so far. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // P lease describe the artistic disciplines you have been involved or interested in so far. // P lease give a clear description of your research topic and the fields this topic relates to. // P lease explain your motivation for choosing this research topic. How do you think doing this research will transform your work? // P lease indicate how your research topic is related to the ArtScience curriculum. // P lease make a first choice for two ArtScience teachers who could coach you in your research (you can look at the Faculty Biographies on the website or in the ArtScience study guide). // P lease describe two concrete projects you would like to realize as part of this research proposal. // P lease indicate the materials and facilities you will need for your research. // P lease give an outline of what you hope to achieve during your studies at the ArtScience Interfaculty. // P lease describe how you think you will be able to contribute to the learning environment at the Interfaculty. p.168 Curriculum Vitae (Resume) This should cover: // y our previous education; // y our artistic past (see also portfolio, below); / / w ork experience; / / l anguages. Portfolio In the portfolio you should show us documentation of works of art you made. These original works can be in any art form or medium, while the documentation should be a short text describing each work, illustrated with photos, drawings, reviews, etc. Please include audio on CD and video on DVD, in which case you should mark a maximum of three minutes you absolutely want to be viewed or listened to by the selection committee. Digital documentation should run on both Mac and PC, can be on CD or DVD and should use standard file formats (jpeg tiff pdf mp3 flash aiff quicktime avi powerpoint). Please do not send us originals. For practical reasons we can not always return your portfolio. Official documents A copy of the candidate’s a visa (when applicable), of relevant diplomas, two photos, and email address included. passport, a copy passport should be Credit Points Overview YEAR 1 Excursion Ars Electronica...........1 Introductory theoretical Courses....4 ArtScience Colloquium...............2 Participation in ArtScience Labs....8 participation in ArtScience.......... research project....................7 Master Meetings.....................4 Individual study trajectory.......... (individual researchplan)..........18 Presentation 1......................8 Presentation 2......................8 Head of Interfaculty Joost Rekveld Coordinator Leonie Zweekhorst Core teachers Cocky Eek Arthur Elsenaar Edwin van der Heide Kasper van der Horst Michiel Pijpe Robert Pravda Joost Rekveld Horst Rickels Joel Ryan Taco Stolk Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide YEAR 2 ArtScience Colloquium...............2 Participation in ArtScience Labs....8 Master Meetings.....................4 Writing Assignment..................4 How to Survive the World Outside....2 individual study trajectory.......... (individual research plan).........12 Presentation 3......................8 Presentation 4: Final................ examination project................20 Staff at the ArtScience Interfaculty Guest teachers Nadine Bongaerts Eva Brinkman Lex van der Broek Sonia Cillari Evelina Domnitch Wim van Eck Dmitry Gelfand Vincent van Gerven Oei Marcus Graf Gosse de Kort Katinka Marac Nenad Popov Sanne van Rijn TeZ (Maurizio Martinucci) Frank Theys Caro Verbeek p.169 4.4 Film and Photographic Studies (MAFPS) Introduction Film and Photography are currently the focus of considerable interest. The Amsterdam Film museum, during more than sixty years of its existence, has built up a reputation with an appealing and daring programme. Photography museums have been established in Rotterdam, The Hague and Amsterdam. Moreover, articles on photography regularly appear in the art pages of leading newspapers. Art museums and university libraries pay more and more attention to their own photo collections. Furthermore, the Leiden University Library houses one of our country’s oldest and most complete photo collections. As a result of this increasing interest, there is a growing need for well-trained individuals with specialist knowledge in this field. These individuals are professionals Areas of attention The master specialization in Film and Photographic Studies aims to provide you with a broad academic and social orientation on film and photography as well as insight into research about photographic practice and history of film. Particular areas of attention include: // i nterdisciplinary methods in the academic study of film and photography; // t heories of film, photography and video; // t he significance of film and photography as a means of communication and a mass medium with specific underlying strategies; // t he interconnections among film, photography, video, visual culture and other forms of visual art; // t he forms of presentation for film and photography (exhibitions, internet, publications, reviews, etc.); // fi lm and photographic practice as research; // s trategies in the field of collecting, conservation and management. As a result of the increasing interest in film and photography and the growing role played by film and photography in society, the surroundings in which film and photography can be investigated are increasing. Therefore, recent developments such as digital photography and new media are also discussed in the programme. p.171 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Film and Photographic Studies – a specialization of the MA Media Studies – is a unique programme in The Netherlands that integrates science and art. The master is initiated by the Institute of Cultural Disciplines, the department of Art History and the Print Room of Leiden University Library and the Royal Academy of Art in The Hague. A high degree of cross-disciplinary thinking is encouraged, as is witnessed by the close collaboration with the Department of Art History and other departments of Leiden University as the Print Room/ Division of Special Collections of the Leiden University Library. The various courses are offered by means of lectures, meetings, seminars and excursions and through self-study based on specific texts or photographic objects, (historical) photographic sources and films and in-depth analysis of history and criticism of photography, film, and video. who can approach and analyse film and photography both as independent media and in relation to other disciplines. The master specialization in Film and Photographic Studies at Leiden University is the only programme that focuses specifically on film and photography while maintaining an interdisciplinary approach as well as providing academic (intellectual) skills. 4.5 INSIDE Interior Architecture (MDes) INSIDE: Design for the real world (Victor Papanek) The Royal Academy of Art in The Hague launched INSIDE, an entirely new Master Interior Architecture since September 2011. This internationally orientated course is a meeting place where students, designers, theoreticians, architects and critics participate on broadening and deepening the content of interior architecture and contribute to solving social issues that really count. Hans Venhuizen Programme Coordinator Marja van der Burgh The team of internationally orientated architects, designers and theoreticians: Elma van Boxel and Kristian Koreman (ZUS) URBAN Anne Holtrop INTER Jan Jongert (2012 Architecten) FLOWS Jan Konings SPACE Other people involved in the programme: Bert van Meggelen Arienne Matser Timo de Rijk Ellen van Loon Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide INSIDE is a two-year, full-time, English-taught programme, which targets the real world, a world that is changing. Large-scale interiors, a changing relation between private and public space, sustainability and a greater demand for social cohesion are themes that call for new forms of interior architecture. Head of the master programme The content of INSIDE is focused on an annual social theme and a set of problems of residents or users of interior architecture. Sustainable, humane solutions for problems are developed and presented through research, conceptualisation and spatial design. More information Visit the website www.enterinside.nl or mail at info@enterinside.nl If you have any further questions, please contact: Royal Academy of Art INSIDE, MA Interior Architecture info@enterinside.nl p.173 4.6 Introduction (MMus) The Master Artistic Research (MAR) is a two-year interdisciplinary Master Trajectory for Research in the Arts for students working in the field of visual art and/or music. The programme is a collaboration between the Royal Academy of Art and the Royal Conservatory in the Hague, and was established in September 2009. Visual artists and musicians have always researched, without it being named as such. Artists working in the field of artistic research are taught to develop a heightened self-reflexivity about their artistic practice, to explicitly position their practice in relation to wider artistic and non-artistic discourses and to expand their knowledge bases into areas that fall outside of the realms of art discourse, but are relevant to their individual artistic practice. The Master Artistic Research extends students’ research skills, including the ability to gather relevant material, to undertake close reading, listening and looking, to locate and understand connections within and across that material and to make informed judgments about the value and relevance of ideas from sources external to their practice. They learn to use insights gained through reflection to improve their artistic The Study Programme The research proposal of each individual student, submitted on application to the course, forms the point of departure for the two-year Master trajectory. This proposal outlines areas of specific interest for investigation as well as areas of practice that the student would like to further develop, extend or break open. This proposal is revisited and revised during the course of the study, and results typically in a series of artistic products rather than an academic research outcome, unless the student explicitly wishes to undertake a formal written thesis. The methodologies artistic research entails are as diverse as artistic practice itself. Research methods used by students of the Master Artistic Research include inter-personal dialogue, reading artists’ writings, critical texts and academic essays, gathering aural, visual and physical materials, forming imagebased, textual, musical and sound archives, watching and making films, doing interviews, visiting exhibitions, attending performances and carrying out collaborative experiments with people in other fields. An exploratory, focused approach to these activities and the continuous further development of lines of enquiry define them as research. The study is conceived as being 60% ‘practical’ (practice and research) and 40% ‘theoretical’ (exploration and research). In real terms, these activities are approached as an integrated practice. It is understood that the status of what constitutes research or an artwork can be fluid. Students are provided with the opportunity to develop, strengthen and reflect on the relationship between practice and theory in their work p.175 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The articulation of artistic research as a demarcated activity emerged in relation to questions regarding whether artists produce knowledge, and if so, how this knowledge relates to academic knowledge. Artistic research makes space for research in the arts by artists (as opposed to research about the arts by non-artists). From the point of view of academic discourse, artistic research facilitates more insight into artistic practice. For artists, and for students participating in the course, the primary goal of artistic research is the further development of artistic practice. work. The result of the research is, in the first place, an artistic product in the broadest sense of the word. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide through ongoing dialogue with their allocated practice and theory tutors as well as their fellow students. One important focus of the core teaching curriculum lies in developing the appropriate form for the work in process, based on the demands of the content of the material being worked with. Students are provided with a working space and have access to all of the general workshop facilities of the Royal Academy and the Royal Conservatoire. During the course students learn to develop their critical reflection on their own work and areas of interest, to analyze and explore their ideas and findings, to communicate these with others through speech and on paper. The research trajectory is documented and explored through a series of research reflection papers, in which students reflect on and analyze their unfolding artistic process, exploring external input from within the course programme as well as outside. These reports provide insight into the departure points, methods and outcomes of the artistic process and form an important basis for dialogue with tutors. They encourage students to think about what they have done, what they might have done differently, how they feel about the process, and how they might change it to extend their learning curve, using insight gained through reflection to improve their own and other students’ work. All students participate in one artistic research group, a small cluster of students guided by specialized theory and practice tutors to engage with a shared area of interest (eg. Art and politics). They work together weekly through group dialogue, engagement with each others’ practices and that of relevant artists and thinkers. The students follow a number of related workshops per year and work together towards a collaborative event and publication. Each research group is p.176 supported by guest lectures and presentations, as well as studio visits by practitioners within the fields of music, art and other disciplines such as choreography or academic fields that are relevant to the work of current students. Additional guest lectures support artistic development at large. There are also guest lectures and workshops organized to address professional practice skills, such as the process of applying for funding or residencies. During the course of the academic year, a number of exhibitions and events are organized during which students can practice presenting their work at a professional level. These events are guided by core tutors and sometimes by a curator or other expert from the field. Students are asked to critically reflect on the process and outcomes of these events, treating them as a learning opportunity as well as a means to disseminate their work to a wider public. These exhibitions and events take place within the galleries and auditorium of the Royal Academy of Art as well as at selected external venues. The Master Artistic Research has a close working relationship with the Academy of Creative and Peforming Arts. Students are invited to participate in selected courses and events, fostering the students’ involvement in a wider artistic research community and introducing Master students to discourse at PhD level. The Master Artistic Research in The Hague also collaborates in organizing an annual exchange with students of the Master Artistic Research in Amsterdam with a view to further extending this research community. Students are also occasionally invited to attend and/or participate in related conferences or events related to artistic research. The Musical Dimension of the course The Master Artistic Research course offers a research environment for expanded practice. For visual artists it can open up or further develop an engagement with sound and performance. Some of the students’ practices operate on the borderline between music and art. For these students it offers a chance for a deeper dialogue, for critical reflection on the significance of this position, and for a greater level of expertise in the field that has not formed their primary working background. For the musician access to visual art’s wide variety of media and ways of working opens up new creative possibilities for an expanded music practice. This includes the repertoire of performance art, which can extend and challenge conceptions of performance in music, as well as the use of video and other visual media under the guidance of artists who are familiar with its creative scope. It includes the potential of working in Through theoretical seminars and guest lectures as well as core teaching, musicians are exposed to new discourses coming out of the field of art specifically as well as wider cultural theory, which can inspire new areas of work and support the musician to articulate complex areas of their practice. They are guided individually in this process by a theory tutor with an interdisciplinary professional background as well as by a writing tutor. The Master Artistic Research offers a supportive environment for the creation of collaborative works and the establishment of collaborative practice. To date the resulting artistic output can be positioned on the borderline between art and music, being received differently but with interest by audiences from both fields. Students also take part in wider interdisciplinary activities within the Royal Conservatoire, including MAsh_UP (an interdisciplinary platform within the Conservatoire) and C.A.S.S. evenings (a platform for students of Composition, Artscience, Sonology, MAR). General learning objectives // T he Master Artistic Research teaches students to critically reflect on and analyze their artistic practice to develop their artistic output to a level suitable for autonomous professional practice in the fields of music and/or visual art. p.177 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Other students express the wish to extend their media into the field of visual art or music. For a visual artist, the musical dimension of the course can allow further development of areas of their art practice that touch on sound – such as the development of sound for installation art works or producing experimental sound to accompany video and film work. Music can also offer the means to establish entirely new ways of working. This includes exploring sound as a medium in itself, including the creative potential of instruments and the voice, as well as allowing the ideas and methodologies related to musical composition and performance to trigger new lines of artistic thinking. Visual artists can participate in selected courses at the Conservatoire to increase their knowledge about specific areas, as well as having individual guidance from music tutors. space and the possibility of using sculptural or choreographic elements within an expanded musical practice as well as considering the perceptual arenas the use of the visual opens up. Experimental musicians can gain support to develop their video documentation of live performance, experiencing how artists use documentation to form new work in its own right. // S tudents are led to explore an expanded field of practice, extending into new areas and further developing aspects of their practice that may have received limited support due to the restrictions of their disciplinary backgrounds. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // S tudents learn to position their practice within wider debates within their respective fields and in relation to wider social and academic discourses. // S tudents are taught how to present their artistic work within the professional context through the putting together of exhibitions and events, with critical reflection and input from tutors and professionals in their field. // T he Master Artistic Research teaches students discursive written and oral means to communicate their practice and disseminate their research to audiences within and outside of their field. Study point requirements Master Artistic Research students are obliged to carry out the following activities to fulfill their study point requirements for graduation: // A ttend regular individual tutorials and group classes with practice and theory. // R egularly present new works to tutors and fellow students to demonstrate the student’s artistic evolution and the relationship between his/her research process and artistic work. // W rite or digitally record reflection papers on his or her artistic development and research trajectory. // A ctively participate in one artistic research group, attending the related meetings, guest lectures, theoretical p.178 seminars and workshops. // A ttend a general guest programme of lectures and seminars. // P eriodically exhibit or perform new work in MAR exhibitions and events and actively contribute to the organization and putting together of these events. Cooperation with Leiden University Together the Royal Academy of Art and the Royal Conservatoire constitute the University of the Arts in The Hague. There is also close cooperation with the Academy of the Arts of the University of Leiden, which makes it possible for students of the Royal Academy of Art and the Royal Conservatoire to take optional subjects or to follow minor or master programmes at the university. The Royal Academy of Art in The Hague also hosts two unique, high-quality Ph.D. trajectories: in fine art and design, leading to a PhArts, and in music, leading to a DocArtes. The PhDArts programme for Research in and through Artistic Practice offers artists the possibility to obtain an international doctorate in art and design. PhDArts is a collaboration between the Leiden University Academy of Creative and Performing Arts and the Royal Academy of Art. Application The Master trajectory is officially enrolled at the Royal Conservatoire, as a research path of the Interfaculty ArtScience. Practically this means the student is officially registered at the Royal Conservatoire, even if the study direction is visual arts. At the completion of the study the student will receive the title Master of Music. For admission to the master trajectory, a Bachelor in one of the disciplines of the arts from a Dutch university of applied sciences (HBO / Hogeschool) or an equivalent Bachelor of Arts diploma earned abroad is required, as well as a demonstrable affinity with theoretical research and / or artistic reflection. English is the working language of the master trajectory, and proficiency in both speaking and writing is required. Applications and motivation letters should be written in English. When these entrance requirements are met, the applicant is judged on the basis of: a portfolio of artistic work, a research proposal and / or study plan, in which an understanding of, and affinity with research are clearly evident as well as an interview about his / her work and affinity with research in the arts. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide How to apply Please visit our website www.masterartisticresearch.eu and send the following documents and materials to mar@koncon.nl before 1 April 2014: // c ompleted application form; // p ortfolio (in PDF format. If the portfolio is too large to send by email, it can be send by regular mail to the address below on CD-ROM or DVD, or by using WeTransfer or a similar service); // i n addition please send these documents by post to the address below: ›› a photocopy of your diploma(s)/ degree(s); ›› a photocopy of the relevant pages of your valid passport (showing passport number and expiry date) or EU/EEA National Identity Card; ›› recent passport photo (3×4 cm; please write your name on the back. Only original photos! Photocopies are not accepted); ›› OPTIONAL: portfolio (only if the portfolio is too large to be send through email). We do not accept incomplete applications. All documents sent by post should be in our possession on 1 April 2014. p.179 4.7 Media Technology (MSc) Media Technology Master of Science (MSc) is a joint initiative of the Computer Science programme of the Faculty of Mathematics and Natural Sciences, Leiden University and the Interfaculty ArtScience. It provides a place where students, artists and researchers are given the opportunity to formulate their own personal research questions. The participants are encouraged to translate their personal inspiration and curiosity into manageable and relatively small research projects. English The programme is entirely taught in English. This allows students, teachers and artists of different nationalities to participate. All lectures, discussions, presentations and reading materials are in English. More information For more information on the master’s programme Media Technology please contact: Annebeth Simonz telephone number: +31 (0)71 5276994 Email address: asimonz@liacs.nl For course descriptions, examples of projects and other information, please visit our website: mediatechnology.leiden.edu Keywords of the Media Technology programme are creativity, technology and scientific research. We want to encourage innovation and creativity in scientific research. It can be said that Media Technology trains autonomous scientists; just as art academies educate autonomous artists. The Media Technology programme prepares students for a future in which creative and critical thinking play an important role, and in particular a future in scientific research. On graduating, students receive a Master of Science (MSc) degree from Leiden University, an internationally acclaimed title. Alumni occupy positions ranging from PhD candidate to creative entrepre- p.181 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The programme acknowledges that creativity is an important factor in scientific innovation. It therefore wants to provide a place where students, artists and scientists can do research by finding innovative solutions for questions - inspired by results and principles of science. In order to achieve this objective, the curriculum focuses on creative discovery and understanding of science and technology. Students are encouraged to make use of the extensive knowledge available at Leiden University and the ArtScience programme of the Royal Academy of Art in The Hague. neur. In general, science and the creative industry are the clients of our students. Actually each position where creativity is combined with scientific thinking is appropriate for our alumni. 4.8 PhDArts PhDArts is a platform for artists who consider theoretical reflection and artistic practice as intrinsically related and complementary to each other. Together with a team of supervisors, staff members and guest teachers, the doctoral candidates of PhDArts form an inspiring and challenging research environment. As a unique programme in the Netherlands, PhDArts creates new possibilities for art and its practitioners by questioning and breaking down existing boundaries between the disciplines of art theory and practice. About PhDArts In practice-based research, or research in and through art, practical action (the making) and theoretical reflection (the thinking) go hand in hand. The one cannot exist without the other; in the same way that action and thought are inextricably linked in artistic practice. This type of research does not have a predetermined methodology. It has an open character, which is determined by the desire to reflect one’s art or design practice, in collaboration with others. Research has always been an integral part of the artistic practice of visual artists The artist/designer-as-researcher distinguishes himself from other artists by taking it upon himself to make statements about his thinking process and the production of work. The researcher allows others to participate in this research process, entering into a discussion with others and opening himself up to critique. The researcher seeks the discussion in the public domain. Without public discussion and the exchange with peers the research lacks its reason for existence. When this exchange takes place in an academic context, within the framework of research for a PhD, certain conditions apply. For example, the research needs to yield fresh insights, not merely into one’s personal work but into art or design in the broader sense as well. Supervision plays a crucial part in critically evaluating the contribution to the artistic domain. Language, in whichever way, plays an important part in the research. Without language it is impossible to enter into a discourse. Inventing a language which enables the researcher to communicate with others and which enables the evaluation of the research is as important as devising a viable research methodology. PhDArts doctorate Research in and through art is an inseparable part of the artistic or design practice of the researcher. Consequently, research-in-art (as opposed to research about art, such as art history) does not have a set p.183 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide PhDArts offers an international, highlevel doctorate in art and design. The PhDArts research trajectory consists of two elements: individual research and participation in the doctoral study programme. An appropriate team of supervisors is sought for each doctoral student. The doctoral study programme, which consists of lectures, seminars, trainings, and workshops, is an essential part of the research environment in which the student undertakes his or her research. PhDArts is a collaboration between the Leiden University Academy of Creative and Performing Arts and the Royal Academy of Art (KABK) in The Hague. and designers, but over the past decades, attention for the research aspect of art and design practice has increased. Contemporary artists and designers often position themselves as researchers in both the social and the artistic field. In some cases the research has become the art work or design itself; matter and medium function as the instruments in the research or ‘thinking process’. goal or expected result, nor are there predetermined general procedures. The outcome of the research is open. This openness is a condition for conducting research in art and design. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide There is a unique relationship between the artist/designer, the research method and the outcome of the research. This research is only possible thanks to the artist’s artistry and, the other way round, the artist develops his artistry through the research. The outcome is therefore an artistic product, combined with a discursive product, the dissertation, which does justice to the artistic one. This final result of this type of research, which is by its nature speculative, cannot be restricted to one particular form. The criteria for the form the research may take are therefore kept as open as possible. Also, there is no fixed ratio between dissertation and artistic production. The requirements that the research must satisfy and the researcher’s methodology derive in part from the assignment that the artist or designer has given himself. Certain conditions apply to the PhDArts doctorate. A high level of artistry/design is a prerequisite for acceptance in the PhD programme. The applicant should have a clear research theme as well as a research plan. In addition, the context of the research should be clearly described. The research should offer new insights, not only in the work of the maker but also in art and design in the broader sense; the research should contribute to knowledge about art/design and the international discourse in the field of research. The researcher is expected to be in the vanguard of his field of research. p.184 The research must take place in an appropriate research environment. Experimentation is an important part of both the process and the result. Critical engagement is inseparably related to the research theme and its results. The final product must be communicated both visually and in writing, and thought and reflection must be clearly present in several ways. Firstly, a report on the research project must provide insight into the departure points, methods and results. Secondly, the work itself must be deliberative: reflection must be an intricate part of it. Research that fulfills these conditions will be innovative and relevant to contemporary developments in the world of art and design. At the end of the PhDArts trajectory, the work must be presented to a committee of experts for evaluation. As part of the research, the doctoral student is expected to attend the doctoral study programme, including the various evaluations. The student should actively and passively participate in conferences (lectures, papers, conference reports) and events. In addition to this, the doctoral student should periodically exhibit new artwork to illustrate the artistic evolution and the relationship between the research and the artistic work, as well as publish writings on one’s work, development and research. PhDArts doctoral programme The PhDArts doctorate programme consists of individual research and the doctoral study programme. Individual research Each research trajectory is individually supervised. The role of the supervisors consists of helping students to develop a suitable research environment. The supervising team consists of the Directing Supervisor and one or two assisting supervisors. The Directing Supervisor is the main person responsible for the student’s supervision. He or she is, in principle, selected from within the institute. One or two supervisors, who are experts in specific aspects of the research, assist the Directing Supervisor. After admission, the doctoral student chooses the assisting supervisors in consultation with PhDArts staff. The choice of the assisting supervisors has to be practically feasible. PhD students are responsible for the progress of their research. It is the student’s task to update the supervision team on his development and notify them of his presentation and evaluation moments. It is up to the student to initiate and maintain the contact with his supervisors and the PhDArts directory. Doctoral study programme The doctoral study programme is supplemental to the supervision of individual research in the PhDArts research trajectory. The supervisors also follow the student’s preparations for presentation moments and the final presentation by ensuring that there is a good balance between written text and art-specific means, so that the research results may be communicated in an optimal fashion. The study programme in the fall semester (September – December) includes an aesthetics and philosophy of science course, and a course covering presentation and information training and writing techniques, with presentations by and discussions with researchers from various disciplines. Furthermore, the supervisor guarantees the required in-depth investigation and broadening of the research topic, as well as possibilities for contextual research and frames of reference. Also, the supervisor ensures that there is a proper balance of artistic work and reflection. In the spring semester (January – June), the study programme consists of monthly meetings of one or multiple days. These meetings take place in the form of workshops or colloquia. Workshops consist of presentations by and discussions with prominent visual artists and designers as well as with theorists, in combination with presentations by students. During the workshops theoretical aspects of the research will be explored. During the end of year colloquium students present on the progress of their research for their fellow candidates, and exchange ideas, thoughts and experiences. Students are expected to attend the The doctoral study includes a number of presentation moments throughout the course of the research, among others in the form of a Qualifying Hurdle after the first year, Annual Progress Reports in the subsequent years, and finally a public presentation and a public defense of the results of the research. p.185 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The tasks of the supervisors include continuously monitoring the quality of the research by keeping close track of the student’s progress and by supplying the necessary research methods and tools to sharpen the student’s critical approach to his research. The research community enables PhD students to exchange ideas. It is a framework which stimulates constructive and content-based criticism of the work of the students among themselves and with supervisors, visiting lecturers and staff. The research community is an important expansion of the possibilities for the undertaking of one’s practice and an expansion of the discourse. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide colloquium throughout the entire duration of their doctoral study and to attend at least half of the courses and training sessions in the first semester and half of the workshops in the second semester. Precisely when this happens is up to the student, but it is advisable to follow courses and training sessions at the beginning of one’s doctoral study. It is recommended to attend the full study programme. The research community is formed during the doctoral study programme, and also through the research facilities offered by PhDArts. These facilities differ depending on the research project. They include access to libraries, availability of studio spaces for presentations and of equipment and computer facilities, and cooperation with partner institutions. Admission The yearly application deadlines for PhDArts are 1 April and 1 October. Accepted applicants can join the programme in September or January of each year. Applicants must have a Master’s of Arts degree or proof of study at a comparable level. English is the working language of PhDArts, and proficiency in both speaking and writing in English is required. Because PhDArts is a practice-as-research doctorate, the applicant must first and foremost demonstrate that he is a highly accomplished practitioner in some aspect of the arts and/or design. On a theoretical level, the applicant has to demonstrate that his ideas are already quite well-formed and that he has begun to place his own contribution within the context of existing research or innovative practice. The applicant will need to show a strong p.186 sense of intellectual curiosity and be able to justify what the urgency for this particular research is. The application process consists of two phases. The first phase is the assessment of the applicant’s research dossier. The research dossier will be assessed by an Advisory Group, with representatives from the Royal Academy of Art The Hague and Leiden University (Academy of Creative and Performing Arts). In the case of a positive assessment by the Advisory Group, the applicant enters the second phase of the application process, and is invited for an Entrance Examination. The Entrance Examinations take place at the Royal Academy of Art, in The Hague. Applicants must put together a research dossier for the application procedure. The application must be written in English. The research dossier consists of three elements: / / A pplication form // D etailed curriculum vitae / / P ortfolio For more information on the programme and application procedures please visit: www.phdarts.eu 5.1 Research Domains 5.2 Research domain Art Theory and Practice Head of Lectorate: Janneke Wesseling Since 1 February 2007 Janneke Wesseling has been professor and head of the Lectorate Art Theory and Practice at the University of the Arts. She is co-director of PhDArts, PhD programme for visuals artists and designers at the Academy of Creative and Performing Arts at Leiden University. Wesseling also writes as art critic for NRC Handelsblad. The Lectorate ‘Art Theory and Practice’ researches how to naturally connect art and theory in art education. This occurs on a BA, MA and PhD level, at the University of the Arts and at the Academy of Creative and Performance Arts at Leiden University. An example is the Research in and through art, or artistic research, is becoming more and more important in art education. This is a consequence of the fact that both artists and theorists are increasingly focusing on the theoretical aspect of the artistic practice and the cognitive function of the art work: art as a tool to gain knowledge about reality. The artist-as researcher has become a familiar phenomenon. The practice of contemporary artists is, in many cases, characterised by a continuous reflection on the artist’s own actions. The attention for theory and research is accompanied by the re-structuring of higher education. The establishment of the Bachelor/Master structure on a European level asks for reflection on the research content in artistic practice. Wesseling’s Lectorate plays a pioneering role in the reciprocal exchange between art education and research. 5.3 Research Domain Interior Architecture: Inside Flows Researcher/Lector: Jan Jongert, 2012Architecten Contemporary interiors increasingly depend on a complex of connecting flows. The researchgroup ‘inside flows’ investigates the specifications and behaviour of these flows to support the development of sustainable designmethods. p.189 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide What is a research domain? Research domains (in Dutch: lectoraten) are the research groups of Universities of Applied Sciences, whose purpose it is to make connections in socially relevant areas between education, practice and practice-based research. The appointed professor leads a research group, which consists of a number of visual artists, designers and theorists from various disciplines. Additionally, contact is kept with those who are active or do research in the field of the research domain. People both inside and outside the academy can contribute to the research of a research domain. Sometimes also students work on (research) projects in the context of their study programme. Research domains share knowledge with companies and institutions, conduct applied research and develop new knowledge in co-production. They maintain partnerships with companies and institutions on local, regional, national and international levels. honours programme initiated by the Lectorate, which offers interdisciplinary workshops for BA students. Wesseling organises pilot projects in which education in art practice and art theory are integrated, in close cooperation with the different art departments of the Royal Academy of Art. Aditionally, the Lectorate organises symposia, workshops and lectures with different partners in the field of artistic research. From at least 13 different flowtypes varying from energy, water and food to knowledge, money and users, practical knowledge will be developed for application in design and research. Next to their content, as well the means to represent flow-systems will be subject of research. Conclusively the research group supports the flow of knowledge within the Master course, providing a knowledgebase/ encyclopedia and connecting different student projects by giving access to the accumulating knowledge from the perspective of flows. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide 5.4 Research domain Innovative Visualization Techniques (IVT) Professor: Yolande Kolstee Support and junior researchers: Reba Wesdorp and Mariana Kniveton Research domain Innovative Visualisation Techniques (IVT) The research domain Innovative Visualisation Techniques in art education focuses on the role and significance of innovative visualisation and interaction techniques in art (and design) education in relation to developments in the cultural domain and the creative industry. Never before were the possibilities to realise artistic and creative ideas with a computer as enormous as today. This is not only because of the increasing capabilities of (mobile) computers, but also because of increasingly user-friendly design software. New visualisation and interaction techniques are developing rapidly worldwide, and offer, as new media, unprecedented possibilities for art and design. The new visualisation, interaction and production techniques are an extremely fascinating field of interdisciplinary practice and research. p.190 This includes, for example: / / Computer-controlled equipment such as 3D printing, 3D scanning, laser cutter, milling machines, textile machines; // A ugmented Reality *) or other forms of mixed reality; / / D igital interactive installations; / / ( Interactive) applications (apps) for smartphones and tablets (iOS or Android). The research domain promotes learning to use and experiment with new (computer-controlled) equipment such as 3D printers, while it simultaneously recognises the importance of the old techniques. Website Workshops The research domain IVT has enabled the development of a KABK Workshops website, on which where all, old and new, equipment of the academy is listed in an organised manner. Workshop Labs: Remediate The overarching theme is Remediate. There is a lot of literature available on this subject, from, for example, J. David Bolter and Richard Grusin. In very rough lines, it concerns the incorporation of ‘old’ media in new media (e.g. film on the Internet). The question is then to research what is new about new media and what its added value is compared to existing media. This theme is not accidental: the academy might organise a major international conference on this theme in 2015. Per IST per block, one workshop containing new equipment is centralised. Students will explore how they can make one or more projects with this new equipment/software, which are then presented during a festive concluding event; like for example this year in cooperation with Studium Generale lectures (just as at the Pop-Ups). The professor, the workshop manager and possibly a guest lecturer supervise the labs. Subscribe via the IST registration system. Other opportunities to work with the research domain IVT: Teachers: Workshop Labs: Remediate Projects: Teachers can propose projects that are relevant to the area of research. Research: Teachers can contribute by doing research and write articles that might be published in the AR[t] Magazine or in another leading journal. Students Students can participate in different ways: // W orkshop Labs: Remediate // A R Lab projects in the IST (7 Wednesdays), often in collaboration with a museum // O wn projects // I ST course 3D Animation and Interaction design // T hesis guidance // I nternship The mission of the research domain IVT is: 1. Knowledge development by undertaking artistic, experimental, scientific and market research on the relevance of new visualisation and interaction techniques for art education, and expose the results to the widest possible audience in a relevant way for each type of research. The research domain aspires to give a boost to: // T eachers, to inform them about new technical developments in the field visualisation and interaction. // F ellow professors of research domains, to increase the importance in the academy of doing research in different fields, by collaborating with external research domains. Cooperation with TU Delft and Leiden University We are working on an inventory of courses/modules that are open to Royal KABK students on AR and related issues both at the TU Delft and Leiden University. 2. Network expansion and consolidation of a network relevant for the professional practice in the field of new visualisation and interaction techniques in relation art (and design) education. The research domain IVT wants to solidify and expand already existing theoretical and practical collaborations in the field of visualisation and interaction techniques between art education and (technical) science. We collaborate with researchers from three different faculties of the Delft University of Technology (Robotics, Industrial Design and Technology, Policy & Management) and with researchers from Media Technology at Leiden University. The research domain also seeks to promote international cooperation, and does so, for now, mainly via the AR Lab. p.191 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Teachers with ideas for the Workshop Labs: Remediate, projects or research, or for an article, can discuss this with Yolande Kolstee (y.kolstee@kabk.nl). // S tudents, to familiarise them with new visualisation techniques and their use in the cultural field through projects that often take place in a museum context, for example in the academy’s Augmented Reality Lab (AR Lab). Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The network built up by the AR Lab consists of artists and designers, and also of museums, large and small companies and numerous art events. There is a close relationship with the professional field, from which frequent questions concerning the application of new visualisation techniques reach us on almost a weekly basis. Impact on art production and design New visualisation and interaction techniques, or production techniques, have a great impact on the creation of art, on improving the image of our cultural heritage, on marketing and graphic design and on several other more technical areas. Particularly graphic and interaction designers will come into contact with it, and photographers equally so. Spatial designers in textile, fashion, interior and furniture design will also be exposed to the techniques in the future. For visual artists and students of the ArtScience department, it is a question whether it is desirable and possible to make art in and with the new visualisation techniques. Examples of already completed projects in collaboration with the AR Lab: // T he new visualisation techniques are of interest to all disciplines. Already in 2008 in Milan, at the Salone del Mobile, virtual furniture and fabrics were exhibited by the department Interior Architecture and Furniture Design and Textile & Fashion. // S tudents from the Graphic Design and Photography departments have worked on, among others, an AR set-up in the Kröller-Müller Museum. // S tudents of the Fine Arts and ArtScience departments participated in a threemonth exhibition in the Museum Boijmans Van Beuningen. p.192 // I MD Students participated in an AR exhibition at the Escher Museum in the Paleis. // F ine Arts and Graphic Design students have been working with AR and have even made it into their graduation projects. // S tudents Industrial Design designed a headset (‘eye-wear’) for mobile AR for the second time. // M ixed groups of students have worked on exhibitions at the Van Gogh museum and the Temporary Stedelijk Museum. // A rtScience and Interactive/ Media/Design students worked on an experiment with Layar on mobile phones for the Open Day in 2012. With different students, and in collaboration with the Norwegian College Gjøvik, we made an AR game for KLM for mobile phones. // I n 2012, Fine Arts, ArtSience and Interactive/Media/Design students worked on a digital visualisation at the performance of an opera (the Walküre) by Wagner in collaboration with the Royal Conservatoire. // F rom June 2011 until the move to the Hermitage in 2012, the Van Gogh Museum held a highly regarded application that was developed by a group of students from different disciplines. // S tudents of the Graphic Design department collaborated with the AR Lab, their professor Gert Dumbar and Studio Maaike Roozenburg, on the project ‘Smart Replicas’ Museum Boijmans van Beuningen in Rotterdam (opened in June 2013). AR Lab (Augmented Reality Lab) The research domain Innovative Visualisation Techniques in art education is closely linked to the Raak-PRO project AR-VIP: ‘augmented reality, visualisation, interaction and perception’ of the AR Lab. This project has as goal to enable artistic, experimental and scientific research aimed at developing new content and ways of interaction based on the technical possibilities of modern interactive visualisation tools such as AR. The research primarily takes place in the AR Lab, an experimental lab of the KABK, based in the Bleijenburg building on the first floor (BB.103). The website of the AR Lab is: http://www.arlab.nl In the AR Lab, Wim van Eck is the expert on 3D animation and application development. Digi-Drinks 2011-2012 In 2011-2012, the research domain IVT organised five digi-drinks to get to know the new workshops and/or new equipment knowledge. Pop Up Gallery 2012-2013 In academic year 2012-2013, students and guest artists realized five Pop Up Galleries under guidance of teachers from: Graphic Design, Photography, Fine Arts and Interactive Media Design. A special Pop Up Gallery was made into a contest to generate Victory Boogie Woogie in code on a display. This competition was organised by Wiskundemeisjes, the Gemeentemuseum, and Set-Up. The Code Lab from the ArtScience department delivered various works during this Pop Up. 5.5 Research in the Arts In The Hague Borgdorff is one of the project leaders of the project ‘The Artistic Research Catalogue’. In this project, funded by SIA-RAAK, 19 national and international partners (among them Van Abbemuseum, Rietveld Academy and Royal College of Art, London) are building a digital platform for the world wide documentation, exposition and distribution of research by artists. On behalf of The Hague he supports the international Society for Artistic research (co-founded by him in Mach 2010); he will work as editor of the Journal for Artistic Research; and he will chair the ‘Validation’ working group of the Erasmus academic network SHARE, which aims to strengthen the third cycle in art education in Europe. Borgdorff is a member of the Strategic Working Group on Research of the The Netherlands Association of Universities of Applied Sciences (HBO-raad). Henk Borgdorff occasionally gives seminars in the doctoral programmes DocArtes (music) and PhDArts (visual arts and design) and in the master’s programme Artistic Research at the KABK. Professor: Henk Borgdorff Henk Borgdorff is Professor in Research in the Arts at the University of the Arts, The Hague. Since p.193 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide *) Augmented Reality is the real-time adding of digital virtual images to reality. Augmented means: increased, enriched, added. The virtual images are digital 3D objects or 3D scenes. 1 September 2010, he combines this position with a Visiting Professorship at the Faculty of Fine, Applied and Performing Arts at the University of Gothenburg, Sweden. In both positions he focuses on the political and theoretical rationale of ‘artistic research’. In this emerging research field, the practice of the arts (creating, designing, composing, performing) is central to the research process and art practices and products (images, compositions, installations, performances etc.) partly form the outcome of the research. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide 5.6 Academy of Creative and Performing Arts The Academy of Creative and Performing Arts is a collaborative effort between Leiden University and the University of the Arts in The Hague. The University consists of the Royal Conservatoire (KC) and the Royal Academy of Art (KABK). The Academy of Creative and Performing Arts works on combining art and academics. This offers many interesting perspectives for students in Leiden and The Hague, and for teachers and other researchers who are testing the boundaries of their abilities and knowledge. In the Academy of Creative and Performing Arts, art and academics come together. Art education is mainly taught in The Hague at the KABK and KC, and academic education mostly at Leiden University. For the practice course in the arts admission requirements apply. These requirements apply to all performing and creative subjects (vocal, instrumental, visual). More information about registration, admission and registration at Leiden University, the Royal Conservatoire and the Royal Academy of Art, can be found online at: www.leidenuniv.nl. Leiden University has more than 16,000 students and employs more than 1,500 assistant professors and academic staff. The programmes at Leiden University are grouped into five faculties: Archaeology, Humanities, Medicine, Law, Social Sciences, and Science. The Academy of Creative and Performing Arts publishes the curriculum and other activities on its website. Both the guide with the curriculum, information about lectures and seminars, and a prospectus with the programme of the Master Photographic Studies are available in writing. Please refer to the website of www.hum.leidenuniv.nl under ‘Education’. p.194 The Academy Creative and Performing Arts offers the following possibilities: // e lectives at the Royal Conservatoire (KC) and Royal Academy of Art Art (KABK); // m inors at the Royal Conservatory; // P hD in the arts. 6. General study information 6.1 Educational Structure The purpose of studying at the Royal Academy of Art (KABK) is to prepare students for the profession of artist or designer. The educational programmes have been designed to make this feasible. The educational structure consists of the propaedeutic year and the main phase, which is divided into the main study phase and the final phase. 6.1.1 Competences & Domains Competences, or abilities, indicate the coherent set of knowledge, skills, attitudes and other personal qualities of an individual that enable him to adequately and successfully carry out tasks, and find and apply solutions in a specific work situation. A student is competent, or is suitable for a particular job or assignment, when he is able to effectively integrate the appropriate knowledge, skills, and attitude in successful behaviour in specific situations. In other words, the student should not only know how and why something must happen, he must also show he is able do it. Competence-based art education is characterised by an integral The following competences are addressed in the programmes: // C reative ability // C apacity for critical reflection // C apacity for growth and innovation // O rganisational ability // C ommunicative ability // E xternal awareness // C apacity for collaboration Creative ability, capacity for critical reflection and capacity for growth and innovation are the key competences for art education. Situational awareness is equally relevant. It stresses the importance of current developments in professional practice. The capacity for critical reflection and situational awareness have a strong interrelationship. The difference is the respective internal and external perspective. Organisational, communicative and collaborative competence are the remaining competences. Domains The competences can be divided into three areas (domains). These domains overlap. The division focuses more on a difference in emphasis within the domains than on creating a sharp demarcation. p.197 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Over the past couple of years, the KABK has slowly incorporated competence-based education. The offered programmes can be seen as a foreshadowing of professional practice. We pay close attention to career orientation and preparation. Important to these aspects is the expectation of an increasing degree of selfstudy from the student. This is very explicit in the case of the Individual Study Trajectory. Additionally, students are acquainted with a wide range of different teaching formats. A very important part of career preparation is the internship. approach to knowledge, skills and attitude. It is an educational form with a high degree of self-study that is aimed at the future careers of the students. The emphasis on the students’ personal (talent) development results in flexible education with a variety of study trajectories. In the programmes, the professional field is always represented by teachers who work as an artist or designer in addition to their teaching practice. Advisors and guest lecturers from different disciplines are frequently invited. Artistic technical domain Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide In the artistic technical domain, students specifically develop their creative ability and the capacity for critical reflection. These abilities or competences are considered most typical and important for the graduating student in visual art education. All art and design courses develop the students’ abilities in this area. Furthermore, this field includes the capacity for growth and innovation, which means that the student’s artistic or design practice (the personal interpretation of the professional situation) can be further developed and deepened. Theoretical domain The making of art and design is intellectual work. Art and design are judged on the basis of artistic objectives for their relevance to (inter)national standards of professional practice. This means that knowledge of the theory of the profession is a necessary component of the skill-set of the artist or designer. This theory covers several areas: historical and contemporary art history, art theory and art history related to the discipline. The socialisation of the art and design process also requires knowledge of disciplines such as philosophy, media history and communication science. We distinguish art theory in this. Art theory, in this sense, includes art history, philosophy, art observation and artists’ theories, as well as special workshops and lectures guided by art theory teachers. Also, the practice teachers contribute by basing their insights on theoretical arguments. In the theory courses of the different domains and disciplines, the history, background and departure points of the disciplines are further discussed and analysed. Professional social domain This field involves almost all competences: capacity for critical reflection, capacity for growth and innova- p.198 tion, organisational, communicative and collaborative competence, and also situational awareness. Art and design have always had a strong foothold in society, and are created as a result of interaction with the social developments in almost every area. In almost all study components students will therefore be faced with examples of how things work in the practice of an artist or designer. Part of the career preparation is the business element. This includes skills like presenting work, dealing with budgets, interacting with clients and so on. In the descriptions of the various disciplines, the heading ‘professional/social domain’ focuses on the business side of professional practice preparation. We want to ensure that students are able to appropriately function as an artist or designer after, or sometimes even during, their education; whether independently, as part of a partnership such as an artists’ initiative, or working at a design bureau or a combination thereof. 6.1.2 Teaching formats During their study at the KABK, students are confronted with different teaching formats. Theory education Theory education takes place in various ways: / / l ectures; / / s eminars; / / w ork discussions; // s upervision of papers and the final thesis. The seminars include discussions, analyses and debates at the hand of contemporary and historical visual material, exhibitions and texts, presentations on theoretical subjects and personal statements. Practice education Practice classes are designed in different ways: // S upervision and instruction for the entire group, usually during the first weeks of a course. // C ollective work discussions and progress meetings of teacher(s) and students. / / W orkshop-based supervision: students work independently and with assistance in a workshop, under the supervision of workshop managers. // W ork discussions: the teacher discusses work of individual students often in a group setting, so that the students can learn from each other. / / Digital supervision: especially in Graphic Design and Interactive/Media/Design students can be supervised online when face-to-face contact is not crucial. Internship and other participation in the professional field Students intern at a company, institution or with an independent artist, designer or photographer. In Fine Arts and ArtScience less internships are available, so instead students take part in external productions and projects. In addition to, and integrated with, the curriculum, a number of activities are organised each year. The organisation of these special activities, such as workshops, projects, excursions and project weeks, is predominantly the responsibility of the different departments. The activities are therefore often discipline-related. For first year students an academy-wide Propaedeutic Year Project Week is organised. Project weeks and excursions sometimes have a very specific purpose, such as a visit to a fashion trade fair, and sometimes a much broader character, such as a visit to Berlin or the Venice Biennale. In the latter case, students from a not-organising department can often participate as well. The travel and accommodation costs associated with the excursions and project weeks are covered by the participants. A contribution from the School Fund is possible and is always made collectively. Students may submit proposals for an excursion, project week or workshop to the head of the department. Special activities are also organised by ‘t Hart and Studium Generale. Activities ‘t Hart ‘T Hart organises lectures, film and video screenings and discussions in the KABK. ‘T Hart also provides discounts on special theatre and opera performances. Information can be found, among others, at the stand of ‘t Hart in the hall of the academy. ‘T Hart organises many activities in collaboration with students. If you are interested in this, please contact Christie van der Haak: hart@kabk.nl. p.199 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // S tudio-based supervision: the teacher visits the student at his workplace or studio and discusses the work on location. This can occur in an individual and in a group setting. Many senior students of the Fine Arts department have their own workplace in the academy. Students of the Textiles & Fashion and Interior Architecture departments work in shared studio spaces. Special activities: visiting exhibitions, project weeks, excursions and workshops Studium Generale Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide The activities of the Studium Generale (SG) are designed to broaden students’ knowledge and keep them up to date with cultural and social developments. During the Studium Generale activities, all students of the KABK are invited to look beyond the boundaries of their discipline: to question the current events taking place in the world around them, and to be confronted with ideas from other disciplines. By doing so they develop a critical way of looking at their own discipline, and they engage in conversation with other students. The exact content of the SG programme for 2013-2014 will be published on the website. For more information about the programme and participation please visit: www.studiumgeneralekabk.nl Self-study Students work independently on their art or design work for a large part of the programme. This can take place in the academy and at home. 6.1.3 Individual Study Trajectory In the academic year 2004-2005, the KABK established the Individual Study Trajectory (IST) in the main phase of the programme. The IST is focused on the discovery and development of the student’s fascinations and preferences, and his personal artistic attitude. It is important that the student discovers what his personal possibilities and ambitions are. Competence-based education requires that students learn to set their own learning objectives (self-study). The IST-plan is an excellent opportunity for students to customise their studies. The Individual Study Trajectory can include the following: // t aking one or more electives or introductory courses at the KABK; p.200 // t aking one or more elective courses outside of the KABK; // p articipation in external projects; // u ndertaking practice-based or theoretical research; // e nrolling in a minor at the Academy of Creative and Performing Arts; // e ngaging in various organisational activities for the KABK. General proceedings Each student makes a IST-plan at the hand of the IST-form. The plan describes the proposed activities, motivation and learning objectives. The IST-plan should be discussed with the coach. In the conversation with the coach the IST-plan is evaluated on the basis of whether it can indeed function as a broadening and/or deepening of the study programme. If the plan is approved, it can be started. After the activity or activities, a formal, external evaluation is carried out (in case of, for example, the minors and electives). In addition, the student is asked to assess the learning results and proceedings. The coach provides a final assessment. Practical information Wednesdays are exempt from compulsory study components for full-time students from the second year and above. The Wednesdays are intended for individual scheduling to deepen and specialise the curriculum. To this aim, the introductory courses and electives are scheduled in on Wednesdays. Part-time students are also given space in their schedules for the IST. IST and the internship The credits reserved for the IST in the internship semester can be used for the internship or for the continuation of a minor. IST credits (EC) The Individual Study Trajectory does not start until after the propaedeutic year. 12 EC are allocated to the IST per year. In total, this amounts to 36 EC in three years full-time programme and part-time programme (new style). Please refer to the appropriate discipline for the relevant credit overview. 6.1.4 Electives Internal Electives at the KABK Since several years, the KABK offers internal electives in the form of the Studium Generale and the Practicum Generale. The Practicum Generale consists of electives, workshops and introductory courses. Electives at Leiden University For main phase students of the Royal Academy of Art, the Royal Conservatory and students of Leiden University, it is possible to reciprocally follow electives at Leiden University, through the Academy of Creative and Performing Arts. Please note: A student who wishes to enrol in an elective at another institution must have the consent of the examination committee of the host institute and his own institute. // U p-to-date information can be found in the electronic study guide of Leiden University: www.studiegids.leidenuniv.nl. // F or more information on electives at the KABK contact: academiederkunsten@kabk.nl. // F or more information on electives at the Royal Conservatoire contact: T.Soekkha@admin.koncon.nl. // F or more information on electives at Leiden University contact the Student Affairs Desk: +31 (0)71 527 8011 Introductory courses The KABK offers a wide range of courses that offer students an introduction to a wide range of techniques. Introductory courses are open to students from all departments from the second year and above. With the approval of the coach, the introductory courses can be followed in the framework of the Individual Study Trajectory. Keep an eye on the KABK website for the up-to-date course offer: www.kabk.nl/introductory. p.201 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Credit allocation IST The work carried out in the framework of the Individual Study Trajectory may not always be part of the collective assessment. This is the case when it, for example, concerns a minor or elective at Leiden University. Students are then assessed externally. The coach provides a Credit Statement: a form that is available at the Student Administration. After the final evaluation and signing of the coach, the credits are added to the collective assessment form. The credits are allocated after the collective assessment. The courses take place on Wednesdays. The courses last seven weeks and have a size of 2 to 3 EC. Application and admission for electives in Leiden Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide A: Electives at the Academy of Creative and Performing Arts The Academy of Creative and Performing Arts has developed a number of electives taught in Leiden for students from Leiden and The Hague, such as in Capita Selecta in Early Music, History and Theory of Printmaking, Music Theory, History of Western Music, World Music, Performing Arts, Multiform Typography, Philosophy of Music etc. Students can sign up for these electives at the secretariat of Leiden University, email: secretariaat@ kunsten.leidenuniv.nl B: Electives at other faculties of Leiden University Students of the Royal Conservatoire and the Royal Academy of Art in The Hague can follow electives at Leiden University. An overview of the electives that explicitly focus on visual arts, music and dance, and information on the management and policy can be found on the website: www. studiegids.leidenuniv.nl. To participate in an elective, students must be in possession of a vwo diploma or should have successfully completed the hbo propaedeutic year. Students who are enrolled in the Conservatoire’s or KABK’s Preparatory year, cannot follow electives at Leiden University. To apply for an elective (a + b) students follow the following steps: // Register at the education secretariat (onderwijssecretariaat) of the department that offers the elective. // Apply for a guest student card at the Student Information Centre Plexus, Keizerstraat 25, Leiden, phone number: 071 527 80 11, email: informatiecentrum@ics.leidenuniv.nl. p.202 To sign up for an elective at Leiden University the student must submit the following: / / Registration form (available from the secretariat of the Academy of Creative and Performing Arts); / / Permission, in writing, from the student’s department at the KABK or Royal Conservatoire (available through the department coordinator), stating the students is allowed to take this elective and a similar statement from the department of Leiden University where the student wants to follow the elective, stating that the department does not object to the student studying there; / / Proof of payment of the University of the Arts tuition fee, to be obtained from the student administration at the KABK or Royal Conservatoire. If all conditions are met, the student can send the forms and the statement to the Student Administration of Leiden University (PO Box 9500, 2300 RA Leiden, visiting address: Student Information Centre Plexus, Keizerstraat 25, Leiden, phone number: 071 527 80 11). After registration the student receives a guest student card. With this card students can use the facilities offered by the university, such as the University Library and Blackboard, the digital learning environment of the university. Electives at the Royal Academy of Art Students from Leiden University who want to follow an elective at the Royal Academy of Art (KABK) need to register in all cases with Dave Willé, coordinator of the Academy of Creative and Performing Arts at the KABK, email: academiederkunsten@kabk.nl 6.1.5 Minor Programmes Students need some experience to participate in the electives. Admission is based on the successful completion of an admission assignment. When the student has officially applied by sending in the application form and has handed in the permission statement, he can apply for a facility card. In addition, students must officially register as a guest student of the Conservatoire. No additional costs have to be paid to follow practical and theoretical electives at the Royal Conservatoire. In consultation with the head of the relevant department it is determined how the student can best join a theoretical elective. Practicum Musicae (individual instrumental/vocal elective): The student should perform at a musical level that corresponds to the basic level of a student enrolled in the Preparatory Course of the Royal Conservatoire. Furthermore, the student should have the ability to develop in such a way during the first year of the Practicum Musicae (PM1), that he reaches the same level at the end of the elective year as that of a student enrolled in a Bachelor’s programme at the Royal Conservatoire. Before a student is admitted to the PM1 he has to audition, during which he is assessed according to the above. A small committee of teachers determines whether the student will be accepted into this course. Minor Entrepreneurship in the Arts The minor is offered in collaboration with the Centre for Business Studies at the Leiden University. Every second year student of the Royal Conservatoire or Royal Academy of Art in possession of a propaedeutic diploma can start the minor Entrepreneurship in the Arts in September. The minor is also intended for students who want to start their own business as an independent artist, designer or musician. Modules of the Minor Entrepreneurship in the Arts as elective The minor consists of a number of modules. The Entrepreneurship in the Arts is intended for students aspiring careers in the cultural sector, where matters such as organisation, leadership, coordination and programming play an important role. The minor is also useful for students who want to present themselves as an independent artist, designer or musician, or who want to set up their own business. The minor teaches students how to effectively and relevantly achieve artistic ambitions. The programme prepares students for the life after graduation. They learn all about networking, investing, the ins and outs of the Dutch cultural world, marketing, project management and the maintaining of a financial administration. This will increase their chances on the labour market. Commitment and motivation are required, also because self-study is a large part of the minor. p.203 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Electives at the Royal Conservatory Students from Leiden University who want to follow both a practical and a theoretical elective at the Royal Conservatoire need to register in all cases with the coordinator of the Academy of Creative and Performing Arts at the Royal Conservatoire, email: T.Soekkha@admin.koncon.nl. The minors available in the academic year 2013-2014, which are offered in particular for students from Leiden University, can be found on: www.studiegids.leidenuniv.nl. More information can be found on the website: www.bedrijfswetenschappen. leidenuniv.nl under Education. For problems with registration you can email Tim Soekkha: t.soekkha@hum.leidenuniv.nl. arship. For more information on the KABK’s European partners, the application process, the application form and the scholarship amount can be found on www.kabk.nl or at the International Office of the KABK. Deadline for application: check the website of the institutions. 6.1.6 Internationalisation The KABK strives for an international learning environment for its students. Firstly, by creating an international climate in the building, and secondly by the encouraging temporary trajectories abroad in the shape of: Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // study; // internships; // post-graduate programme. The advantage of a temporary trajectory abroad is the contact with different cultural and living environments and teaching methods. In addition, students learn to function in an international context, which will benefit their future careers. Through different mobility programs, the European Union (EU), Dutch government and several foundations offer many scholarships every year for students to follow a part of their programme, internship or research abroad. In most cases, the stay abroad takes place in the third year of the programme. The length of stay varies from three months to a full academic year. The Erasmus exchange has a maximum of six months. Temporary study abroad A well worked out study plan is the basis for applying to study abroad. The student can obtain advice and information about academies abroad from the internationalisation office and the head teacher. The head of department makes the final decision concerning the study period abroad. When the study abroad takes in Europe, the student is eligible for the Lifelong Learning Erasmus schol- p.204 Inside and outside Europe we have established relationships with art schools in: // Tirana, Albania // Jerusalem, Israel // T okyo, Japan // B eijing, China // M inneapolis, United States // B angalore, India // N ew Delhi, India // S eoul, South Korea On the KABK website the most current list of partner institutions can be found. Cumulus The KABK is a member of the international network of leading art schools ‘Cumulus International Association of Universities and Colleges of Art, Design and Media’. This membership gives students the opportunity to temporarily study at one of the member schools. This has significantly expanded the international offer for KABK students. An overview of associated art schools can be found at www.cumulusassociation.org. Internship Also read the general information on internships (chapter 6.1.9)! Internships can take place both in and outside Europe. For questions about internship position students are referred to their own department. The KABK offers scholarships for internships abroad, also through the Lifelong Learning Erasmus Programme of the EU. More information on the criteria, the application process and the scholarship amount can be found on www.kabk. nl or at International Office of the KABK. 6.1.7 After graduation Students can make use of the following websites in their search: // www.cumulusassociation.org International Association of Universities and Colleges of Art, Design and Media; // www.elia-artschools.org/members index European League of Institutes of the Arts; / / www.aicad.org Association of Independent Colleges of Art and Design (US); / / www.penrose-press.com/idd/edu International Directory of Design. Studying at a post-graduate institute abroad is a costly affair. It is not unusual that a student needs on average € 30,000 for one academic year for the tuition fee, travel and accommodation costs. Students can apply at several funds for a scholarship. It is possible to apply simultaneously at different funds. Possible funds are: // V SB Fund scholarship programme www.vsbfonds.nl/beurzen; // C ulturele Verdragen www.nuffic.nl/cultureleverdragen; // F ulbright scholarship programme (for US) www.fulbright.nl; // I nstitute for International Education (for US) www.fundingusstudy.org; // P rins Bernhard Culture Fund www.cultuurfonds.nl; // F onds voor Beeldende Kunsten (BKVB) www.fondsbkvb.nl. Look for more funds on www.beursopener.nl. Important tips for when applying for a scholarship: // M ake sure the application looks presentable and does not contain language mistakes; // G ive arguments for your plans in a well-written letter of motivation; // S tate in the application if you have already been admitted to the institution of choice. p.205 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Post-graduate programme When students want to continue their studies abroad after graduation, there are several high-quality post-graduate programmes available. Timely preparation is necessary, however. Most admission procedures of foreign post-graduate programmes start in January. This means students should start their orientation on the offer at the beginning of the exam year. Funds and scholarships Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide VSB Fund Scholarship Students qualify for a VSB Fund Scholarship when they graduate between 1 March 2013 and 31 December 2014 from their Bachelor’s programme and want to study abroad after graduation for an additional programme or research. The additional programme should last a minimum of three and a maximum of 24 consecutive months and should be completed within that period. The grant can amount to a maximum of € 10,000. The scholarship is not intended for internships and the applicant cannot be older than 29 years at the start of the programme. The application form is available on the website of the VSB Fund. All applications can be handed in, with original documents, at the International Office of the KABK. The first written and oral selection is performed by an internal selection committee of the University of the Arts in The Hague. The selection committee proposes a, by the VSB Fund predetermined, number of candidates to the Executive Board of the University. More information on criteria and procedures can be obtained from the International Office or the website: www.vsbfonds.nl/beurzen. 6.1.8 Career orientation and preparation In the course of study, the student increasingly approaches the level of a starting professional, which contributes to the further professionalisation of his own work in the chosen profession or occupation. The educational programmes of the academy can be seen as a foreshadowing of the future professional practice: students encounter it in different forms throughout their years of study and master its different components. This begins with an introduction to professional practice in the courses, which are taught by artists and designers that almost all have their own professional careers. The link p.206 with the professional field is more explicitly made by participation in internal projects, presenting work in internal and external exhibitions and attending lectures and workshops. Externally, the link is made during visits to exhibitions and (participation in) manifestations. During the course of study, students gain knowledge and experience at the hand of career orientation and later on at the hand of career preparation. The ability of the student to function independently becomes increasingly important. In the main phase, we offer the course Writing a Business Plan. Career orientation/field orientation during the Propaedeutic year Especially in the first year it is of importance to the student and to the academy that career orientation takes place. Both the KABK and the student must be able to determine whether the student has enrolled in the right programme. Students visit exhibitions, a designer or artist in groups or independently and report on the visits. This can also serve as a training of written expression skills and the student might reflect on it further in an oral presentation. This type of career orientation is part of the study programme of each department. Career Preparation in the main phase Main phase students are becoming increasingly independent, and have more technical and artistic skills and more conceptual and theoretical knowledge. Students want to be an artist or designer and their professional career draws near. Participation in workshops and projects or productions is a method to intensify the career preparation. Each department employs methods that are best suited to the discipline. Some methods to prepare the student for the profession and to teach him how to present as a designer or artist are: / / case study: the practice education includes a series of fictitious assignments (sometimes simulations) that teach the student to deal with an authentic practice problem (case) reflecting real assignments; / / (learning) to document own work in a (digital) portfolio; // d igital recording of project, production and workshop reports; // d escribing the work that is presented at the collective assessment and giving an oral explanation of the work. 6.1.9 Internship The internship is part of the career preparation for the profession of artist or designer. During the internship, the student experiences working conditions, methods, techniques and limitations of his future professional field. It is an important part of the career preparation. The KABK attaches much value to the internship. A strong relationship with the professional field is considered as an essential part of the programme. As of yet, the internship is not compulsory for part-time students. For full-time students of the Fine Arts and ArtScience departments it is difficult to arrange an internship, so they work on The ability of the student to function as an aspiring artist or designer during his internship is an important addition to the programme. The defining of learning objectives prior to the internship and the assessing of whether they were achieved at the end by student, client and teachers, creates the possibility to arrive at an assessment of what the student has achieved so far. By working in the professional field the student also gets the opportunity to gain important contacts. An internship does not qualify as an internship unless supervision is available on location. When a student participates in a project instead, the KABK arranges regular supervision. The KABK guarantees the effective contribution of the internship to the programme at the hand of internship guidelines for the interim and final evaluation. Guidelines have also been created for the communication with the internship company. Every department has an internship coordinator who is often also the internship supervisor. For information and tips, students can consult numerous websites. On the KABK website students can find an overview of a number of useful sites. Internship objectives The internship must offer the student the opportunity to demonstrate insight in situations that are typical of the future profession, and on the basis of that, students should act appropriately. Students formulate their own learning objectives for the internship. The internship has as aim to prepare the student for his later career, and therefore the student must, during the internship: // f amiliarise himself with the profession and his future career; p.207 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Career preparation in the final exam trajectory/final phase Already early on in the programme, but explicitly in the final phase, the student shows that he can work independently as a professional. His supervision will therefore take place from that perspective. The final thesis and end exam work are two elements in which the student can make an artistic statement. In the fourth year, the full-time students Interior Architecture and Furniture Design, and Textile & Fashion work at their internships. (external) projects. // a cquire the professional skills and professional attitude of a starting professional (designer/ artist); // T he department can organise a collective internship meeting halfway through the internship period. // l earn to participate in the working/business world; // T he coordinator always visits new internship companies when the student is present. With already known internship companies, contact is kept by telephone, if so desired. // l earn to integrate theory and practice; // d iscover his own qualities and learning objectives; // e xplore a possible specialisation; Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // n etwork: establish contacts to make the transition to the professional field as small as possible; // o btain an understanding of, and gaining experience in, the field under professional conditions; // g ain experience in professional manufacturing methods and techniques; // w here applicable: learn to work in teams and learn to work with clients, production deadlines and, where applicable, carry out acquisitions, make quotations and manage budgets. Internship supervision // T he department coordinator accompanies the internship. During the internship contact is kept with the internship company according to pre-defined arrangements. // T he internship company has a contact person, with whom the internship supervisor has, if necessary, talks throughout the internship, but at least a final conversation. // I f the internship takes place abroad, contact will mostly be kept by email or telephone. // T he KABK supervisor contacts the internship company and the student at least once during the internship. // I f the internship company and/or the student encounter problems, please contact the coordinator. // T he coordinator must handle the internship contract. Organisation of the internship The internship brochure contains detailed information about the internship procedure. The brochure is also contains an internship contract and the interim and final evaluation forms. The departure points of the internship policy and contract in English are also included. The interim and final evaluation forms are available in Dutch and English and can be obtained from the Student Administration. The internship lasts at least half a semester and has a maximum of one semester. During the actual internship period sufficient time is devoted to an (oral or written) interim report. Participation in the mid-internship return days, timesheet, activities overview signed by the student and internship company, and the internship report are inextricably linked to the internship. No separate credits will be allocated for writing the report. The following steps should be taken (refer to the internship brochure for more information): // c reate an internship work plan; // f ind an internship or internship replacement place; / / a pply; // p repare an internship contract; p.208 // w rite an interim report; // w here applicable: participation in a return day; // r eceive a mid-term review of the external internship supervisor; // r eceive a final assessment from the internship company; // w rite the final report; // w here applicable: create a visual presentation about the internship period. Starting conditions Before students can start the internship, the internship plan must be approved and prior study components must be completed. In exceptional cases, the head of department can authorize an internship before completion of the prior programme. It is necessary to make the necessary preparations in the period prior to the internship by, for example, attending the internship return days that take place half way through each internship period. Students are also advised to make use of the internship brochure. Internship replacement activities It is more difficult to find an internship position for students of the Fine Arts and ArtScience departments than for design students. Occasionally, a single student might work in the studio or on a project of an artist, but these positions are very limited. A non-continuous period, for example in the form of one or two days per week, offers a solution in those cases. Institutions such as Stroom Den Haag, the GEM, Museum of Contemporary Art, the Gemeentemuseum and artists’ initiatives provide a proper context for doing research on more general issues, such as how the Students of the interfaculty ArtScience work on productions and projects such as the Sonic-Art Festival. Within this department education, research and production are preferably seen as a whole. The head of department appoints a supervisor for the internship replacement activity. The rules regarding credit allocation and the conclusion of an internship are the same as formulated for regular internships. The writing of a report on the replacement activity is compulsory. 6.2 Assessing in art education Assessing During their study at the KABK, students are assessed in a specific, extensive and very thorough manner. In art education we use methods that differ from those used in other forms of higher education, where students are usually assessed on the basis of exams. At the KABK, this specific way of assessing can already be observed during the admission: the applicant’s former education is not the only decisive factor, because his or her creative abilities, motivation, ambition and the potential for talent development are equally important in making the decision to accept the student to the KABK. The individual development of the student puts special demands on the method of assessment. The assessment has primarily a didactic purpose: it should provide the student with insight on how his development as an artist or designer is advancing. The assessment does not only concern the form of the work, but also the strength of the concept, the way p.209 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide For situations where internships are difficult to obtain, such as Fine Arts, the internship is replaced with other activities (see the section Internship Replacement Activities below). process of making art available to the public works in the professional field. Fine Art students participate in, for example, external projects or the organisation of exhibitions. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide the result has been achieved, the process, and the student’s theoretical knowledge. This analysis of the work or design is made during the individual and collective assessments. The conclusions form the basis for a discussion with the student. The coordinator or head of department leads the conversation, to be able to clarify the specific issues at hand. Information on the different assessments, the composition of the different assessment committees and their authoritative reach, are set out in the Education and Examination Regulations (chapter 7). It is particularly important for first year students to read the rules on the propaedeutic assessment. In Fine Arts, the individual and collective assessments are combined in one assessment. Individual assessment In the design departments, the teacher individually assesses students after completion of a study component. At the end of each semester, an integral assessment of each student takes place; the so-called collective assessment. In the individual assessment attention is given to the requirements of processes, products and competences related to the work or assignment. feedback from the teachers of the various study components. See also the section ‘Credit Allocation’. The competences of the visual communication/product/spatial designer and the competences of the visual artist are described in their original form in the Educational Profiles of the OBK. The competences are described per academic year in the descriptions of the curriculum per department. Registration and archiving // T he head of department signs in the name of the assessment committee for all collective assessments. // A ll students receive a form signed by the head of department, in which the result of the collective assessment is stated. // A copy of the form is kept in the student’s file at the student administration. 6.2.1 Credits, EC Collective assessment The collective assessment assesses the integral development of the student, the processes, products and skills. In addition to the evaluative purpose of the assessment, it also has a didactic objective: the student receives feedback on his attitude, the work and the way the work or assignment was approached, the strength of the concept and his theoretical knowledge. As a result of the introduction of the Bachelor-Master structure (BAMA) in higher education in 2002-2003, European Credits (abbreviated EC, both plural and singular) are used. The system’s full name is: European Credit Transfer and Accumulation System. The purpose of the system is to create a singular unified higher-education system in all European countries. By applying the same system in all participating countries, now already more than forty, it has become much easier to compare programmes and diplomas. This very much benefits the possibility of exchange. The starting point for the collective assessment is the presentation of the student’s work, and its developments in comparison with previous assessments, taking into account the European credits are a unit of measurement to calculate study load. The study load includes all the activities a student undertakes in the framework of one specific p.210 Credit allocation The study load of the various components is expressed in ECs. The individual assessments are followed by the collective assessment. Students only receive their credits after the collective assessment. Only then the team of lecturers (the collective: hence, the collective assessment) assess the student’s integral development and the results of all study components together. This applies to both the full-time and part-time programmes. All study components of one semester have a combined study load of 30 EC (full-time and new-style part-time). Five credits of this semester total are reserved for the collective assessment. These credits are only allocated after a positive collective assessment, when the teachers are able to judge the student’s work in its totality. The reason for this is, that there is an assessment of the student’s integral development. If any components still have to be completed, the credits for the collective assessment are also withheld until the student finishes. In the old-style part-time programmes, the construction is the same, except that four credits are allocated per semester in the first years. The credits for the collective assessments are officially allocated when all components of the semester have been duly completed. Please note: Due to the different structure of the study programme of the ArtScience department, the allocation of credits takes place after the collective assessment that is linked to the final presentations per semester. Credit allocation international exchange KABK students who go on exchange receive their credits according to the system of the host institution. These days, many countries have the EC system. If not, it is determined how the credits can be converted. The study load of the exchange programme is determined by the policy officer internationalisation, in cooperation with the head of department, prior to the exchange. International exchange students studying at the KABK fall under the protocol of the academy. An individual arrangement is made in case the credit systems differ. Credit allocation ‘guest students’ Students from other institutions such as Leiden University, who want to follow classes at the KABK, need approval from their own institution and from the academy. After a positive assessment they receive a statement that specifies the study load of the followed programme in EC. Credit allocation internship Prior to the internship students create an internship plan. Interim and final evaluations are part of p.211 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide study component, which does not only include the contact hours and classes, but also the independent study hours. A study year consists of 42 weeks of 40 hours, so 1680 hours in total. One EC equals a study load of 28 hours. There are 60 EC a year in a full-time programme: 60 x 28 hours = 1680 hours. A bachelor’s programme covers four years of 60 EC each. Students must obtain sufficient EC to continue the programme and must receive all of the programme’s 240 EC to obtain a bachelor’s degree. The study load of the old-style part-time programmes is different because they concern a five-year programme. The total number of EC is to be acquired here is also 240. In the old-style part-time programmes, the first three propaedeutic semesters each have a study load of 20 EC. Semesters four to eight of the main phase each have a study load of 24 EC. The final phase semesters (nine and ten) each have a study load of 30 EC. the internship, and the student is expected to make a presentation and write a report at the end of the internship. The credits are allocated when all conditions have been met. Please also read the brochure with extensive information on the internship. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Credit allocation Individual Study Trajectory Credits are reserved for the Individual Study Trajectory (IST). The work carried out in the framework of the IST may not always be part of the collective assessment, for example when it concerns a minor or elective in Leiden. Externals then assess the student. The coach signs the plan in advance and will issue a Credit Statement afterwards, if everything is in order. A form is available for this. Credits gained for activities in the IST are, like all other credits, only allocated after the collective assessment. Credit allocation minor KABK students who take a minor at Leiden University can, when the end result is positive, use maximum of 36 EC (full-time and new-style parttime) and 35 EC (old-style part-time) for their programme. This is the space that offered by the Individual Study Trajectory. If a minor has a larger study load than 36 EC, the additional credits earned are noted, but are not part of the compulsory programme. 6.2.2 Study and progress guidance The KABK distinguishes between guiding students in the content of their programme and artistic development, and supervising their study progress. The guidance of the student’s artistic development takes place continuously by the constant discussions between student and teachers on the work and work process. p.212 Mentors and coaches Mentors and coaches monitor the student’s study progress. Mentors guide students in the propaedeutic year, while coaches guide students in the higher years. The mentors meet with the student twice a year. At the end of the first semester, all first year full-time students receive provisional (interim) advice concerning their study progress. A final and binding decision follows at the end of the second semester. For parttime students old style this decision takes place after the second or third semester. The mentor is a teacher of the relevant discipline. The tasks of the mentor are focused on: // d iscussing the student’s study progress; // d iscussing the assessment of the first semester; // d iscussing the assessment of the second semester; // k eeping a concise record of the date and content of the conversations. Coaches are available for main phase students. The coach is a teacher of the relevant discipline. In some cases, the head of department takes the role of coach. The tasks of the coach are focused on: // d iscussing the student’s study progress; // p re-approving the IST plan; // a ssessing the IST plan after completion; // r ecording and archiving the students’ IST plans. Student counsellor The KABK has an independent student counsellor. The counsellor can supply more general information. He represents the individual interests of the students and has an agreement of confidentiality. The counsellor may also mediate or refer to agencies or individuals outside the academy. If necessary, only with approval of the student, third parties are contacted. The counsellor provides information on, and assists, if possible, with: // s tudy financing; // a ssistance in applying for funds and grants; // p roblems in study progress due to illness; // p ersonal problems; // h elp and advice with professional procedures; // a djustment difficulties, study motivation, study planning, performance anxiety, switching programmes; // c onflicts with teachers; // i nformation on de-registration; // i nformation on post-graduate programmes. The KABK student counsellor is Paul Deneer. It is possible to make an appointment with him by emailing: p.deneer@koncon.nl. He is also a confidential contact person. Pauline Spoon is also a confidential contact person. Her email address is: p.schep@kabk.nl. 6.3 Quality Assurance Quality assurance is the totality of measures with which an institute systematically defines, monitors and improves the quality of education in the broadest sense of the term. Objective The objective of the Bologna process is to create attractive and internationally competitive higher education, through mobility of students and teachers. To achieve this mobility, it is important that the higher education systems in Europe are transparent. The systems have therefore been organised into three cycles (bachelor, master and doctorate) throughout Europe. This way, the level of the academic degrees is clear. The following agreements have been made to enhance the compatibility of higher education systems and the mobility of students and teachers: // q uality assurance with standards and guidelines from ENQA (European Association for Quality Assurance in Higher Education) as a reference document; // reflection of the study load in 60 European Credits (abbreviated as EC) per full-time year; // P roviding a Diploma Supplement (DS) (since 2005). The DS contains information about the courses the student has completed; // a European qualification framework for higher education. This describes the final p.213 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // h ousing; Bologna process The Bologna Process is one of the most important changes the European higher education system has seen in the last few decades. In 1999, 29 European ministers signed the Bologna Declaration, in which they agreed to collimate their national higher education systems in a number of crucial points. Over the years, the number of participating countries has grown to 47. On the official website of Bologna information can be found in many languages: www.ond.vlaanderen.be/hogeronderwijs/ bologna/pcao. qualifications of bachelor, master and doctorate, at the hand of the five reference points, the ‘Dublin descriptors’. The Dublin descriptors for the KABK are outlined below; Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // a national qualification framework. ECTS ECTS is a European system for the exchange and accumulation of credit points: European Credit Transfer and Accumulation System. It includes the agreement that the learning objectives of the curriculum and the courses are clearly defined, to ensure the compatibility of the programmes. The ECTS also compares different grade systems, to ensure people from other countries know what it means to be awarded a six or an eight (and vice versa). 6.4 Accreditation Accreditation is the providing of a label that indicates that the educational programme meets the requirements set by the Minister of Education, Culture and Science. This is a condition for the recognition of diplomas, for the funding of the programmes and for grant applications. An external committee reviews and evaluates the programmes and reports to the NVAO, the accreditation body. The NVAO grants the ‘label’. A list of accredited programmes can be found on the website of the NVAO (www.nvao.net). Quality assurance is an important part of the accreditation. It implies the continuous examination of the performances of the education and organisation. This is done through interviews and evaluations (see below). If the outcome of to assessments is negative, improvements will be made. p.214 The KABK bachelor’s programmes were accredited per 1 January 2009 and are accredited again this academic year. Of the master’s programmes, Type & Media was accredited per 15 July 2008 will be re-accredited this year as well. Interior Architecture was accredited per 8 June 2010 and the master ArtScience per 2 May 2007. Final level of the bachelor’s programmes The bachelor’s, master’s and PhD levels are described on the basis of five benchmarks referred to as the ‘Dublin descriptors’. During the accreditation, it must be demonstrated that the programmes reach the minimum required level. The granting of the corresponding label guarantees that the programmes are of sufficient level, or even rise above it. The KABK has described the Dublin descriptors for its art education on the bachelor’s level as follows: Knowledge and insight The graduate of the KABK has his own artistic vision and insight into his own work process. He understands key concepts such as ‘artistic practice’, ‘design practice’, ‘meaning’, ‘uniqueness’, ‘authenticity’ and ‘innovation’. He is knowledgeable about the transfer of meaning through image and form. He is aware of general art history and the history of his discipline, and is aware of contemporary and international developments. He has knowledge of theories and ideas about art and artists or designers and design. He has insight into developments in the cultural, public and social context in relation to his own vision and work. Application of knowledge and insight The graduate can professionally create authentic work that protrudes from his own artistic vision, or develop an innovative concept and to develop this into a unique and meaningful design or image. He is able to solve artistic and design problems. He is capable of giving arguments for these solutions and his work, and present and explain them in an inspiring way, by using his knowledge and insight and his experience in the field or discipline. He can also employ them to create and maintain an inspirational and functional work environment. Communication The graduate can, in an inspired and substantiated manner, present and explain his work and the vision on which the work is based, to stakeholders, the public and potential clients, and negotiate with them if necessary. The graduate is able to provide an independent artistic contribution to a joint product, to which he adds content, quality and possibly direction. Learning Skills The graduate can deepen and broaden his artistic or design practice, his knowledge, methods, vision and abilities, or develop them differently, in a way that suits his personality and is related to his discipline. He has a passionate, curious and inquisitive attitude and is able to successfully participate in a post-graduate programme on a (international) level or by continuing his studies independently in, for example, an international centre of excellence. Degrees and Titles Graduates from the Dutch higher education receive a bachelor’s or a master’s degree. The professional 6.5 Quality assurance at the KABK Staff, students, alumni and professionals of the different departments are actively involved with the internal quality assurance of the KABK. Great importance is attached to a solid quality policy, both academy-wide and in the departments. The academy gauges the opinions on the programmes and their results. This happens internally with students and staff and externally with alumni, committee members, important people in the art and design worlds, internship companies and art institutions from the professional field. Quality assurance at the KABK consists of: // S atisfaction inquiries Students and staff are questioned via written or digital inquiries about their satisfaction with the educational programme in general, but also about specific parts of the programme. The surveys include questions on matters such as the level of the course, assessments and level of difficulty. The inquiries are developed in close collaboration with the ICLON department at Leiden University. This department also takes care of the automatic processing of the inquiries. p.215 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Forming opinions The graduate is able gather relevant knowledge and information in service of his work, and establish links between his own work and that of others through consideration, analysis, interpretation and evaluation. He does so by using his knowledge and understanding of relevant social, scientific or ethical issues. He is able to realise that the results of analyses, reflections and assessments benefit of the development of his work. colleges (hogescholen) provide both bachelor’s and master’s Degrees, with an English discipline or course related addition. At the academy it is possible to obtain a BFA (Bachelor of Fine Art) or a BDes (Bachelor of Design) or a master (ma). The word ‘master’ is then usually followed by the name of the discipline and specialisation: Master of Design in Type and Media, for example. The abbreviation for master’s degrees is, for example, MDes in Type and Media. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // Participation in national satisfaction inquiries The KABK regularly participates in national satisfaction inquiries to ensure its compatibility with other institutions for higher education in the arts. // S tudent panels/class representatives meetings Within each course, regular meetings (at least once a year) are scheduled between the head of department and the class representatives in the student representatives meeting. In addition, the class representatives hold a meeting at least once a year with the director of the KABK. // Course Committee The Course Comittee (in Dutch: Opleidingscommissie OC)) plays an important role in the developments in the programmes and in quality assurance, by giving advice (ask or unasked for) on all matters concerning education. The committee is also involved in finding the best way to gather information on education. The Course Committee consists of students and teachers. The meeting dates are found in the calendarium. // Departmental meetings Teachers and the head of each department regularly meet to discuss the goings on and the quality of the education. This information is then used to further develop the programmes. // S tudy days The director, heads of departments and other staff participate in a study day several times a year to discuss the current developments within the academy and develop new ideas. p.216 // E xternal assessors Renowned experts, artists and designers are involved yearly in the final examinations as external assessors. They are asked about their experiences and findings in relation to the department. This information is used in developing the programmes of the department. The assessors are also questioned about their findings in writing. // W ork field committees For each department, a work field committee has been instated to ensure the compatibility with the professional field. There is also an academy-wide work field committee. The work field committees consist of respected people from the professional field who advise the KABK and comment on the content of the programmes, the final objectives and the final level, the developments in the field and the consequential demands for the education and organisation. / / Internship companies The companies where students intern, are asked about their findings, both on the level of the student as on the their needs in the professional field. // R esearching among alumni All alumni who have finished their studies successfully, are asked about how they experienced their studies about three months after their graduation, ever since 2003. The first few years this was done by post, and since a few years, alumni can complete the questionnaire digitally. The response rate is high for this type of research: around forty percent. In the near future, another inquiry will also be held researching how alumni conquer a place in the world of art and/or design. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide / / In-depth interviews with alumni A select group of alumni from the Fine Arts department who graduated in 1986, 1993 and 2000 have been subjected to in-depth interviews to gain insight into how they have developed from a starting artist to a more experienced professional. This research was held in the scope of the research domain ‘Reflection processes in the arts’ by Michael van Hoogenhuyze. Former teaching staff has also been asked about their findings. The research domain published several books on this, including the book ‘Help, I’ve got talent’. // E xit-inquiries All students leaving the KABK without a diploma are also asked to complete a questionnaire. This is an additional source that can provide information useful for the development of the education. p.217 7. Education and Examination Regulations Education and Examination Regulations Royal Academy of Art The Hague 2013-2014 Academic Year The general description of the education provided at the Academy and the concise description of the curriculum for the programmes in this Study Guide are an integral part of the Education and Examination Regulations. The Education and Examination Regulations apply to all cohorts of students of the programmes and courses referred to and apply solely to the 2011-2012 academic year. If, on 1 September 2013, the 20132014 Education and Examination Regulations are not yet ready, by way of exception to the above, the 2012-2013 Education and Examination Regulations remain in force until the 2013-2014 Education and Examination Regulations have become effective. Article 1 Applicability of the regulations These regulations apply to the education and the examinations for the programmes and courses: Visual Arts, ArtScience, Photography, Graphic Design, Interior Architecture and Furniture Design, Textile and Fashion and Interactive/Media/ Design. The courses are provided by the Royal Academy of Art, a faculty of the University of the Arts, The Hague, further referred to using the Dutch abbreviation: KABK. The ArtScience course is provided by the ArtScience interfaculty. Relevant articles are also operative for the postgraduate course Industrial Design and the master programmes ArtScience including the variant Master Artistic Research, Master Interior Architecture and Type and Media. Article 2 Definitions Academy for Creative and Performing Arts A collaboration between the University of the Arts, The Hague and the University of Leiden. Recommendation A distinction is made between: // The propaedeutic recommendation: at the end of the propaedeutic or first year of a degree programme a recommendation is made on the continuation of the course of study. This may be a negative binding recommendation. A negative binding recommendation means that a student is not admitted to the main part of the course in question and that the enrolment of the student for that course is terminated in conformity with article 7.8.b of the Higher Education and Research Act. p.219 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Education and Examination Regulations This part of the Education and Examination Regulations sets forth the rules and provisions that apply to the education at the Royal Academy of Art as a whole in conformity with the Higher Education and Research Act (Hoger onderwijs en Wetenschappelijk onderzoek (WHW)) article 7.13.2 a to u inclusive, and has been approved by the Board of Governors of the University of the Arts, The Hague, formerly the School of Visual Arts, Music and Dance. These regulations came into force on 1 September 1998 and were in part modified by the Board of Governors (most recently in July 2011) for all programmes of study at the Royal Academy of Art. General Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // Interim propaedeutic recommendation: after the first semester in year 1 for full time students and after the second semester for part-time old style students a provisional recommendation is made that is not binding. // Green light recommendation: after the seventh semester for full time students and the ninth semester for part-time old style students a non-binding recommendation is made about participating in the final examination if all the preceding parts of the course have been succesfully completed and there is sufficient confidence in the student being able to pass the final examination’s format and content. This recommendation is binding if the preceding parts of the course have not been successfully completed. Main subject The Visual Arts and Design programmes include different main subject that provide a training for a specific profession. Bachelor The title can be obtained after a four-year higher professional education course or after a three-year university course. Every bachelor course normally takes four years at a Higher Professional Education Institution for which 60 EC credits per year are required. Assessment An assessment is a feasible and valid equivalent in higher art education for what is called an examination in the regulation higher education world (Higher Education and Research Act 7.10 paragraph 1). Assessment interview The equivalent in art education for that which is referred to in the p.220 Higher Education and Research Act article 7.3 paragraph 3 and article 7.10 paragraph 1, as tests and examinations. The assessment involves a review of the knowledge, the insight and skills of the examinee as well as the assessment of the outcome of the review. A distinction is made between : / / the propaedeutic assessment for fulltime and part-time new style students after the second semester, and part-time old style students after the third semester; / / the semester assessment; / / the final assessment; / / and, depending on the assessors: collective assessment and individual assessment, and if these coincide, integrated assessment. Assessment commitee For the purpose of preparing for and/ or implementing examinations and parts of examinations committees of examiners (or assessment committees) are set up as referred to in article 7.12c paragraph 1 of the Higher Education and Research Act. The examiners are responsible for setting and assessing tests and examinations. The assessment committee is a committee that is set up for the propaedeutic and main phase of the study and is responsible for the collective assessments. For each course the Academy has an assessment committee for the propaedeutic assessment, the assessments in the subject study phase and the final assessment. These assessment committees have different competences depending on their tasks. Articles 22, 23, 24 and 25 give details of the composition of the assessment committees. Block/Period Half a semester. There are a maximum of four blocks/periods per academic year. Coach A student counsellor for the main subject students, possibly also responsible for coaching of the Individual Study Track. Competence areas There are three areas or domains of competence: / / Artistic/subject-based domain; / / Professional/social domain; / / Theoretical domain. Board of Appeal for Examinations The Board of Appeal as referred to in the Higher Education and Research Act 7.60 can be reached through the Central Office of the University of the Arts. Board of Governors The Board of Governors of the University of the Arts, The Hague is the competent authority and is responsible for the education, organisation and management of the institution. EC/Credits A measure of the hours of study. A European Credit is equal to a study load of 28 hours (independent and taught). The study load for a Bachelor in a higher professional education programme is 240 credits of which 60 are to be obtained in the propaedeutic phase and 180 in the main phase. Final assessment/final examination The closing examination of a programme. The final examination takes place in the form of a final assessment. Exams A review of the knowledge, insights and skills of the examinee as well as the assessment of the outcomes of that review. Examination committee The management of the institution has set up an examination committee in accordance with article 7.12 of the Higher Education and Research Act for the purpose of setting, organising and coordinating examinations, tests and assessments for each of the courses or groups of courses offered by the institution. Members of the examination committee are persons who provide teaching on the relevant course. The Examination Committee (Visual Arts and Design) is responsible for arrangements for examinations. The examination committee: // d raws up rules regarding the proper procedures during the tests and examinations; // a ppoints the examiners, including the chairman of a committee of examiners (article 7.12c); // m ay give guidelines and instructions to the examiners with regard to the assessment and determination of the outcome of the tests (article 7.12b, paragraph one, sub b); // a pplies rules of exception such as those for exemptions, and determines in a number of individual cases exemptions to the regulations (article 7.12b, paragraph one, sub d); p.221 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Competence Competence is the integral whole of knowledge, skills, attitudes and other personal qualities that individuals possess and which enables them to carry out tasks in an adequate way, to find solutions and put these into effect in practising their profession. ECTS European Credit Transfer and Accumulation System, European system for exchanging and accumulating credits. // i s authorised to take steps in the case of fraud by a student (article 7.12b, paragraph two); // A wards the certificate as soon as the student has taken the required tests (article 7.11). Committee of examiners See: Assessment Committee Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Examiner A member of the committee of examiners, as referred to in article 7.12c. Persons who provide teaching on the relevant course as well as experts from outside the programme may be designated as examiners. Extraneous Those who have solely been enrolled at the university to take part in the propaedeutic or the final examination or parts thereof. Faculty Organisational unit. The University of the Arts, The Hague comprises two faculties namely the Royal Conservatoire and the Royal Academy of Art. There is also the Interfaculty ArtScience and the Interfaculty School for Young Talent. The University of the Arts, The Hague The Royal Academy of Arts and the Royal Conservatoire merged on 1 January 1990 to become the School of Visual Arts, Music and Dance. Since 8 July 2010 the name has been the University of the Arts, The Hague. The daily running of the University is in the hands of the Board of Governors. Head Official in charge of an educational unit, a degree course, at the Academy. Main phase The component of the study that follows on from the propaedeutic or first year and is concluded with the p.222 final examination. The main phase comprises the subject study phase and the final study phase. Individual Study Track (IST) In the main phase, part of the workload is reserved for the students’ own, agreed assignment. At this stage students can give rein to their own imagination and ambitions. Individual study track credits acquired during the period of full time internships and/or the final examination can be integrated in the assessment of the internship or the final examination in a manner to be approved by the head or coordinator of the course. Interfaculty An Interfaculty is collaboration between the Royal Conservatoire and the Royal Academy of Arts. Interfaculties are ArtScience and the School for Young Talent. The ArtScience Interfaculty’s course ArtScience comes under the heading of the Visual Arts in the CROHO Central Register of Higher Education Study Programmes. The Royal Academy of Arts The Visual Arts and Design Faculty of the University of the Arts, The Hague. Royal Conservatoire The Music and Dance faculty of the University of the Arts, The Hague. Major-minor system A bachelor programme may comprise a major, the main programme and a minor, a coherent elective subject. As a rule the scope provided by the Individual Study Track is set aside for a minor. A student at the University of the Arts may be eligible to pursue a minor at the University of Leiden after completing the propaedeutic phase. By the reverse token a student at the University of Leiden may be admitted to a minor at one of the faculties of the University of the Arts. Master A one or two year follow-up (as a rule subsequent to the completion of a bachelor programme) at a higher professional education institute or university. Mentor The counsellor provides help to propaedeutic students with regard to progress with their studies. Education and Examination Regulations The Education and Examination Regulations are in two parts: one gives a general description of the teaching at the Academy and a concise description of the curriculum of the courses and the Interfaculty ArtScience. Part two includes the rules and provisions. Both these are included in the study guide. Programme A programme as referred in the Higher Education and Research Act 7.3 is a cohesive whole of educational units designed to achieve clearly defined objectives in the field of knowledge, insight and skills which the person completing the programme is required to possess. Each programme is concluded by an examination. The programmes at the Academy include several degree courses. Practical exercises Carrying out assignments or creating designs, carrying out research assignments, attending internships, taking part in excursions, taking Propaedeutic assessment/Propaedeutic exam The examination which concludes the propaedeutic phase. The examination takes the form of a propaedeutic assessment to determine whether a student meets the requirements set for the propaedeutic phase. Semester Each academic year has two semesters. A semester comprises blocks or periods. Semester assessment A formal assessment that takes place at the conclusion of each semester. This assessment is carried out by an assessment committee. Specialisation A cohesive whole of educational units within a course of study focussing on a specific domain within the visual arts and/or design. Student A person who is enrolled at the University of the Arts, The Hague full time or part-time to pursue a programme. Student dean Confidential advisor who, if need be, and as a supplement to the mentor, coach or class teacher gives advice to students and provides information to them regarding matters relating to their study. The student dean also helps students with personal problems of a material and immaterial kind or refers them elsewhere or acts as intermediary. Academic year The period that begins on 1 September and terminates on 31 August of the subsequent calendar year; an academic year has two semesters. p.223 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Participation Council The participation council as referred to in the Higher Education and Research Act 10.17. The council comprises elected representatives from different ranks of the institution: students, teaching staff for each faculty and general support and educational support staff. There is a central council and two faculty councils for the Academy and the Conservatoire. part in other necessary educational activities, geared to achieving the required skills. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Component of a study programme A component of a study programme is equivalent to what in the Higher Education and Research Act article 7.3 is referred to as a unit of study. It is part of the educational programme that is concluded with an assessment. Study load All activities as component of the study with or without guidance: practical exercises, excursions, internships, interviews, practical and theory lessons, lectures, workshops and independent study in and outside the buildings of the Academy. Study load is also referred to as study hours and is expressed in credits. Test A written or an oral review of the knowledge, the insights and the skills of the student as well as the assessment of the outcomes of that review. Admissions committee A committee set up by the institution’s management, represented by the faculty director, responsible for assessing the attitude and suitability of a candidate for a course (7.26a). Entrance review Review of the suitability of a potential student. Higher Education and Research Act (WHW) The Act on Higher Education and Research, Bulletin of Acts, Orders and Decrees 593, 1992; Implementing Decree 2008 Text as in force on 1 July 2011. WSF Act on Student Grants and Loans, Student Finance Act Article 3 Progammes Bachelor programmes The Bachelor programmes have a different propaedeutic phase for each subject. Students who pass their propaedeutic phase are entitled to go on to the main phase of their chosen subject. a. Fine Arts / / Visual Arts, full-time and part-time: in the main phase students taking this programme can opt for the specialisation Fine Arts, 3D, Graphic Art, and Painting. / / ArtScience, full-time, provided by the Interfaculty ArtScience. b. Detsign Profile Visual Communication / / Graphic Design, full-time and part-time; / / Photography, full-time and parttime; / / Interactive/Media/Design, fulltime. Profile Spatial Design Interior architecture and Furniture design, full-time and part-time: in the main phase students can opt for Furniture design. Profile Product Design Textile and Fashion, full-time. In the main phase students can opt to specialise in Fashion or Textiles. Masters and advanced programmes The Royal Academy of Art has four advanced programmes. // M aster in Design of Type & Media // M aster Interior Architecture // M aster track ArtScience and p.224 // M aster track Artistic Research as a variant of the Master track ArtScience The latter two are collaboration between the Royal Academy of Art and the Royal Conservatoire. The Post Graduate Course on Industrial Design is also offered. Programmes offered in collaboration with the University of Leiden are: // M aster (MaFPS) Photographic Studies / / Master (Msc) Mediatechnology. // a diploma awarded in the Netherlands or elsewhere which has not been referred to in a ministerial ruling but which the board of the institution deems to be equivalent to one of the diplomas referred to. Article 6 Supplementary requirements (Higher Education and Research Act 7.26a) To be enrolled in one of the programmes candidates in addition to the aforementioned previous training requirements must meet specific requirements set by the programme to be able to study successfully. Admission These requirements are: Article 5 Exemption from previous training requirements on the grounds of other diplomas (Higher Education and Research Act 7.28) Exemption from the required previous training (article 5) is given to those who hold: // a certificate for passing a propaedeutic or final examination from an institution of higher education; // a diploma awarded in the Netherlands or elsewhere that has been designated by a ministerial ruling that it is at least equivalent to one of the diplomas referred to; // d emonstrable creative and visual or design skills; this will be verified during the entrance review; // s ufficiently motivated choice for one of the degree course; this will be verified during the entrance review; // s ufficient command of the Dutch or the English language; during the period when the English language is used to communicate the candidate must gain sufficient command of the Dutch language. The ability to communicate adequately in Dutch or English is verified during the entrance review. The holder of a foreign diploma can only enrol: // a fter the requirement regarding sufficient command of Dutch or English has been met, and // a fter it has been demonstrated that the requirement of sufficient command of English at the level of the Dutch senior general secondary education has been met. p.225 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Article 4 Previous training (Higher Education and Research Act 7.24) All candidates in possession of a secondary school certificate (VWO pre-university, HAVO senior vocational education, MBO (four years) senior secondary vocational education) or an equivalent foreign qualification may enrol for one of the bachelor programmes at the Royal Academy of Art. In the case of a foreign diploma the Netherlands Organisation for International Cooperation in Higher Education may carry out a credential evaluation if there is any doubt. The costs of this are paid by the candidate. Deficiencies in the previous training in English need to be remedied before the programme begins by taking one of the following tests: // I nternational English Language Testing System (IELTS), academic module. The minimum required IELTS overall band score must be 6.0. // T est of English as a Foreign Language (TOEFL).The minimum required TOEFL score is: 83 (internet-based test). Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Article 7 Entrance review // t he entrance review takes place by an admissions committee set up by the institution’s board; Article 8 Exemption from previous training requirements on the grounds of the entrance review Students aged 21 years or older who do not meet the aforementioned previous training requirements or the criteria for exemption from these can be admitted if they comply with the requirements of the entrance review as referred to in article 6, and who by taking a test or examination authorised by the institution demonstrate that they have a comparable level of training as a person with a diploma from one of the previous training programmes referred to in article 4. The institution’s board may deviate from this age criterion in exceptional cases. // a student may be a member of the admissions committee; Article 9 Admission to the main phase Students who have passed their propaedeutic phase can continue their studies in the main phase of the same degree course. In consultation with the head of the degree course in question it is possible for students to continue their studies in another discipline at the Academy. // t he head or the coordinator is the chairman and secretary of the committee; Article 10 Conditions for admission to the main phase // t he committee comprises the head or the coordinator of the degree course and a number of members to be designated by the institution’s board; // t he entrance review takes place on the basis of the admission criteria set by the relevant degree course with regard to the supplementary requirements; // t he result of the entrance review is notified to the institution’s board in the form of a recommendation for admission; // t he institution’s board decides on the basis of the recommendation whether, and if need be, under what conditions an aspiring student is admitted to one of the degree courses of the Academy; // n o appeal is possible against a negative decision on admission by the institution’s board. p.226 // t he propaedeutic examination has been passed; // t he examination committee, on behalf of the institution’s board, can grant exemption from the requirement of a passed propaedeutic examination to the holder of a diploma awarded in the Netherlands or elsewhere if the diploma, in the opinion of the examination committee, is at least equivalent to the propaedeutic examination certificate; // t he student who has taken the propaedeutic part of a degree course, but has not yet passed the propaedeutic examination, can take part in the main phase of the programme if in the opinion of the propaedeutic examination committee the student is deemed to be capable of completing the parts which have not yet been passed in the first subsequent semester. a final phase: semesters 9 and 10. The curriculum of the main phase is described in the study guide and on the website. Duration and structure of the programme The parts of the study in the propaedeutic phase constitute a cohesive base for the main phase. The propaedeutic phase is arranged in such a way that students obtain insight into the content of the degree subject and the future profession with the possibility of referral and/or selection at the end of this phase. The curriculum of the propaedeutic phase is described in the study guide. Article 12 The main phase The main phase involves 180 EC credits and takes three years of study for the full-time and parttime course new style and three and a half years of study for the parttime course old style. The aim of the main phase is to prepare students for professional practice in the field of the visual arts and design. The main phase is subdivided into a subject phase and a final phase. The main phase full-time and part-time new style is subdivided into a subject phase: semesters 3, 4, 5, 6 and a final phase: semesters 7 and 8. The main phase of the part-time old style course comprises a subject phase: semesters 4, 5, 6, 7 and 8 and Article 13 General // 1 . Every semester comprises one or more study components. Each study component is concluded with an individual assessment; see also paragraph 5 of this article. // 2. The individual assessment, which is based on criteria, procedures and regulations established in advance, involves a review of the extent to which the student meets the set criteria and the determination of the assessment score of the review. The criteria are stipulated for each study component and each degree programme. The procedures and regulations of the individual assessment are described in article 17. // 3 . In cases arising, such as the Visual Arts, the individual assessment coincides with the collective assessment. // 4 . At the end of each semester the assessment committee makes an integrated assessment which is called the collective assessment. The assessment committee gives a pass if the requirements set beforehand have been met. // 5. In the collective assessment work done by the student in the preceding semester is assessed. The individual assessments are discussed and considered and ultimately brought together by a decisive collective and integrated judgement. // p.227 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Article 11 The propaedeutic phase (Higher Education and Research Act 7.8) Each degree programme at the Academy has its own propaedeutic phase which is geared to the main phase of that specific degree course including the accompanying specialisations. The propaedeutic phase counts for 60 EC and takes one year of study for the full-time and part-time course new style, and one and a half years of study for the part-time course old style and is concluded by the propaedeutic examination in the form of an assessment. Assessments Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // 6 . The collective assessment, based on criteria, procedures and regulations set beforehand, involves a review of the extent to which the student meets the criteria and the determination of the assessment score of the review. The criteria are defined for each degree course bearing in mind above all artistic ability, presentation and communication about the work and the capacity for critical reflection and growth and innovation. The procedures and rules of the assessment are given in article 17. // 7 . All assessments (individual, collective, practical exercises, theory subjects and any other forms of assessment) are scored as follows: a result of 6 or higher is a pass. Results below 6 are fails. Article 14 Assessment times and number of assessments A collective assessment takes place after every semester. The number of collective assessments in the propaedeutic phase: full-time and part-time new style: one semester assessment and one propaedeutic assessment, the propaedeutic exam; part-time old style: two semester assessments and one propaedeutic assessment, the propaedeutic exam; The number of collective assessments in the subject study phase: full-time and part-time new style: assessments at the end of semesters 3, 4, 5 and 6; part-time old style: assessments after the end of semesters 4, 5, 6, 7 and 8. The number of collective assessments in the final phase: full-time and p.228 part-time new style: an assessment at the end of semester 7, after which the green light assessment follows, and the final assessment; Part-time old style: an assessment at the end of semester 9 after which the green light assessment follows, and the final assessment. Article 15 Sequence of the assessments General: students must pass the collective assessment of a preceding semester before proceeding to the next part of the programme. Student may be given the opportunity to continue with their studies if it is plausible to assume that they will pass the next subsequent collective assessment. // 1 . Students must have passed the preceding assessments to take part in the assessments of semesters 3, 4, 5, 6 of the full-time course and the part-time course new style and semesters 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, of the part-time course old style. // 2 . Students must have passed all preceding assessments and have acquired the necessary 210 EC credits to be able to embark on the study components in semester 8 of the full-time course and the part-time course new style and semester 10 of the part-time course old style. // 3 . A non-binding recommendation is given on participation in the final examination, once students have passed all the preceding study components after semester 7 of the full-time and part-time course new style and semester 9 of the part-time course old style. The recommendation is binding if students have failed the preceding study components and they have not obtained the requisite 210 EC credits for the programme. Article 16 Individual assessment/Procedure // 1 . Each study component is concluded with an assessment. // 2 . The individual assessment takes place prior to the collective assessment. // 3 . Individual assessments take place as a rule one to two weeks before the collective assessments stipulated in the timetable unless these relate to study components which only took place during a shorter period in that semester. In the latter case the date and time of the individual assessment is notified to the student by the teacher. // 4 . When the occasion arises, as is the case with the Visual Arts, the individual assessment coincides with the collective assessment. Article 17 Collective assessment/ Rule // 1 . The Academy has an assessment committee for each degree course comprising the head and the accompanying teachers. // 2 . The collective assessment is carried out by the assessment committee. // 3 . The collective assessment relates to all the study components that belong to the semester to be assessed. The assessment takes place on the basis of the results of the practical and/or theoretical work on those study components. // 4 . The assessment committee assesses the work and decides on the assessment results in consultation. // 5 . Students may be given the opportunity to give an explanation on presentation of the results for their study. // 6 . The collective assessment is concluded with a meeting of the assessment committee in which the assessment results are formulated and recorded. If need be the committee makes a recommendation on the continuation of the students’ studies or the choice of a specialism. // 7 . The chairman of the committee also determines the number of EC credits obtained. Article 18 Propaedeutic phase assessment/Rules (Higher Education and Research Act 7.8) // 1. The propaedeutic phase is concluded with a propaedeutic examination in the form of the propaedeutic assessment. // 2 . The propaedeutic assessment takes place by an assessment committee. p.229 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // 4 . Students are given the green light if they have passed all the preceding study components and there is confidence that they will pass the final examination’s format and content. Students are given the amber light if there are doubts about the completion of the preceding components or them passing the final examination’s format and content but there is nevertheless the chance of a pass. Students are given the red light if the assessment committee is of the opinion that a student has no real chance of passing the assessment in the final examination: a negative recommendation for the final examination. The ‘red light’ is binding if the verdict on the final examination relates to a student who has still not passed all the preceding study components, that is to say has still not acquired the requisite 210 EC credits. // 3. The Academy has an assessment committee for each degree course for the propaedeutic phase comprising the head and accompanying teachers. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // 4 . The assessment committee checks to see the extent to which the candidate meets the criteria stipulated on the basis of previously determined, general and subject-related criteria, procedures and rules, and determines the assessment result of that review. // 5 . Students pass the propaedeutic exam if they pass the individual and collective assessments. // 6. The propaedeutic assessment is concluded with a meeting of the assessment committee in which the result is decided and recorded. // 7 . The committee may advise the faculty director to give a binding negative recommendation on the continuation of the study or choice of specialisation. See article 19 of these regulations. // 8 . If students pass the propaedeutic assessment a certificate is awarded indicating that they have passed the assessment and that 60 EC credits have been obtained. // 9 . The propaedeutic phase has to be completed within 2 years for the full-time and part-time courses new style. Article 19 Rules on the study recommendation and rejection (Higher Education and Research Act 7.8b) All propaedeutic students at the Academy, both full-time and parttime, receive a recommendation on the continuation of their course of studies, within the programme or elsewhere, at the end of their propaedeutic phase. Students who have not passed the propaedeutic assess- p.230 ment and who, bearing in mind their personal circumstances, are not deemed by the Academy to be suitable for the main phase of the degree course, may be given a recommendation which involves a binding rejection: the binding negative recommendation. Such a recommendation is also notified to the candidate in writing by one of the faculty directors, or a deputy, in a signed document. The binding negative recommendation refers to the procedures that students must pursue if they wish to lodge an objection or appeal against the recommendation. The recommendation comprises one of the following options: // A positive recommendation: the Academy expects on the basis of the results of the study that the student can pursue the study successfully and promotes the student to the main phase of the degree course in question. // A binding negative recommendation: this entails that the student cannot continue the course of study and can no longer enrol for the same degree course at the Academy. The binding nature applies to the full-time and parttime variant. Students receive this recommendation if the assessment committee on the basis of the results of their studies arrive at the conclusion that the student will not be able to complete the course successfully. // A deviating recommendation with the possibility of resitting the propaedeutic assessment or part of this: students who show talent but fail to back this up sufficiently in their results may be given this recommendation if the assessment committee expects that repeating (parts of) the propaedeutic phase offers the students sufficient basis for successfully pursuing the study, notwithstanding the provision of article 18 paragraph 9. The assessment committee gives the reasons for this expectation in its recommendation. A deviating recommendation is possible as a result of exceptional personal circumstances. Exceptional circumstances are those listed below insofar as in the opinion of the assessment committee they have been an obstacle to students obtaining satisfactory results. They include: / / Student’s serious personal circumstances; / / Pregnancy of the student; / / Membership of the participation council; / / Board membership of a foundation which by virtue of its charter runs student amenities as referred to in the act; / / Board membership of a students’ organisation of some size or a comparable organisation which primarily serves the interests of the arts in society and to this end organises activities; / / Other circumstances than those listed above as a result of which a binding negative recommendation at that moment in the opinion of the assessment committee would result in serious unfairness. Students inform their mentor as soon as possible of any exceptional circumstances. If students do not regard their mentor as being the suitable person for this they get in touch with the student dean who informs the assessment committee of the circumstances in writing. The information may serve no other A recommendation rejecting further study can only be made if the following criteria are met: // A ll students upon commencing the first year of enrolment for the propaedeutic phase of the programme are made aware of the criteria and the procedure with regard to the recommendation on further study and the possibility of rejection. // T he mentor for the propaedeutic phase has an individual talk with individual students twice a year. The first talk takes place as soon as possible after the assessment of the first semester and the results of this are discussed. The second talk takes place in the course of the second semester, possibly in the third semester in the case of part-time courses old style. Students are given information about the recommendation on further study in the first interview. // D uring the interviews students’ results are also available to the students. Any exceptional personal circumstances can also be discussed during this interview alongside these results. // T he mentor makes a record of the outcome of these interviews and adds these to the student’s file. Any exceptional circumstances are included in a separate report that is kept in the student’s file. The mentor informs the assessment committee of these circumstances in writing. p.231 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide / / Student’s demonstrable and longterm illness; purpose than the study recommendation and is only made available to the assessment committee which adds this separately to the student’s file, as does the mentor. The binding negative recommendation can be issued as long as the student has not yet passed the propaedeutic examination and can therefore also be made during the second year of enrolment for the propaedeutic phase. If the student fails to pass the propaedeutic phase at the end of the second year of enrolment this automatically entails a binding negative recommendation unless the Examination committee, at the recommendation of the relevant assessment committee, decides otherwise. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Article 20 Semester assessment // 1. Each semester is concluded with a semester assessment comprising a collective assessment, preceded by or integrated with the individual assessments (see articles 16 and 17). In the last semester of the propaedeutic phase the assessment is called the propaedeutic assessment and in the last semester of the main phase this is called the final assessment. // 2 . As soon as the technical development of the Academy network allows and students have been explicitly informed about it, students will be expected to make available a digital version of all the work to be assessed and keep that available so that this can be held in digital form by the Academy as a portfolio of the individual student’s programme. Article 21 Final assessment or final examination // 1 . The final phase of the study is concluded with the final assessment or concluding exam. // 2 . The assessment committee examines the degree to which the candidate meets the set criteria and determines the assessment p.232 result of that examination on the basis of criteria, procedures and rules established beforehand. // 3 . The assessment criteria are defined for each degree course. // 4 . Students have past the course if they score a pass on the assessments of the parts of the study of the main phase. // 5 . If students pass the final assessment they are awarded a certificate. Article 22 The assessment committee The Academy has assessment committees for each degree course for the propaedeutic assessment, the semester assessments and the final assessment. These assessment committees have different competences depending on their tasks. A description is given below of the committees and their competences. Article 23 Propaedeutic assessment committee; Composition and method of working / / 1. The Academy has an assessment committee for each degree course functioning under the auspices of the Examination Committee, comprising the head of the degree course and the teachers who teach the course. // 2 . The head of the degree course is the chairman of the assessment committee, the coach or the coordinator is the secretary and teachers who teach the relevant parts of the course of study are the members. // 3 . The chairman determines whether the student to be assessed may attend the assessment. // 4 . The committee formulates a recommendation on whether or not the student should continue with the course of study and possibly pursue the study in a particular subject on the basis of the outcome of the propaedeutic assessment at the end of the second semester for full-time and part-time new style students and the third semester for part-time old style students. See article 19 of these regulations. Article 24 Semester assessment committee; Composition and method of working // 2 . The head of the degree course is the chairman of the assessment committee, the coach or the coordinator is the secretary and the teachers who teach the relevant parts of the course of study are the members. // 3 . The chairman determines whether the student to be assessed may attend the assessment. // 4 . The committee formulates a recommendation for each student on the basis of the outcome of the assessment of the semester in question. The recommendation relates to admission or otherwise to the main phase of the study and to pursuing the study in a particular specialisation, where applicable. Article 24a Rules for the semester and propaedeutic assessment committees // 1 . Planning, organisation and coordination of the presentation of the work to be assessed is the responsibility of the chairman of the assessment committee. For this presentation // 2 . Vote: the committee may take a vote if the outcome of the assessment gives rise to this. The committee takes its decision on the basis of a majority vote. If the vote is tied, the chairman has the deciding vote. // 3 . Deciding on a postponed assessment: if the presentation of the work of the student is incomplete the chairman may set a deadline by which an assessment will take place and the procedure that will be adopted for this. // 4 . Study progress: if students fail to pass a course year and the committee is of the opinion that they would be able to continue with their studies after obtaining a pass, the committee can decide to make the assessment again after a certain period. This period may never be longer than the length of the subsequent semester. // 5 . Determining the number of ECTS credits obtained: the chairman of the assessment committee determines the number of EC credits obtained. // 6. Recording the results of the assessment: the chairman is responsible for ensuring that a record is kept of the study results. The chairman dates and signs the form indicating the results of the assessment. After the form has been signed the results are officially ratified. The chairman is responsible for directly handing over the assessment results to the student administration office for the purposes of declarations and certificates. p.233 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // 1 . The Academy has an assessment committee for each degree course functioning under the auspices of the Examination Committee, comprising the head of the degree course and the teachers who teach the course. each component of the study should be presented in such a way that a good impression can be obtained of the performance of the student to be assessed. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // 7 . Further procedure: the chairman is responsible for the further procedures arising as a consequence of the assessment results. Students who in the opinion of the assessment committee have performed unsatisfactorily in whatever way must be informed by means of a letter and/or an interview of the possible consequences of the assessment. The decisions on this must be reported on the assessment form. // 8. The chairman informs the faculty director about all matters of a problematical nature that will not be dealt with by the assessment committee itself or matters for which these regulations do not provide. Article 25 Final assessment committee: Composition and method of working (Higher Education and Research Act 7.12) // 1 . The Academy has an assessment committee for the final assessment: the final assessment committee, functioning under the auspices of the Examination Committee. The committee comprises a chairman, the head of the degree course and (a core team of) teachers who teach students during the final phase of the study. // 2 . At the invitation of the director one or more external experts may join the final assessment committee as a member of the final examination committee // 3 . The final examination is public. The public character of the final assessment does not include the deliberations of the final examination committee. // 4 . The final assessment committee determines on the basis of the outcome of the p.234 final assessment whether the student has passed or failed the course. Article 26 Final examination regulation Royal Academy of Art // 1 . The final exam (or final assessment) is arranged in conformity with the provisions of the Higher Education and Research Act (7.12). The final exam takes place in the form of a final assessment. // 2 . The composition of the assessment committee for the final assessment, the final assessment committee, is described in article 25 of these regulations. // 3 . The final assessment committee decides on the final examination work in a collective assessment, in which the substance of the verdict of the external members is taken into account, as are the assessments of the individual elements which are part of the final examination phase. The work presented plays a decisive role in this whole. The question that is asked is whether the work makes visible as a cohesive whole an authentic vision of the visual arts or design, and whether the individual theme and research incorporated in it has been brought into the public domain in an articulate way. ›› 3a. The number, subject, technique and execution of the works are determined in consultation with the teachers involved and the head of the degree course in the light of the goal of the final examination as described in paragraph 3 of this article and in the description of the programmes of the degree courses in the Education and Examination Regulations. For the theory subjects a written paper is required, the subject and the size of which is determined in consultation with the teacher in question. The paper must be submitted in triplicate: one copy for the student, one for the teacher and one for the records in the library. The copy of the final paper given to the teacher and the library remain the property of the Academy. If possible the final paper must also be handed in in digital form preferably in PDF format. // 5 . All presented pieces of work need to be verifiably the inalienable intellectual property of the candidate. // 6 . The final assessment committee takes its decision on the basis of a majority vote. If the vote is tied the chairman has the deciding vote. / / 7. As soon as possible after the final assessment, but at the latest within three days, the outcome is notified to the candidate by the secretary of the final assessment committee. After processing the data the candidate receives a judicium or verdict indicating the score and the outcome. The formulation of the score comprises a final grade and/or a list of grades and/or a reasoned written declaration. // 8 . When it becomes apparent that the student has not passed all the necessary preceding components of the study a decision is taken as to how and when a student will be given the // 9. Awarding of certificates and declarations is described in article 30 of these regulations. // 1 0. Resits: the final examination committee may grant students the opportunity to take a resit if a candidate has failed one or more parts of the exam. ›› T he final assessment committee decides at the final assessment committee meeting whether one or more resits can be taken if in the opinion of the final assessment committee the candidate can be deemed capable of passing the final assessment if one or more resits is taken. ›› C andidates who are eligible to take one or more resits are required within seven days after the announcement of the outcome to submit a request to take one or more resits to the chairman of the final assessment committee. ›› T he chairman of the final assessment committee determines the date, time and place of the resit which has to be taken at the latest before the start of the new course year. ›› T he final assessment committee may decide on an ‘extended examination’, that is to say postponement of the final assessment if a candidate presents an incomplete final examination collection for one or more parts of the exam. An ‘extended examination’ p.235 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide / / 4. For all papers/pieces of work submitted for assessment the rule is that they must have been made under the supervision of the teacher or teachers in question and must have been accepted as such by the teacher(s). opportunity to nevertheless pass these components. The student is informed of this effect by the chairman or the secretary of the final assessment committee. Completion, if possible, will take place before the end of the current academic year in other words by 1 September, otherwise the student will be required to re-enrol. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide is conditional on the final assessment committee’s view that a resit, that is to say the presentation of more work or work again is impossible before the beginning of the new course year, and that the candidate is deemed capable of passing the complete final examination within the period of one semester. // 11. Extended examination: the candidate who has been declared eligible for the ‘extended examination’ must submit a request for postponement of the final examination to the chairman of the final assessment committee within seven days of the announcement of the aforementioned decision. The chairman of the final assessment committee determines the date, time and place of the postponed final assessment which has to take place at the latest before the end of the semester subsequent to the final assessment. If the candidate does not wish to avail himself of the extended examination, he is deemed to have failed. // 1 2. Inability to participate in the final assessment or part of this as a result of illness, accident or serious family circumstances must be notified to the chairman of the final assessment committee before the commencement of the final assessment. Written proof must be submitted for acknowledgement of the inability to take part. A new date for the final assessment can be decided on in consultation with the chairman of the final assessment committee. // 1 3. Candidates may lodge an appeal against the outcome of the final assessment in conformity with the valid rules stipulated in article 33. p.236 / / 14. A book and/or CD ROM/DVD will be compiled of the final exam work of all candidates taking full-time and part-time courses at the Academy. Every student is obliged to supply material for this before the set deadline. / / 15. A final examination candidate can only participate on one occasion in this publication. An endeavour is made to have the date of issue of the final exam book and/ or CD ROM/DVD coincide with the diploma awarding ceremony. ›› 15a.Participation in the final examination exhibition is a one-off event and subject to conditions. If the final assessment committee or the final examination exhibition coordinator commissioned by the director is of the opinion that the presentation of the student is incomplete the student may be excluded from participating in the final examination exhibition. // 16. In cases where these regulations do not provide, the faculty director or the deputy decides. Article 27 Exemption An assessment committee may, on behalf of the Examination Committee, at the request of a student grant exemption for one or more components of the study on the basis of a qualification, diploma, certificate or other documentary proof from which it is apparent that the student has already met the requirements of that part of the course. The request must be submitted in writing to the chairman of the assessment committee or direct to the Examination Committee. The relevant documentary evidence must accompany the written request. The validity of an exemption granted is unlimited unless the content of that component of the study changes as a result of an amendment to the Education and Examination Regulations. If an exemption is granted the student is sent a notice of exemption. Article 28 Resits/re-examination (see also article 24a) / / 1. The assessment committee determines on the basis of the results of the assessment whether a student is eligible for a resit and what conditions apply to a resit. / / 3. Individual assessments of design subjects or visual subjects: if a student fails an assessment of a design subject and visual subjects a resit can take place. In certain situations a compensation arrangement applies or the activities in a subsequent semester may count as a resit for assignments that were failed during a preceding semester. / / 4. Collective assessment: in certain situations if a student fails a collective assessment a resit can take place by obtaining a pass for a collective assessment in the next semester. Article 29 Registration and announcement of assessment results; validity of results / / 1. The assessment committee uses a form to record the assessment results for each student at the meeting after the collective assessment. The chairman of the assessment committee signs the forms. // 3. The outcome of the assessment is notified to the student as soon as possible after the collective assessment. // 4. The student receives a report of the assessment after it has taken place, including the assessment of the performance and the outcome of the assessment. // 5. Students who fail the assessment receive an overview as soon as possible after an assessment indicating whether a resit is possible. // 6. In the case of students temporarily interrupting their studies results obtained remain valid for one year. In principle after this students are required to retake their entrance. The admissions committee also makes a recommendation as to whether earlier credits obtained are still valid. Article 30 Declarations and certificates (Higher Education and Research Act 7.11) // 1. Students receive a written declaration giving the outcome of the assessment and, where applicable, the recommendation made as soon as possible after a collective assessment and after the student administration has made a record of the assessment results. // 2. Students who pass the assessment receive a certificate giving the outcome and the recommendation for further study after the propaedeutic assessment and after the student administration has made a record of the assessment results. p.237 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide / / 2. Individual assessments of theoretical subject: if a student has failed the assessment of a theory subject a resit is possible. The resit must have taken place by the end of the relevant course year. // 2. The outcome of the assessment is stored for each student in the student tracking system by the Student administration. // 3. Students who have passed the final assessment receive a certificate giving the outcome of the final assessment and the status of the diploma obtained after the final assessment and after the student administration has made a record of the assessment results. Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide // 4. The institution’s board grants the degree of Bachelor and the degree of Master to those who have passed the final examination of a Bachelor programme or the final examination of a Master programme respectively // 5. The institution’s board adds to a degree the discipline or the professional domain to which the degree applies. Bachelor of Fine Arts (Bfa) for those who have graduated in the Visual Arts and Bachelor of Design (Bdes) for those who have graduated in Design. Master of Design in Type and Media (MaDes). // 6. Students who have passed several assessments but to whom no certificate in the sense of article 30 paragraphs 3 and 4 can be awarded, receives on request a declaration by the Royal Academy of Art listing the assessments that have been passed. The student must submit the request in writing to the faculty director. Article 31 Irregularities // 1. If a student is culpable of any irregularity with regard to any part of an assessment, the chairman of an assessment committee may refuse him participation or further participation in an assessment. // 2. If the irregularity is first discovered after a propaedeutic assessment or the p.238 final assessment the assessment committee may refuse the student the certificate referred to in article 7.11 paragraph 1 of the Higher Education and Research Act or may determine that the student may only be awarded the certificate after a new assessment of the parts to be designated by the assessment committee and in a way which the committee determines. / / 3. Prior to a decision being taken by virtue of paragraphs 1 and 2 the chairman of the assessment committee hears the assessment committee and the student. / / 4. The chairman consults at all times with the faculty director. / / 5. The chairman reports the decisions immediately to the student, if possible in person, and in any event in writing. Article 32 Safe-keeping / / 1. For the duration of an appeals procedure lodged by a student all the theoretical and practical working items need to be kept safe. The student is responsible for keeping the aforementioned items. / / 2. For the duration of an appeals procedure lodged by a student all applicable theory and practical assignments given need to be kept safe. The Academy is responsible for keeping the aforementioned items. Article 33 Objection and appeal arrangements / / 1. Students who deem that their interests have been directly damaged as a result of what is in their opinion a wrong application of the Education and Examination Regulations, are entitled to lodge a written appeal within thirty days with the Board of Appeal for Examinations of the University of the Arts, The Hague. / / 2. The Board of Appeal gives judgement on the appeal that has been lodged against: ›› decisions to fail the student with a binding study recommendation as referred to in article 19; ›› decisions on admission to the final phase and final assessment as referred to in article 15 paragraph 2 to 4 and article 26; ›› other decisions by assessment and examination committees and examiners. / / 3. The appeal can be lodged if: ›› t he decision is in contravention of any generally binding regulation, for example the Education and Examination Regulations; ›› in taking the decision the body obviously used its power for other purposes than that for which it was originally intended; ›› in weighing the interests in question the body involved could not in all reasonableness have taken the decision; ›› the decision is contrary to any other principle of good administration prevailing as part of the general sense of justice; ›› the further provisions regarding the procedure, the handling and the verdict can be found in the Legal Protection chapter of the Student Charter of the University of the Arts, The Hague. // o rder to immediately restore the damage; // s uspension or denial of access to the buildings and area. Article 35 Copyright All the work that students make during their study is part of the study and also serves as the basis for the credits obtained during the study. This is why the work during the entire duration of the student’s study is the property of the Royal Academy of Arts. Naturally students have right of use. Once students have been deregistered the right of ownership passes to them. The Royal Academy of Arts retains the right to use the work at a later date as well, without any remuneration, within the context of its own objectives. If a former student becomes affiliated to an intermediary agency in the field of copyright the student is obliged to inform that agency of this arrangement. The digital “conversions” of the work assessed as part of the semester assessments remain available to the academy for appropriate use within the objectives of the academy. Article 36 Tests and exams (assessments) for disadvantaged students Disadvantaged students can take part in the tests and examinations in a way that allows for their disadvantage. They can come to an agreement for this purpose with the head or the coordinator of the degree course and/or if need be submit a request to this end to the Examination committee. p.239 Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide ›› decisions on the number of credits obtained; Article 34 Misconduct Misconduct including vandalising or inflicting damage on the building and/or aggression towards persons is notified to the director who will then take measures. The measures may be: 8. Organisation and Facilities In addition to a wide range of other topics, you can find the most up-todate information about the following matters on the KABK website: // O rganisation // S tudent housing // F inancial matters // F acilities/workshops // C ollaborations of the KABK // K ABK digital // A rt Student Union // A lumni Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide p.241 Colophon Design Studio KABK 2012/2013 Anton Lamberg & Arthur Reinders Folmer Royal Academy of Art − Studyguide Editor Wieneke Mulder Eric Privee in cooperation with heads of the departments Translation Studyguide Tamara de Groot Printer Veenman+, Rotterdam Paper Cyclus offset 80gr & 200gr Colors Pantone 072 Pantone Black 5 Typefaces Berthold Akzidenz Grotesk Akkurat Mono Calendarium/Regular p.242 Royal Academy of Art Adress Prinsessegracht 4 2514 AN The Hague Contact tel 070 315 47 77 fax 070 315 47 78 post@kabk.nl www.kabk.nl - “I think we should be leaving now.”, - “Yeah. That’s probably a good idea.”